Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Consuming Catastrophe PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 196
At a glance
Powered by AI
The book discusses how mass media shaped public understanding and memory of major disasters that occurred in the United States in the 2000s, such as 9/11, Hurricane Katrina, and the financial crisis.

The book is about how mass media and mass culture influenced how Americans understood and remembered major disasters like 9/11, Hurricane Katrina, and the financial crisis of the late 2000s.

Some of the major disasters discussed in the book include 9/11, Hurricane Katrina, the Virginia Tech shooting, and the financial crisis of the late 2000s.

CONSUMING

CATASTROPHE
CONSUMING CATASTROPHE

Mass Culture in America’s


Decade of Disaster

TIMOTHY RECUBER
TEMPLE UNIVERSITY PRESS
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19122
www.temple.edu/tempress

Copyright © 2016 by Temple University—Of The Commonwealth System of Higher Education


All rights reserved
Published 2016

Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data

Names: Recuber, Timothy, 1978– author.


Title: Consuming catastrophe : mass culture in America’s decade of disaster / Timothy Recuber.
Description: Philadelphia : Temple University Press, 2016. | Includes bibliographical references.
Identifiers: LCCN 2016018610 | ISBN 9781439913697 | ISBN 9781439913703 | ISBN
9781439913710 (e-book)
Subjects: LCSH: Disasters—Press coverage—United States. | Disasters—Social aspects—United
States. | Mass media and culture—United States. | Mass media—Social aspects—United States. |
United States—Civilization—21st century.
Classification: LCC PN4888.D57 R43 2016 | DDC 070.4/49973931—dc23
LC record available at https://lccn.loc.gov/2016018610

987654321
CONTENTS

Acknowledgments

Introduction: A Decade of Disaster

1 A History of Catastrophe: Media, Mass Culture, and Authenticity

2 The Limits of Empathy: Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech


Shootings

3 The Authenticity of Fear: September 11 and the Financial Crisis

4 Memory as Therapy: September 11, Hurricane Katrina, and Online


Commemoration

Conclusion: The Deepwater Horizon Oil Spill and Disasters Still to Come

References
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

Iandhavewriting
been tremendously fortunate to spend the past eight years thinking
about disasters and their media representations, all while
supported by talented advisers, generous colleagues, and loving friends and
family. I owe them all much more than these brief acknowledgments, but at
the very least I want to bear witness to their benevolence.
I began graduate school at the University of Maryland in the fall of 2001
and woke to news of the September 11 attacks the morning after moving into
my first apartment with Jenna Kryszczun, who is now my wife. We moved to
Brooklyn in late August 2005, as I had decided to pursue a doctorate at the
Graduate Center of the City University of New York, and we got our
television hooked up just in time to see the first images of people stranded on
rooftops in an inundated New Orleans after Hurricane Katrina. As we
experienced these and the other disasters covered in this book, Jenna was by
my side at every turn, helping me make sense of this turbulent, tumultuous
world. She has supported me in every imaginable way throughout this project
—as a critic, a proofreader, a benefactor, and a promoter—and without her
this book simply would not have been possible.
At the Graduate Center, Stuart Ewen helped me conceive of this project
in its earliest stages and kept me focused on the bigger picture throughout.
John Torpey provided thoughtful and encouraging comments on my work, as
well as invaluable professional guidance. Sharon Zukin helped shape and
sharpen my theorizing with her keen insights. My work and career have
benefited greatly from the influence and friendship of all three. Others at the
Graduate Center who aided my efforts include Patrick Inglis, who
commented on an early draft of a chapter, and Kristen Van Hooreweghe and
Elizabeth Bullock, who helped me clarify ideas over drinks in our Greenpoint
neighborhood. While I was at the Graduate Center, the New York Public
Library generously provided space in its Wertheim Study for me to pursue
much of my preliminary research.
My colleagues at Queens College supported me as I was finishing my
doctorate and writing the earliest draft of this book, and for their help and
encouragement, Jason Tougaw, Ken Nielsen, and Judith Summerfield
deserve many thanks. In addition, were it not for the care and stewardship of
my intellectual career at its earliest stages provided by my mentors at the
University of Maryland—Lory “Tomni” Dance, Bill Falk, George Ritzer, and
the late Richard Harvey Brown—I would not be a sociologist or an academic
of any kind.
I have learned a great deal about the craft of writing from my colleagues
at the Princeton Writing Program (PWP), where I have taught for the past
five years. Ali Aslam and Rebekah Massengill provided valuable feedback on
drafts and proposals related to this project. I have benefited from the talents
of my fellow lecturers in many discussions, workshops, and presentations at
the PWP offices, and I have been especially fortunate to be able to teach
courses such as my “Witnessing Disaster” seminar to so many bright, young
first-year Princeton students. Their interest in and dedication to this topic
have continually inspired my own.
Parts of Chapter 4 are derived from my article “The Prosumption of
Commemoration: Disasters, Digital Memory Banks, and Online Collective
Memory,” American Behavioral Scientist 56, no. 4 (2012): 531–549. I thank
the anonymous reviewers of that essay and the reviewers of two of my
preliminary essays that also fed into this book: “Disaster Porn!” Contexts 12,
no. 2 (2013): 28–33, and “The Terrorist as Folk Devil and Mass Commodity:
Moral Panics, Risk, and Consumer Culture,” Journal of the Institute of
Justice and International Studies 158 (2009): 158–170. I am also grateful to
the reviewers of this book for their generous and enthusiastic suggestions and
to Micah Kleit for his skilled editorial guidance.
While I have immersed myself for years in tales of disaster and
destruction, I have been constantly surrounded by the love of my wife, my
parents, my brother and brother-in-law, my friends, and especially my
children—Margot and Simon. They remind me every day of the good and
beauty in this world. By understanding disasters and their mass mediation, it
is my hope that we can work to protect that beauty, promote the common
good, and create a more just future for all.
CONSUMING
CATASTROPHE
INTRODUCTION

A DECADE OF DISASTER

T he World Trade Center towers burned and crumbled to the ground on


live television as millions watched in awe, horror, and anguish. They watched
alone or with loved ones, at home or at work, on television or online. Some
stayed online and shared their thoughts, recollections, and fears with
anonymous others. Some donated money, gave blood, volunteered their time.
Some bought American flags, patriotic bumper stickers, memorial T-shirts
and trinkets. Some bought bigger, safer cars; home security systems; even
parachutes designed to save executives in skyscrapers from similar attacks in
the future. And some made speeches, pushed policies, passed legislation that
steered the country’s recovery and shifted the national character in the new,
post-9/11 reality.
So, too, did millions watch as New Orleans was flooded four years later,
its poorest neighborhoods destroyed, its poorest residents stranded on
rooftops and in a poorly organized mass shelter at the Superdome. They
were, once again, horrified, saddened, angered. Again, these distant
spectators sat glued to the television, or went online, or donated time or
money, or bought music or T-shirts to benefit Hurricane Katrina recovery
efforts. Some even purchased rooftop escape hatches to help them avoid the
fates of those who were trapped in attics and consumed by floodwaters,
should a similar disaster occur in the future. And again the government
responded, though belatedly and ineffectively, as the country struggled to
come to terms with the destruction of one of its major cities and cultural
centers.
A year and a half later, millions again tuned in to breaking news
coverage as an alienated and unstable student at Virginia Tech shot and killed
thirty-two of his fellow students, and himself. They watched shaken and
shocked students stagger out of classrooms into a pool of cameras and
microphones. They watched two days later as portions of the shooter’s
deranged and violent multimedia manifesto were broadcast on major
television news programs. They gave money to scholarship funds, bought the
school’s athletic apparel as a show of solidarity, and checked in on social
networking sites with students at Tech and other universities. And Virginia
politicians began a massive inquiry into what went wrong and what could
have been prevented, while broader national debates about gun control and
mental health were reflected in the speeches of pundits and politicians,
though never in any subsequent federal legislation.
A year and a half after that, the sudden collapse of venerable investment
bank Lehman Brothers signaled the beginning of another disaster, a massive
global recession erasing billions in wealth and causing waves of evictions and
unemployment across the country. Millions watched the less spectacular but
frequently ominous footage of white-collar workers carrying boxes out of
their emptying offices or heard the fearful pronouncements from news
anchors and politicians about a potential meltdown of the global economy.
Even the normal, twenty-four-hour-a-day coverage of the presidential race
between John McCain and Barack Obama was superseded by a series of
revelations about the insolvency of large financial institutions. This disaster
ultimately resulted in the passage of highly controversial bank bailout
legislation and other, smaller economic stimulus measures, none of which
successfully reignited the American economy in the ways their creators had
hoped. Meanwhile, Americans began to radically change their spending
habits, out of either fear or necessity, as companies attempted to shift their
marketing and advertising strategies to match the new frugality of panicked,
economically insecure consumers.
In the first decade of the twenty-first century, Americans watched as
mass media, consumer culture, big business, and national politics both shaped
and were shaped by the September 11 terrorist attacks in 2001, Hurricane
Katrina in 2005, the Virginia Tech shootings in 2007, and the financial crisis
of 2008. Although each of these disasters was the focus of extensive news
coverage, political debate, and popular culture, efforts to rebuild have been
slow, at best, and often ineffective, particularly at instituting the safeguards
necessary to prevent similar calamities in the future. The financial crisis has
not resulted in meaningful prosecution of bankers or strong legislation to
prevent future financial collapse. The shootings at Virginia Tech did not spur
new gun control laws. Hurricane Katrina has only exacerbated the racial and
class inequality that made the government’s poor response so problematic in
the first place. Even the massive post-9/11 security and surveillance
apparatus has not seemed to decrease the sense of threat posed by terrorism.
Although such failures have not gone unnoticed, they also have not sustained
the high levels of concern that these disasters initially generated. Why is this?
Why do we care so much about the live broadcasting of mass tragedies and
give so much money to disaster relief efforts, only to quickly accept that the
work is done, that the problem is over? Why, despite so many admonitions to
never forget, do we seem to do just that—at least when it comes to the big,
long-term solutions that disaster prevention tends to require?
Part of the explanation certainly lies in the narrow and formulaic ways
that we engage with disasters and tragedies today and the kinds of outcomes
that such engagement both constrains and enables. Although these were all
very different disasters with vastly different death tolls, economic costs,
cultural effects, and political ramifications, they followed surprisingly similar
paths through public consciousness. These paths included an initial flurry of
attention in which they dominated the media landscape in a highly
spectacular and emotional fashion; followed by a broad response from a wide
range of producers, advertisers, entrepreneurs, and politicians; then a slow
tapering off of public attention and emotional investment, coupled with a
backlash over the media coverage or mass consumption of the events
themselves.
The January 26, 2011, issue of the satirical newspaper The Onion
captured the backlash concerning September 11 in an article entitled
“Congress Honors 9/11 First Capitalizers.” It described the passage of a
fictional “9/11 First Capitalizers Act,” designed to honor those “who sensed
the direness of the moment and immediately sprang into action on that
terrible day, exploiting it for personal profit” (“Congress Honors 9/11 First
Capitalizers” 2011, 1). Included in this group were “not only those who
rushed to Ground Zero immediately to sell merchandise, participate in photo
ops, or advance an ideological agenda, but also those who profited from afar
by producing jingoistic songs and TV specials, or mentioning 9/11 in stump
speeches as a way of scaring people into voting for them” (“Congress Honors
9/11 First Capitalizers” 2011, 7). Although the article singled out some real-
life “capitalizers” such as the country musician Toby Keith, the filmmaker
Oliver Stone, Halliburton’s chief executive David Lesar, and George W.
Bush, it also described a forty-eight-year-old woman named Linda Banks
“who continues to trot out her maudlin, self-serving story of where she was
on 9/11 every single time she sees an opportunity” (“Congress Honors 9/11
First Capitalizers” 2011, 7). The article closed by stating that a special plaque
would be erected on the National Mall “containing the names of all
12,554,310 Americans who eventually capitalized on the tragedy” through
“advertising, partisan rhetoric, forgettable novels, defense contracts, and all-
around cheap, manipulative sentimentalism” (“Congress Honors 9/11 First
Capitalizers” 2011, 7).
Although the “9/11 First Capitalizers Act” is a fabrication, the criticism
behind this satire is quite real. Many commentators have been bothered by
the roles of mass media and consumer culture in the American public’s
response to the September 11 attacks, and the political uses to which that
response was ultimately put. Some, such as social theorist Frederic Jameson,
argued that the public’s emotional reaction to 9/11 constituted a kind of
“utterly insincere” hysteria (Jameson 2002, 297). Others, such as the film
critic Anthony Lane, were troubled by the degree to which viewers’
responses to the spectacle of the attacks mimicked everyday forms of cinema
spectatorship. He asked, “Where have you heard those expressions most
recently—the wows, the whoohs, the holy shits—if not in movie theatres, and
even on your own blaspheming tongue” (Lane 2001, para. 2)?
Whether aimed at the news media, real estate developers, Hollywood
producers, souvenir vendors, government officials, or American consumers,
these types of ethical, aesthetic, and political condemnations formed a
countercurrent to the tide of mainstream public opinion immediately after
September 11. As the decade continued, subsequent disasters generated
similar processes of mediation, consumption, and, some would say,
exploitation, which were often the subject of similar rebukes. Just as many
held that tourism at the Ground Zero site was a morally dubious activity, so,
too, did people come to perceive travel to New Orleans after Hurricane
Katrina as a potentially ghoulish act. As one disaster recovery volunteer with
the Federal Emergency Management Agency (FEMA) recalled on a website
devoted to the storm, “It was not without reservation that I went to St.
Bernard parish. I felt like—I was a voyeur in their neighborhood.” This
charge of voyeurism, this unease about viewing intimate details of others’
suffering from a safe distance, appeared again in 2007 after the shootings at
Virginia Tech. NBC News was flooded with criticism online and in print
after it decided to air parts of the shooter Seung-Hui Cho’s digital manifesto,
and some victims and their families canceled their scheduled television
appearances on the network as a result (A. Johnson 2007). Writing in
Advertising Age, the media columnist Simon Dumenco assailed the news
networks for their crass “Massacre at Virginia Tech” graphics, arguing,
“We’ve come to the point at which murderous psychopaths and TV news
executives are of the same mind when it comes to human tragedy: It’s a
branding opportunity” (Dumenco 2007, 34). It seems that when otherwise
normal forms of commerce, entertainment, politics, or mass communication
take disasters as their subjects or inspiration, they often rankle the
sensibilities of many Americans.
Yet many more engage in precisely these types of activities each time a
disaster strikes. Even The Onion recognized this situation by asserting that
more than twelve million people had “capitalized” on the events of 9/11 in
some fashion and thus deserved the sarcastic inclusion of their names on an
honorific plaque. If watching a disaster on television or visiting a disaster site
makes one a voyeur, if reacting to a disaster emotionally is insincere, if using
a disaster to make a political point is exploitative, and if creating a product,
service, or work of art that responds to a disaster is simply a way to capitalize
on tragedy, then very few Americans have escaped the past decade ethically
untarnished. The simple fact is that most Americans, and many others across
the globe, rely on mass media and consumer culture to provide the resources
through which we experience, understand, and respond to pain, tragedy, and
loss—even, or perhaps especially, when they occur on such a massive scale.
In the wake of this decade of disaster, each of us has had to negotiate a
stunning variety of images, texts, products, and services that address the
harrowing realities of multiple crises and catastrophes. These negotiations,
and the moral condemnations that sometimes accompany them, suggest that
the norms concerning appropriate personal, commercial, and political
responses to disasters are in the process of shifting and that a consensus on
these matters is only beginning to emerge. Norms are the codes of conduct
that delineate culturally acceptable behavior and that mark certain ways of
seeing the world as legitimate or appropriate. “Just as sets of mutually
consistent norms help regulate behavior, so sets of inconsistent or rapidly
shifting norms … are often regarded as a symptom, if not a cause, of social
unrest” (Hechter and Opp 2001, xi). Such unrest—or, at least, widespread
unease—was evident almost immediately after September 11: one poll taken
two weeks after the attacks found that 53 percent of Americans were very or
somewhat worried that they or someone in their family “might become a
victim of a terrorist attack” (Pew Research Center for the People and the
Press 2001c). Two years later, 75 percent of Americans felt that the world
had become a more dangerous place (Pew Research Center for the People and
the Press 2003). In 2009, 58 percent of Americans still felt that way (Pew
Research Center for the People and the Press 2009). By the end of the
decade, in addition to these fears about terrorism, Americans’ financial
security had also been shaken: a full 70 percent of Americans had
experienced a problem related to their job or personal finances (Pew
Research Center for the People and the Press 2010b). It makes sense, then,
that a period in which Americans from all walks of life had their sense of
personal safety and economic security shaken would expose rifts and
fractures in normative structures concerning not only disasters but also the
larger role of mass media and consumer culture in American life.
This work explores the interwoven fabric of news, entertainment,
advertising, commodities, and other services through which Americans came
to experience disasters in the first decade of the twenty-first century. Within
this fabric are threaded several important norms concerning the appropriate
emotional, commercial, and political responses to disasters. These are often
complementary, though occasionally contradictory, but taken together they
explain the contemporary appeal of disaster consumption. Although many
Americans are bothered by the consumption of catastrophe, many more
actively participate in it—and, perhaps more accurately, those two groups
need not be seen as mutually exclusive. Instead, individuals today are tasked
with navigating the shifting cultural standards concerning forms of disaster
spectatorship and consumerism that they may experience as morally
appropriate, personally therapeutic, or, in extreme cases, ethically repugnant.
This book argues that disasters stand out from the rest of mass media and
consumer culture because of their connection, however tenuous, to the real
and because of the emotional power that such a connection generates. Typical
elements of mass culture get disrupted by disasters, as do the cynical and
ironic perspectives of audiences and consumers. Instead, the texts, products,
websites, and other mediated experiences that stem from disasters are marked
as different from the rest of popular culture by the traces of real loss and real
pain that they signify. These traces, when clearly identifiable via certain
aesthetic and performative cues, signal to audiences and consumers that it is
OK, and even laudable, to be moved emotionally. In fact, this has become a
norm or obligation—to allow oneself to empathize with distant victims of
disasters and tragedies.
For instance, five days after the terrorist attacks of September 11, 2001,
the New York Times discussed the details about the lives of the victims that
had begun to emerge. “We are just now getting to know these people, the
missing and the dead. Their stories carry a weight no one expected because
they are such ordinary stories” (“The Faces Emerge” 2001). One sees in this
ordinariness an important marker of authenticity, one that allows readers to
forge a specific kind of emotional connection to these victims. As the Times
put it:

No person is interchangeable with another, but we all understand


how interchangeable these … stories might have been if the timing
of the attacks and the ultimate collapse of the towers had been
different. The dividing line between those who made it out and
those who didn’t is inexplicable. We are also learning how to
recognize in the tales the obituaries tell, and in the profiles of the
victims we see on television, how interchangeable we might have
been with those who died. Their lives resembled ours more closely
than we can let ourselves imagine. (“The Faces Emerge” 2001)

Despite the rhetorical flourish that this is all “more than we can let
ourselves imagine,” such imagination is precisely what the quote encourages
from its readers. Indeed, the passage makes the case that these victims’
stories are valuable because of the sort of personal, empathetic reflection they
engender. While such engagement with the suffering of others is not
necessarily, as some critics would have it, insincere or voyeuristic, the irony
of disaster consumption resides in the fact that the catastrophes and crises
experienced as the most real, the most harrowing, the most authentic contain
the greatest potential for steering or manipulating public opinion. Indeed, the
most seemingly authentic disasters ultimately can have the most inauthentic
political ends. At the very least, the harrowing spectacle of mass-mediated
disaster provides no guarantee that institutions will take the appropriate
measures to safeguard us from future calamities. Far from it.
Instead, the assumption that consuming catastrophe allows us to learn
from these tragedies and improve ourselves and our society as a result is
often shattered when the next disaster strikes. For example, another New York
Times editorial took the occasion of the four-year anniversary of the
September 11 attacks to ponder Hurricane Katrina’s recent devastation. “It
took a day or two after Hurricane Katrina hit the Gulf Coast to understand
that it could affect our feelings about what happened at the World Trade
Center, at the Pentagon and in rural Pennsylvania” (“Revising 9/11” 2005).
Lamenting the fact that “everyone did not behave well” and “the federal
government was less prepared than it had been” before 9/11, the authors were
forced to revise the “tidy story arc” about 9/11 in which “mistakes were
made, but we would learn from them, and wind up stronger and better
prepared” (“Revising 9/11” 2005).
This shock at the repetition of disasters, this disappointment at the lack
of lessons learned, is a common feature of disaster media. After the Virginia
Tech shootings in 2007, comparisons to the mass shootings at Columbine
High School in 1999 were, of course, commonplace. As the Times once again
exclaimed, “Sympathy was not enough at the time of Columbine, and eight
years later, it is not enough” (“Eight Years after Columbine” 2007). Yet
sympathy and empathy are often all that we, as distant spectators of others’
misfortune, have to give.
The book thus tells the story of how authenticity came to be a crucial
element in the mass-mediation of disaster; how the authenticity of disasters
works in tandem with the rise of empathy as a cultural norm; how empathy is
connected to other emotions, such as fear and trust; how this focus on
empathy for suffering others gets channeled toward the individualistic rather
than the communal; and how this individualism makes disasters amenable to
the manipulation of elites and reactionary forces. Ultimately, it argues that
the ineffability of disasters—their stubborn refusal to provide a full
understanding, or a complete catharsis, to their distant spectators—makes
them a particularly powerful force in contemporary American mass culture.
In fact, this quality encourages a kind of empathetic hedonism, in which the
desire to understand the suffering of others is pursued doggedly, though
always necessarily unsatisfactorily. But how did we arrive at this point?
The contemporary consumption of disaster is itself the product of a
history of shifts in ways of knowing and responding to the suffering of
others. The invention of the printing press first made tales of misfortunes
suffered by distant others available to mass audiences, and discourse on the
appropriate moral and political responses to such suffering has been a feature
of social life since at least the Enlightenment. But the speed, frequency, and
intimacy of our exposure to others’ suffering has increased exponentially
with the growth of consumer culture and the rapid development of a host of
mass-media technologies. Today, audiences and consumers engage with
disasters and tragedies through television news programs, reality television
shows, documentary films, and digital archives, as well as the myriad other
commodities that cater to some aspect of disasters—comic books with
patriotic themes, T-shirts or records that benefit disaster-related charities,
home and office security devices designed to protect against future disasters,
and social networking sites devoted to sharing one’s grief over a mass
tragedy, to name a few examples. Thus, to fully understand the consumption
and mediation of recent disasters such as September 11, Hurricane Katrina,
the Virginia Tech shootings, and the 2008 financial crisis, one must explore
the very development of the modern public sphere, as well as its recent
transformations.
Disaster sociologists might find the grouping together of these events
problematic inasmuch as the social disruption and social changes in
communities affected by these disparate events have varied greatly (see
Quarantelli and Dynes 1977). But the farther one moves away from
victimized communities, or the more distant and mediated one’s experience
of a disaster becomes, then the more likely it becomes that these events will
be experienced through similar cultural frameworks. Although the processes
by which communities respond to and cope with disasters have been expertly
investigated by sociologists such as Kai Erikson (1976, 1994), Eric
Klinenberg (2002), Thomas Drabek (2010), and many others, the effects of
disasters on national audiences who experience them only through media
images and mass commodities remain less thoroughly explored within this
sociological subdiscipline.
Scholars outside the traditions of disaster sociology have debated the
effects of disasters as generators of media, consumption, and capitalism.
Mike Davis (1999) has critiqued the denials about real disasters and
inequality that are embedded in fantastic disaster-themed media, focusing on
the especially disaster-prone city of Los Angeles. Marita Sturken (2007) has
examined the ways in which kitsch consumerism helped construct a “culture
of comfort” that depoliticized the national traumas of the Oklahoma City
bombing and the September 11 attacks. E. Ann Kaplan (2005) has coined the
term “empty empathy” to describe the emotions generated by harrowing
images of war and disaster when the news media fails to adequately
contextualize them. Kevin Rozario (2007) has highlighted the historical
development of an American perspective on disasters in which they are seen
as opportunities for both spiritual renewal and capitalist expansion. And the
current neoliberal manifestation of this perspective may be the “shock
doctrine” described by Naomi Klein (2007), in which elites in business and
government depend on, and in some cases engineer, crises and catastrophes
to shock the public into accepting aggressive and exploitative privatization
schemes. Yet her account neglects the fact that, rather than shocked public
acquiescence to elite schemes and frameworks, disasters often trigger
spontaneous outpourings of nationalist sentiment, expressed through diverse
forms of mass media and mass consumption, in support of many expansions
of neoliberal governance.
One form of mass media has long been a focal point for these types of
debates: the photograph. A deep discomfort with photographs of suffering
emerged as early as 1945, when images of World War II and the Holocaust
began to be labeled “pornographic” (Dean 2004). The effects of such so-
called pornographic imagery were often believed to be a kind of deadening or
flattening of audience engagement. John Berger has suggested that
photographs of conflicts such as those in Vietnam or Northern Ireland
became commonplace only once newspaper editors realized that their
supposed radicalizing effect was “not what it was once presumed to be”
(Berger 1991, 38). But if their effects on audiences were limited, such
photographs nonetheless left their producers and consumers open to charges
of exploitation. In On Photography, Susan Sontag argued that to photograph
a moment of pain or trauma was “to be in complicity with … another
person’s pain or misfortune” (Sontag 1990, 12). Later, Arthur and Joan
Kleinman reminded readers that “images of trauma are part of our political
economy. Papers are sold, television programs gain audience share, careers
are advanced, jobs are created, and prizes awarded through the appropriation
of images of suffering” (Kleinman and Kleinman 1996, 8).
These arguments certainly present a moral dilemma for the consumers of
such images, who may be sympathetic to others’ suffering but wary of
exacerbating or exploiting it. Yet these critiques of photography, and the
larger media culture in which it is embedded, may be overestimating the ill
effects of mass-mediated pain. Sontag herself came to revise her position on
these matters, writing that “such images cannot be more than an invitation to
pay attention, to reflect, to learn” (Sontag 2003, 117). She went on to provide
an interesting rationale for criticisms such as her earlier ones: “The
frustration of not being able to do anything about what the images show may
be translated into an accusation of the indecency of regarding such images, or
the indecencies of the way such images are disseminated—flanked, as they
may well be, by advertising for emollients, pain relievers, and SUVs. If we
could do something about what the images show, we might not care so much
about these issues” (Sontag 2003, 117). These remarks offer an alternative
take on consumer culture’s relation to suffering and disaster and the ethical
condemnations surrounding them. Seen in this light, the consumption of
catastrophe signifies less of a flattening of interest or emotion than a
frustration with distant audiences’ fundamentally limited possibilities for
understanding and action. No matter how intimate their images, or how
spectacular their broadcasts, disasters remain immeasurably complex, and
others’ suffering remains, in a way, inscrutable to its distant observers.
Nonetheless, as the phrase “consuming catastrophe” suggests, I believe
that consumption is an appropriate rubric with which to assess and understand
the predominant ways of experiencing crisis and catastrophe today. Raymond
Williams (1985, 78) has pointed out that the earliest English uses of the word
“consume” came with negative connotations of destruction, using up, or
wasting. In this sense, the consumption of disaster refers not only to the fact
that disaster-related products, services, and media are increasingly available
for purchase but also to the fact that the heavily mediated experience of
disaster in a consumer society involves using up the raw material of human
tragedy, devouring the spectacular, tragic, and even the mundane aspects of
catastrophes. Although the suffering they caused may persist, and the work of
rebuilding may remain undone, once disasters lose their novelty or their
resonance, one can expect to see fewer reminders of them on the evening
news, in TV or magazine advertisements, and on the shelves of stores.
The raw material that gets consumed in this process of covering,
packaging, and consuming a disaster is its authenticity. The contemporary
usage of authenticity is generally fraught with contradictory interpretations,
but I take authenticity to refer to the perceived quality of being unique,
genuine, or, for lack of a better term, real. Although the difference between
authentic and inauthentic sometimes seems natural—a home-cooked meal
with locally produced ingredients seems more authentic than a meal at a fast-
food chain, just as live news footage of a flooded New Orleans seems more
authentic than a Hollywood disaster film—authenticity ultimately refers to
subjective, aesthetic distinctions rather than to any quality intrinsic to
commodities, texts, or images. It is a social construct, but one that reveals
much about American values, desires, and fears. Disasters tend to attract
large numbers of viewers and consumers based on the perception that they
are much more real than the rest of what is available in contemporary media
culture. Each disaster strikes us as new and immediate, creative in its unique
pattern of destruction. Yet each also strikes primal emotional chords and
reminds us of ancient calamities. What is more, we know that disasters affect
real people and real communities and that ‘but for the grace of God’ we could
be victims of a similar fate.
In consumer culture today, such perceived authenticity is incredibly
valuable and highly sought after by all sorts of companies precisely because
it can inspire powerful emotional responses from otherwise jaded or detached
audiences. For instance, the management consultants Jim Gilmore and Joe
Pine have published a widely read guide entitled Authenticity: What
Consumers Really Want that teaches companies how to “manage the
perceptions of real and fake held by the consumers of your enterprise’s
output—because people increasingly make purchase decisions based on how
real or fake they perceive various offerings” (Gilmore and Pine 2007, xi).
Scholars such as Sarah Banet-Weiser (2012) have tracked the results of this
increasing commercial focus on the somewhat nebulous notion of
authenticity. Her research confirms that “in the US, the 21st Century is an age
that hungers for anything that feels authentic, just as we lament more and
more that it is a world of inauthenticity, that we are governed by
superficiality” (Banet-Weiser 2012, 3).
How, then, to study such consumption of authenticity? This book
focuses on the texts that are consumed during and after disasters, especially
those associated with factual media, including news, documentary films,
reality television programs, and digital archives. At times throughout the
book, these sources will be supplemented with discussions of other products,
services, and experiences associated with disasters, but the main analytic
focus of each chapter is on a small sample of media texts. After an initial
chapter focusing on the history of disaster-related media, each subsequent
chapter compares texts from two different disasters in the hope of drawing
out the common themes between them and highlighting the differences
among them.
The aim of this approach is to identify the larger meanings and
prevailing cultural norms at work in disaster-related mass culture. Certainly,
any particular text will generate some alternative readings as individual
audience members decode it in oppositional or idiosyncratic ways (see S.
Hall 1980). Still, at a minimum, one can say that media texts reflect the ideas,
norms, and values at work in the culture that produced them. The fact that a
number of news broadcasts, films, advertisements, television shows, and
websites reflect the same small set of norms and values across a variety of
different disasters tells us at least that these ideas were meaningful influences
on the lives of many viewers and consumers. As such, analyzing the texts
through which Americans experienced the disasters of the past decade can
tell us about the norms that guided these experiences.
Of course, too many texts were produced around the four major disasters
covered here to allow for a comprehensive sampling of them. Even a single
disaster such as September 11 generated so much media that a vast array of
scholarship has been devoted just to analyzing the mass media and popular
culture around it (see, e.g., Chermak, Bailey, and Brown 2003; Heller 2005;
Izard and Perkins 2011). But focusing only on September 11 has the potential
to reinforce some flawed conventional wisdom about the uniqueness of that
disaster relative to any other tragic or catastrophic events; this is often
expressed as the idea that September 11 “changed everything.” By contrast,
situating September 11 in a long history of mass-mediated disasters, then
comparing it with the disasters that immediately proceeded it, exposes the
larger normative structures at work around many different instances of mass
mediated suffering, and the continuities between these cases.
This book uses several text-based methods of inquiry to uncover these
continuities. Chapter 2 employs close reading of the narratives at work in
four different texts—two news broadcasts, a documentary film, and a reality
television program. “Narrative texts are packed with sociological
information” (Franzosi 1998, 517), and a close reading of these four texts
shows how narratives about suffering, misfortune, and violence get told in
ways that are meaningful but also problematic. Chapters 3 and 4 use the
methods of discourse analysis to investigate television news broadcasts and
users’ submissions to digital archives, respectively. In both cases, my
analysis focuses on the ways the texts offer “cues in the process of
interpretation” (Fairclough 1989, 24). What scholars engaged in the
somewhat overlapping practices of content analysis, discourse analysis, or
“ethnographic content analysis” (Altheide 1996) all have in common is the
use of documents to systematically “understand the process and meaning of
social activities” (Altheide 1996, 10). The study of texts and discourses can
reveal “how ways of talking in a society simultaneously reflect, constitute,
and reproduce social organization … cultural beliefs … and norms about
everyday living” (Grimshaw 2001, 752). It can even expose the ways “more
powerful groups in society can influence less powerful groups through
cultural models” (Gee 1999, 66). These are the central concerns of this book.
As mentioned, the wide variety of disasters covered here, and the
incredible number of texts representing these disasters that might be studied,
mean that any sampling of texts will necessarily be quite partial. There is no
scientific way to ensure that the sample analyzed here is representative of the
whole. However, in this book, as is common with discourse analytic methods,
I have attempted to keep my interpretations closely aligned with those of the
texts’ authors. I have also attempted to present to the reader many direct
quotations from the texts being analyzed. Both of these elements serve as
checks on the reliability of discourse analytic work such as this (see Potter
1996). Still, rather than traditional social science notions of generalizability
based on random sampling and large sample sizes, the types of qualitative
and textual interpretation in this book might best be understood as aiming for
“transferability.” The term “implies that the results of the research can be
transferred to other contexts and situations beyond the scope of the study”
(Jensen 2008, 887). The way researchers typically establish transferability is
to “describe the context of the case/situation in sufficient detail, so that the
receiver has an appropriate base to make a judgment” (Hellström 2008, 327).
Indeed, “it is the responsibility of the inquirer to provide sufficient base to
permit a person contemplating application in another receiving situation to
make a judgment of similarity” (Lincoln and Guba 1985, 360). My approach,
then, has been to provide a chapter’s worth of historical context in order to
situate the present cases. Within each chapter, I have aimed to provide
enough background information on the disasters and the texts analyzed to
convince readers that the themes and meanings I uncover are present across
these cases and even potentially in cases that have not been studied here.
Such attention to historical context helps reveal that the public appetite
for mass-mediated disasters, and the taste for disaster representations that are
both undeniably real and spectacularly unfamiliar, are important if somewhat
overlooked elements of modernity itself. For instance, although the ancient
destruction of Pompeii left behind only a single eyewitness account, the
rediscovery and excavation of the city in the eighteenth century helped
inspire a host of commodities, from silverware and pottery mimicking ancient
styles to novels dramatizing Pompeii’s last days. Coupled with a devastating
earthquake in Lisbon, Portugal, in 1755, these disasters helped steer
Enlightenment thought toward new understandings of natural disasters that
were secular, scientific, and even occasionally romantic. Subsequent
technological developments in mass production and communication
continued to stoke public appetites for tales and artifacts of disaster, but the
twentieth-century critique of modern culture as conformist and inauthentic
really set the stage for disasters to achieve their contemporary status as
uniquely valuable carriers of authenticity. Walter Benjamin believed that new
forms of mass-producible media, such as photography and film, had
eliminated the authentic existence in a particular time and place characteristic
of the “aura” of older forms of art (Benjamin 1969), while other members of
the Frankfurt school assailed the mass deceptions of the burgeoning “culture
industry” of the 1940s (Horkheimer and Adorno [1944] 2002). But
Benjamin’s earlier writings on the topic portrayed the aura as a sort of specter
of reality that haunted its photographic reproductions (Duttlinger 2008; see
also Benjamin 1999). Thus, one may understand the aura of disaster as the
haunting traces of the real still captured in its many representations. These
traces attract a consumer culture in thrall to such authenticity yet are also
always already in decay as media coverage and mass commodification begin
to transform the disaster into spectacle, kitsch, morality play, or political
platform.
Much of mass-media spectatorship and mass consumption today
involves an exercise in determining the authenticity or genuineness of people,
products, or experiences—be they reality television stars (Andrejevic 2004;
Rose and Wood 2005), tourist sites (Grayson and Martinec 2004),
automobiles (Leigh, Peters, and Shelton 2006), ethnic handicrafts (Wherry
2006), jeans and sneakers (Botterill 2007), or urban neighborhoods (Zukin
2008, 2010). In this same sense, audiences and consumers are tasked with
assessing the authenticity of disaster-related texts and commodities and
balancing potentially inauthentic aspects, such as their mass-produced, for-
profit nature, against the seemingly undeniable kernel of real loss and pain
with which they have been imbued. The results of those assessments of
authenticity tend to determine the level of socially acceptable economic,
emotional, or political investment in these texts and products. Judging from
the sheer amount of disaster-related media and consumption that is discussed
in this book, it appears that although there are a variety of competing
standards concerning the authenticity of disaster-related media and products,
there is certainly no blanket, normative prohibition against the consumption
of catastrophe. For instance, watching the digital videos created by the
Virginia Tech killer Seung-Hui Cho on network television news offered an
authentic, uncensored glimpse into the mind of an alienated young killer for
some viewers or, perhaps, a chance to understand and prevent future school
shootings, while for others the broadcast smacked of a sensationalist ratings
grab that resulted in the glorification of a murderer. In any case, such ethical
debates concerning disaster mediation tend to coalesce today around the
theme of authenticity and the appropriate emotional responses to such
authentic depictions of suffering and pain.
This process of assessing the authenticity and trustworthiness of media
texts also helps audiences and consumers determine their levels of
apprehension over looming risks and future threats. The “risk society” first
envisioned by Ulrich Beck (1992) and Anthony Giddens (1990, 1991)
appears to operate affectively as much as rationally and often in a kind of
retrospective fashion. Rather than being informed of potential disasters and
then acting preventatively, governments, media, and consumers often seem to
only really appreciate a threat that has already materialized as a spectacular
catastrophe. Social responses to such disasters thus tend to look backward, in
an almost nostalgic panic, with the aim of preventing a recurrence of the
same disaster rather than proactively anticipating new and different ones. The
deployment of media frames—persistent discursive principles that structure
social reality and create shared cultural meanings (Reese 2003)—can inspire
widespread public acceptance of government risk claims in the wake of a
disaster or engender fierce political opposition to official policy proposals. In
either case, public understandings of risks and their possible prevention in the
future both rely on and shape normative codes concerning the spectacles of
real suffering generated by mass-mediated disasters. Trust in the risk
assessments of government officials, technical experts, media icons, and
other authority figures is thus a heavily mediated and highly emotional
process.
This affective component of disaster representation, mediation, and
consumption has been somewhat neglected by mainstream sociology. For
instance, sociologists who study disasters have long disputed the
conventional wisdom that mass panic is the usual public response to
disasters, especially on the ground in affected communities (Quarantelli
2001; Tierney 2007). But while it is true that disaster-struck communities
tend to exhibit a whole host of positive, pro-social responses, it does not
mean that mass-media accounts of disaster may not inspire panic in distant
spectators who are less directly affected. Divorced from the kinds of
sustaining, ad hoc, local communities that maintain order and provide support
during and in the immediate aftermath of disasters (see Solnit 2009), those
who merely consume distressing stories and images at a distance may be
more likely to take drastic measures or respond with overwrought emotional
displays. Of course, mass media today tend to operate in crisis mode at all
times, even over seemingly trivial matters (McRobbie and Thornton 1995),
making the shock and immediacy of disaster-related stories an overly familiar
style of communication, and thus potentially contributing to the onset of what
has come to be known as “compassion fatigue” (Moeller 1999). However,
American audiences of disasters have demonstrated over the past decade that
distant or unaffected spectators are likely to feel that they too have been
vicariously traumatized and thus enfranchised to participate in mass-mediated
rituals of commemoration, or to claim the social and political status of victim
(see Kaplan 2005; Savage 2006).
Such vicarious emotional connections to disasters and their distant
victims are increasingly common today, and one of the most powerful,
emergent norms in this regard is the obligation to show empathy toward those
directly affected. Media texts have particular ways to present the suffering of
others, designed to draw out these reactions, which engender a kind of
empathetic gaze rooted in reality television but now transcending that genre.
This stylized or idealized empathy for the suffering of distant others is
rehearsed today even in non-disaster-related media programming, but it is
particularly prevalent when large-scale tragedies result not only in live
television news broadcasts but also in the many commemorative events and
product sales that are supposed to benefit those distant others. Consuming
such experiences and products marks one as a moral person with the capacity
to understand the pain of others. Unlike classical forms of Enlightenment
sympathy, however, in which detached spectators sought to actually alleviate
the suffering of unfortunate others whose causes they found worthy, the
empathy on display when one buys a Virginia Tech T-shirt or a record that
benefits New Orleans musicians, or when one watches television programs
devoted to these disasters, seems to be as much about self-improvement as
about the improvement of the conditions of those who are less fortunate. This
can be thought of as a kind of empathetic hedonism inasmuch as there is
pleasure to be gained in attempting to imagine what others are feeling—even
if those feelings are painful. This is not to say that such consumption is not
driven by sincere concern for disaster victims, but simply that mass culture
tends to direct such concern toward viewing habits and consumption
practices that help the self-image of the viewer or purchaser at least as much
as they help any disaster-stricken communities.
The consumption of disaster thus encourages a kind of “political
anesthesia” (Szasz 2007) that reduces one’s ability to recognize the collective
solutions to problems, as well as one’s willingness to work toward them. As
Andrew Szasz (2007, 4) puts it, “A person who buys some products because
those products promise to shield them from trouble is not at that moment a
political actor. He or she is, instead, in the modality of a consumer.” While
that distinction may be too sharp, the authentically threatening quality of
disasters does often nurture a paradoxically fantastic desire to secure the
safety of oneself and one’s family through private acts of consumerism.
These fantasies are often backward-looking; they envision the next disaster as
a similar chain of events that, having recently happened, is actually unlikely
to happen again due either to officialdom’s new awareness of the problem or
simply to the remote odds of two similar disasters happening in such close
succession. Of course, in the current American political moment of ascendant
neoliberal governance, such individualistic strategies of preventative
consumption may constitute the only measures being taken on one’s behalf.
These atomizing tendencies of consumerism have even fed back into
norms surrounding creative new forms of online experience. Rather than
promoting a simple one-way consumption of information, the Internet
increasingly encourages various types of digital content co-creation, which
are often referred to as prosumption because they blur traditional distinctions
between producers and consumers. New forms of media witnessing that rely
on raw, incidentally recorded footage of disasters and tragedies may at times
disrupt elite news framing strategies (Frosh and Pinchevski 2014; McCosker
2013). And new sites of collective memory such as digital archives and
online memorials similarly empower consumers to become active, creative
collaborators in the process of memorializing disasters. Yet despite the
communal nature of many online efforts at commemoration, the messages
collected there are frequently exercises in therapeutic self-help, in which the
act of reading or writing a message serves as a form of psychic healing for
oneself rather than for the community of other contributors. Such digital
forms of commemoration can also end up encouraging a kind of nationalistic
pride concerning the nostalgic or heroic aspects of disaster responses, while
abetting a national forgetting of a disaster’s more shameful elements and the
persistent social inequalities that such disasters often magnify.
This book seeks, then, to develop a model of disaster consumption that
holds true across diverse types of contemporary crises or catastrophes. In this
model, a disaster and the texts and commodities it generates stand out from
the normal flow of mass media and popular culture because they are
generally perceived as more authentic. This authenticity allows otherwise
skeptical consumers to invest genuine emotion in the media coverage of the
disaster, as well as in subsequent acts of consumption devoted to displaying
patriotism, securing one’s home, expressing empathy, enacting therapeutic
self-help, or any of the other goals and motivations of disaster consumerism.
It also encourages many of the kinds of economic or political “capitalizing”
described earlier in this Introduction. As time passes and images and
commodities from the disaster become increasingly commonplace, one sees a
disaster’s authenticity itself become increasingly consumed or used up. In
this period, with its aura of sacredness diminished, critical, oppositional, or
ironic responses to the disaster become more socially acceptable, and the risk
claims and emotional reactions that the disaster had inspired become subject
to retrospective scrutiny. This has certainly been the case with September 11
—writers at Time and Vanity Fair declared an end to the “age of irony” in the
weeks following the attacks (Nunberg 2001), but less than a decade later,
satirical pieces such as The Onion’s were fairly commonplace. Still, a trace of
that reality, an aura, tends to haunt disaster texts and commodities long after
those tragic events have dulled in our memories.
That is not to say, however, that all disasters are perceived as equally
authentic. Implicit in the very act of witnessing others’ suffering—or, at least,
in the use of the term “witnessing” to describe some kind of direct or
mediated experience of suffering—is a value judgment on what kinds of
experiences, media, and rhetoric are more truthful, objective, or genuine (J.
D. Peters 2001). Although there is always a degree of uncertainty about the
veracity of any testimony, John Durham Peters reminds us that society tends
to privilege “being there” over simply watching an event unfold via live
media transmission or visiting the site where an event transpired in the past.
When one merely watches the recording of an already transpired event, he
argues, “the attitude of witnessing is hardest to sustain” (J. D. Peters 2001,
720). While the description of a hierarchy of witnessing and spectatorship is a
useful starting point, the research in this book suggests that even recordings
of disaster or disaster-related souvenirs can be weighted with much the same
historicity as actual disaster sites and genuine artifacts. Such a connection to
real human suffering, in fact, is another way to understand what makes
disaster-related media and commodities appear genuine in the first place. For
this reason, our understandings of these phenomena need to move beyond the
assumption that a spectator’s spatial or temporal distance from an event
necessarily limits the authenticity of his or her experiences and emotions.
The geographical distance of spectators is, after all, largely immaterial
when they are subject to the kinds of “disaster marathon” (Blondheim and
Liebes 2002; Liebes 1998) television coverage in which normal routines and
programming are dropped in favor of a spontaneous focus on calamitous
events across multiple channels and platforms. The communication scholars
Elihu Katz and Tamar Liebes argue that media coverage of disasters and
accidents has become more influential today than coverage of staged “media
events” such as coronation ceremonies and athletic contests. However, they
suggest that these newly ascendant disasters are “disruptive” forces, “out of
the reach of establishment control” (Katz and Liebes 2007, 164), in contrast
to the “integrative” influence of staged and ceremonial media events. This
book suggests otherwise. At least as far as distant audiences and consumers
are concerned, the most seemingly disruptive, destructive, shocking, and
unprecedented disasters may exert the most integrative, unifying influence,
and provide the most leverage for elites looking to profit from the apparent
chaos. And that fact makes them all the more dangerous.
1

A HISTORY OF CATASTROPHE

Media, Mass Culture, and Authenticity

T he emotional effects of tragic works of art have been a source of debate


at least since the ancient Greeks. Plato feared the irrational emotions stirred
up by tragic poetry, while Aristotle argued that such works brought about a
necessary emotional release, or catharsis, that left audiences at ease in its
aftermath. Much later, the English literary critic A. D. Nuttall (1996)
suggested that viewing tragedies gave audiences pleasure because it allowed
them to prepare themselves for the real horrors they might one day confront
and the psychic anguish those horrors might cause. However, all of those
notions of tragedy had one thing in common: the tragedies in question were
fictional. As Nuttall (1996, 83) put it, “Traditionally, most of the answers
offered to the question ‘Why does tragedy give pleasure?’ have been founded
on the essential unreality of tragic drama, on our implicit awareness that what
we are looking at is a representation and not the thing itself.”
The tragedies that we view today—the big ones that bring us together
around television sets, that keep us glued to smart phones and computer
screens, that monopolize the newspaper headlines, that inspire grand
monuments as well as cheap memorabilia—are all too real. The history of
mass media is, among other things, one of increasingly timely and intimate
exposure to disasters, catastrophes, and other real-life misfortunes, and a state
of uncertainty about the appropriateness of viewing others’ suffering has
been a consistent feature of modern life. Thus, the stakes are higher today
than they were for the ancient Greeks as they puzzled over the appeal of a
literary genre. Our fascination with the fates of the others whom we so
frequently view or read about as they suffer through disasters is both more
understandable and more ethically dubious precisely because we know or
presume that the pain we see is genuine, not simulated. And yet that has not
dissuaded the ever growing numbers who have come to consume
catastrophes in the modern era. Disasters have remained an important topic
for media and consumption in part because they speak to a host of modern
anxieties about the self, individuality, reason, emotion, progress, authority,
and community.
There have, however, been important changes to the ways that publics
have come to know of tragic or catastrophic events over the past three
centuries. Four related phenomena have combined in that time to create the
current cultural climate toward disaster: a gradual loss of confidence in
various public and private arenas of authenticity, be they art, mass
communication, or individual sentiment; a growing awareness on the part of
the press, the advertising industry, and governments of the need to address
this lack of confidence in their dealings with the public; developments in
mass communication that have increased the speed, clarity, and variety with
which consumers receive information and entertainment; and the growing
exposure to distant, suffering others that results from those developments.
This chapter provides a historical overview of the mass mediation and
consumption of modern disasters and the norms about authenticity and
emotional expression that have developed around the misfortune of others.
From the discovery of Pompeii’s ancient ruins in 1748 to the earthquake in
Charleston, South Carolina, of 1886; the sinking of the Titanic in 1912; the
assassination of John F. Kennedy in 1963; the space shuttle Challenger
disaster in 1986; and the death of Princess Diana in 1997, this chapter looks
at the ways disasters have shaped and been shaped by modern mass culture.
Despite the tremendous changes in mass media and consumer culture over
the hundreds of years covered here, some common features of disasters’
mediation and consumption have persisted. I argue that disasters have been,
and remain today, such powerful forces in mass culture precisely because of
their undeniable connection to the real. Modernity has broken down a whole
host of traditions and institutions, and as it has called into question the
authenticity of our selves and our connections to others, disasters have
offered a chance to really feel for suffering others and to publicly
demonstrate that feeling. As modernity has made death a less frequent and
less visible presence in daily life (see Ariès 1974; Becker 1973), disasters
remind us of the real fragility of human existence and the vicarious
excitement of survival in the face of catastrophe. As modernity has made
publics increasingly wary of, and savvy about, the staged and simulated
character of mass culture, disasters have generated media texts and cultural
products that feel more genuine and more trustworthy than others. All of this
depends on a claim to the real that sets disasters apart from other subjects of
mass media and consumption.
Of course, this claim to reality is not necessarily “real” in and of itself.
Rather, it is contingent on cultural and aesthetic codes that change over time
with the emergence of new media technologies as they alter common-sense
beliefs about what sorts of things in a mass-mediated social world are still
genuine. In this way, a televised news report from the site of a disaster, or a
moving documentary about its aftermath, or the handwritten note left behind
by one of its victims, or a blog post written on its first anniversary may all be
said to contain a kind of authenticity that allows audiences to grieve as if they
were also affected, to fear as if they may still be, or to exalt that they were
not. However, that trace of the real is frequently watered down through the
persistent reproduction of images, stories, and products that accompany many
disasters, to the point that media devoted to even the deadliest or most
catastrophic events eventually lose much of their perceived authenticity. Still,
the minute traces of the real associated with disaster-related images and
commodities can be enough to inspire all sorts of emotional responses,
political decisions, and life choices. Consuming catastrophe gives us the
exhilaration of coming close to real pain and real death but always from the
safety of some mediated distance.
In this way, disasters can be said to have a kind of “aura,” similar to
Walter Benjamin’s (1969) term for the unique and absorbing presence of
classical works of art. Although Benjamin sometimes suggested that this aura
had been destroyed by modern, mass-produced art forms such as photography
and film, his earliest work contained a less restrictive view of the term (see
Duttlinger 2008; Hansen 2008). This book argues that, indeed, the aura of
disaster persists even as it is mass produced. That aura stems from the
connection to real pain and suffering at the heart of disaster-related texts and
commodities. Such a connection draws viewers in; it invites and even
demands their contemplation. It has done so since the earliest shipwreck
narratives were printed in the sixteenth century, and it continues to do so
today. Yet the aura of disaster produces a kind of distance from the audience,
as well. It absorbs viewers but is always just out of reach. As distant
spectators we never truly know what it is like to survive an earthquake, or to
escape a terrorist attack, or to be trapped in a flooded city, no matter how
vividly or in how timely a fashion these events are communicated to us.
Thus, throughout history, disaster-related media and culture have
revealed as much about the ineffability of others’ suffering as they have about
the ever increasing frequency and intimacy with which we are exposed to it.
This just-out-of-reach sense of the real meaning or genuine experience of
mass-mediated disaster helps explain how disasters generate more and more
consumption, spurring us to more reading, listening, viewing, purchasing,
and downloading of disaster-related texts and products. Such a quality has
made disasters and disaster consumption a potent force inspiring communal
sentiments across great distances and among diverse peoples since the dawn
of modernity. It also makes disasters powerful tools in the hands of elites
looking to steer a frightful, angry, or mourning public in useful or profitable
directions.

Pompeii, Lisbon, and the Emergence of the Public Sphere


On August 24, 79 C.E., the eruption of Mount Vesuvius destroyed the ancient
cities of Pompeii and Herculaneum. While hundreds and perhaps thousands
of people died in those cities and the surrounding villas and towns as a result
of the eruption, only one eyewitness account has survived to the present day.
Almost thirty years after the events, the Roman historian Tacitus asked his
friend and student Pliny the Younger to write about the death of his uncle,
Pliny the Elder, during the eruption of Vesuvius as source material for
Tacitus’s own historical work. Although the portion of Tacitus’s Histories
covering these events has not survived, Pliny the Younger’s two letters on the
subject have (Moser 2007). While these accounts were undoubtedly read by
some Romans at the time, nothing that might be called consumption of this
catastrophe occurred on a large scale in its immediate aftermath. The Roman
Senate authorized some efforts to recover vaults and other valued property
from the ruins of Pompeii to finance disaster relief for survivors, but the
cities remained mostly buried and faded from memory until their rediscovery
more than 1,600 years later (Pellegrino 2004; Stewart 2006).
Like the ancient art and artifacts that for centuries they held secret, the
ruins of Pompeii and Herculaneum exhibit a classical sense of the aura. Only
a handful of copies of the one surviving eyewitness account existed in
various European monasteries for many centuries (Moser 2007). There is a
temporal gap between the calamitous events that unfolded there and the
contemporary observer of the ruins that cannot be bridged; it is “the unique
phenomenon of a distance, however close it may be,” as Benjamin (1969,
222) might describe it. In Pompeii, evidence of life and death intertwine.
Amid graffiti on the side of a brothel and footprints left by children outside a
school, one finds ghostly figures trapped in their death poses. But even these
are not actual human remains. Rather, they are plaster and cement
impressions made by filling pockets of ash where human remains had once
been. One can know Pompeii and Herculaneum only through the traces
scattered around its ruins, traces that invite the kind of deep contemplation
associated with high art. Pompeii absorbs the visitor and returns his gaze, as
Mark Twain put it when describing his visit in 1875:

[I] went dreaming among the trees … of this city which perished …
till a shrill whistle and the cry of “All aboard—last train to Naples!”
reminded me that I belonged to the 19th century, and [that I] was
not a dusty mummy, caked with cinders and ashes, 1,800 years old.
The transition was startling. The idea of a railroad train actually
running to old dead Pompeii, and whistling irreverently, and calling
for passengers in the most bustling and business-like way, was as
strange a thing as one could imagine, and as unpoetical and
disagreeable as it was strange. (Quoted in Pellegrino 2004, 147)

Twain’s description suggests the unique power of this place to evoke


contemplation, not only of what happened there centuries ago, but of one’s
own time and place as well.
That is not to say, however, that the experience of Pompeii remains as it
was on the day that the ruins were first discovered. When Pompeii and
Herculaneum were finally unearthed between 1738 and 1748, they emerged
in a context in which mass media and mass consumption were growing social
phenomena. The sites quickly became tourist destinations for wealthy
Europeans, thanks to numerous published descriptions of their excavation.
Victorian architects adopted the Roman styles found at Pompeii and
Herculaneum in buildings as diverse as Washington’s Capitol Building,
California’s Getty estate, and Buckingham Palace’s “Pompeiian Room.”
Thomas Jefferson designed silverware based on what he had seen recovered
from the sites during a visit to Italy. Josiah Wedgwood’s popular ceramics
reproduced frescoes and sculptural scenes found in Herculaneum’s Villa of
the Papyri (Pellegrino 2004; Stewart 2006). This resurgence of interest in
Ancient Rome also led to a renewed awareness of Roman law and philosophy
among men such as Jefferson, George Washington, and Benjamin Franklin,
resulting in the heavy Greco-Roman influence on American political
philosophy (Pellegrino 2004).
The eighteenth century’s fascination with Pompeii and Herculaneum
coincided to a large extent with the devastation in 1755 of Lisbon, Portugal,
by a powerful earthquake. Three main shocks and the resultant tsunami and
fires combined to kill between 10,000 and 15,000 out of a population of
275,000 (Kendrick 1956). The discovery of Pompeii and Herculaneum
followed by the Lisbon earthquake served to shake the religious and
philosophical foundations of all of Europe (Davis 1999), thanks especially to
the ways in which print media responded to the seemingly apocalyptic Lisbon
tragedy. Many tracts and sketches were printed describing the terrifying ruins
of Lisbon, and eyewitness accounts of the disaster were spread across the
continent through newspapers and pamphlets. These helped to create “the
illusion of proximity and unity among the peoples of different European
nations” (Araújo 2006, para. 1) and led many central Europeans to convince
themselves that they had also felt the earth shake on the day of the
earthquake.
A mass-mediated public sphere began to emerge in which new, modern
ideas about the causes and meanings of natural disasters appeared to
challenge traditional or superstitious beliefs. Lisbon had been widely
perceived as a pious city, and the long-standing religious view that natural
disasters represented God’s vengeance failed to hold sway for many educated
Europeans. Instead, Enlightenment thinkers such as Voltaire, and later
Immanuel Kant, used the earthquake to argue against the philosophical
optimism of the past and to encourage explanations of seismic activity that
were scientific rather than supernatural (Dynes 1998). Much has been made
of the way the Lisbon earthquake helped to usher in Enlightenment thought,
but what is less frequently emphasized is the way in which early forms of
mass consumption helped steer this process. Voltaire’s novel Candide, a
continuation of themes explored in his “Poem on the Lisbon Disaster,” used
the Lisbon earthquake and other tragedies to emphasize a more skeptical
view of divine Providence. It sold 20,000–30,000 copies in the first year it
was published, despite its denunciation by the Catholic Church (Mason
1992). News of the tragedy reached Europeans not only through Voltaire’s
philosophical writings but also through the somewhat sensational accounts
disseminated by the press. Just as with the rediscovery of Pompeii and
Herculaneum, the public’s desire to be informed dovetailed with its desire to
be entertained or to vicariously experience what life had been like during (in
the Lisbon case) or before (in the case of the ancient cities) a natural disaster.
In both cases, forms of consumption emerged to stoke and satisfy those
desires.
The Lisbon earthquake has been called the first modern disaster, not only
because it was part of an Enlightenment effort to supplant religious
explanations of natural phenomena with reasoned, scientific ones. The ability
of elites to capitalize on the earthquake through standardized urban planning
and aggressive rebuilding marked another fundamentally modern response to
disaster, exhibited for the first time in Lisbon. Portugal’s secretary of state,
the Marques de Pombal, used the disaster as an opportunity not only to
modernize the city’s structures but also to cement his own power and
reputation. He engineered the execution of a rival, Gabriel Malagrida;
expelled the Jesuits from Portugal; and essentially ruled Portugal until the
king’s death in 1777 (Kendrick 1956; Rozario 2007). Furthermore, a third
current of modern thought pulsed through the debates around the Lisbon
quake: anti-modern backlash. Rousseau argued that Voltaire’s views on
Lisbon robbed survivors of the comforts of Providence. He also argued, in
what Russell Dynes (2000) contends is the first social science view of
disaster, that reckless buildup of overcrowded urban areas caused the terrible
effects of the earthquake, not God or nature.
Despite the increase in mass-produced accounts of disasters such as the
Lisbon earthquake, the experience of disasters in the eighteenth century
maintained much that might traditionally be described as authentic. Only
those present at the precise time and place knew the real effects of the Lisbon
earthquake or any other disaster. The resulting destruction and ruins were
also really knowable only to those who lived near or traveled to that place to
see the aftermath. Reproduced drawings and printed firsthand accounts
certainly did become available after the fact, but with nothing near the
immediacy that later mass-media technologies would allow. Indeed, despite
the growing public appetite for depictions of catastrophe, disasters retained
their unique presence in time and space, their ability to elicit a kind of
contemplative spectatorship, and their stubborn, tantalizing refusal to reveal
all their secrets to distant viewers.
Mass production of printed materials thus allowed for the dissemination
of accounts of the suffering of others to an expanding number of readers, but
to truly experience the kinds of sympathetic identification with sufferers
lauded by Enlightenment thinkers, one still had to imagine oneself in the role
of the sufferer (Adam Smith [1790] 2009; see Boltanski 1999). The Romantic
movement associated with Jean-Jacques Rousseau provided the imaginative,
emotional inspiration behind both the rising levels of consumer desire that
accompanied developments in mass production of the late eighteenth and
early nineteenth centuries and the increasing relevance of the suffering of
others in the development of modern mass communication. For Rousseau,
compassion consisted of man’s “innate repugnance to see his kind suffer”
(Rousseau 1997, 152). As a basic emotional response, such feeling for the
plight of others was “so Natural that even the Beasts sometimes show evident
signs of it” (Rousseau 1997, 152). Yet this commiseration with the situation
of suffering others varied “in proportion as the Onlooking animal identifies
more intimately with the suffering animal” (Rousseau 1997, 153).
Philosophers such as David Hume and Adam Smith also extolled the
virtues of sympathy, although their definitions varied. Hume conceived of
sympathy mainly as the communication or transfer of an emotion from one
individual to another, a process of coming to feel what another feels (Mercer
1972). “As in strings equally wound up, the motion of one communicates
itself to the rest; so all the affectations readily pass from one person to
another, and beget correspondent movements in every human creature”
(Hume 1874, 335). Smith viewed sympathy as an act of imagining oneself in
another’s place: “The compassion of the spectator must arise altogether from
the consideration of what he himself would feel if he was reduced to the same
unhappy situation, and, what perhaps is impossible, was at the same time able
to regard it with his present reason and judgment” (Adam Smith 1869, 12).
Among the general literate public, the eighteenth century’s cult of sensibility
privileged “susceptibility to tender feelings” and “an ability to enter into the
sufferings of others” (C. Campbell 1987, 140).
Thus, while governments began to see disasters as objects of scientific
knowledge and opportunities for enlarged development or expanded powers,
modern consumers came to view them as chances to experience emotion and
to reaffirm their own sincerity. The powerful emotional character of this
emerging system of mass consumption ensured that disasters would remain a
popular topic for the press and other entrepreneurs. Jürgen Habermas’s image
of a “private people come together as a public” to engage authorities in
reasoned debate “over the general rules governing relations in the basically
privatized but publicly relevant sphere of commodity exchange and social
labor” (Habermas 2001, 27) remains the dominant conception of the
eighteenth-century public sphere. Yet his account neglects many of the kinds
of affective or non-rational communication that have always constituted an
important part of public discourse (see Bickford 2011; Crossley 1998;
Petersen 2011; Vetlesen 1994). As we have seen, the bourgeois public sphere
that emerged in the eighteenth century was not limited to the sorts of
everyday economic and political discussions most commonly associated with
Habermas’s theory: disasters, crises, misfortunes, and the suffering of distant
others were central topics of discussion there, although these literate publics
frequently disagreed about the moral and ethical acceptability of such
macabre subjects (see Boltanski 1999). As new media technologies
developed in the nineteenth century that made accounts of others’ suffering
an increasingly frequent and vivid presence within social life, such
disagreements were magnified.

Sensationalism and Shock


Newspapers changed a great deal in the nineteenth century, thanks to
declining paper costs, new color printing technologies, enhancements in the
speed of delivery, and the invention of the electric telegraph (J. Campbell
2001). The telegraph made long-distance communication at nearly
instantaneous speeds, far surpassing the pace of an actual letter carrier, a
reality. Gathering news via telegraph allowed newspapers to achieve
previously unthinkable levels of timeliness. Before then, information about
an event such as the Revolutionary War was discovered by the press through
no method more organized than the haphazard arrival of private letters and
official or semiofficial messages (Mott 1962). The telegraph changed all that,
but initially, at least in the United States, inexpensive daily newspapers such
as the New York Sun were the only papers to really use it. Selling on the street
rather than by subscription, and for a reduced price, meant the penny press
had to print news that was more timely and eye-catching than that of its more
up-scale competitors. The penny press focused on crimes and scandals,
leading to widespread criticism by the establishment press of the 1830s. Still,
by the 1880s this focus had become typical of most major papers in cities
such as New York, and use of the telegraph to relay information to
newspaper publishers was commonplace (Schudson 1978).
One of the first major American disasters to be relayed to the public with
the aid of the telegraph was the 1886 earthquake in Charleston, South
Carolina. The powerful quake damaged a majority of the buildings in
Charleston and killed more than a hundred people, while the rest of the city’s
inhabitants fled to the streets. More than forty thousand people were still
sleeping outside a week after the quake, as severe aftershocks continued
(“Three Shocks Yesterday” 1886). The initial earthquake was felt as far away
as Boston, Milwaukee, and Bermuda (T. Steinberg 2000). The morning after,
telegraph linemen were dispatched to repair the lines and return telegraph
service to the city. In less than a day, the lines were repaired, and reports of
the disaster went out across the region and the country (L. C. Hall 1902). A
week later, a telegram concerning the possible geological causes of the
earthquake was sent over the newly laid transatlantic cable and read at the
British Science Association in London (“Three Shocks Yesterday” 1886).
Rather than simply learning the facts about the destruction, some
Americans sought a more intimate experience of the earthquake. George
LaGrange Cook sold copies of nearly two hundred different photographs
depicting the destruction of Charleston to curious consumers (Teal 2001),
though the taste for such photos had perhaps already been stoked—or, at
least, the taboo against them had been mitigated—by Matthew Brady’s
gruesome pictures of Civil War battlefields (see Sontag 2003). Visitors
traveled to Charleston from all over the East Coast to see for themselves the
spectacular devastation (T. Steinberg 2000), but unlike the disaster tourism
surrounding ancient sites such as Pompeii, Charleston’s tourists descended on
the city mere days or weeks after the disaster struck.
Just as some had viewed the Lisbon earthquake as a chance to improve
on the city’s backward provincialism (Dynes 1998), the business community
of Charleston emphasized that the earthquake was a chance to renew the city,
to wash away “decadence” and attract rural merchants to the “newest old city
in the Union” (Doyle 1990, 171). Still others saw the quake as a chance to
reassert white supremacy in the face of post–Civil War gains made by blacks
and, especially, post-earthquake gains made by black tradesmen, who saw a
windfall during the city’s early reconstruction. In response, within three years
Charleston’s leading moderate white politician had been murdered, and its
white citizens had passed laws legalizing segregation and disenfranchising
black voters (Williams and Hoffius 2011).
Public interest in disasters was certainly not created by the telegraph,
however, nor was it apparent only within journalism. Disaster had also
become a recurrent theme in works of fiction in the early nineteenth century,
as in Jean-Baptiste Cousin de Grainville’s Le Dernier Homme (1805) and the
subsequent work that it inspired, Mary Shelley’s three-volume epic The Last
Man (1826). Both novels presented apocalyptic scenarios of human
extinction (Davis 1999). Edward Bulwer-Lytton’s dramatic novel The Last
Days of Pompeii enjoyed phenomenal success in 1834, when another
eruption by Vesuvius preceded its publication by only a few months
(Simmons 1969). It remains one of the most popular disaster novels of all
time (see Davis 1999). But the press took the bulk of the early criticism for
the seemingly growing public appetite for bad news. As early as 1800,
William Wordsworth bemoaned the daily and hourly reports of
“extraordinary incidents” that were commonplace in modern urban living,
and Baudelaire made similar complaints in 1863 about the glut of newspaper
reporting on wars, crimes, and other horrors (quoted in Sontag 2003).
By the mid-nineteenth century, the thirst for timely news of disasters that
had begun to reveal itself a century before in the widely consumed accounts
of Lisbon, and probably even a century before that with the publication of
shipwreck narratives (see Huntress 1974), was associated with the telegraph’s
ability to transmit information almost instantaneously. But the accusation of
journalistic “sensationalism” that emerged in this period did not refer
primarily to the speed with which news was delivered. According to Michael
Schudson, such criticisms of the press focused instead on the style in which
the news was displayed. “Sensationalism meant self-advertisement …
anything about newspaper layout and newspaper policy, outside of basic
news gathering, which is designed to attract the eye and a small change of
readers” (Schudson 1978, 95). In addition to the standard tales of crime and
misfortune, this penchant for self-advertisement was reflected in the aesthetic
experiments of newspapers with larger fonts for headlines, imaginative
illustrations and photographs, and bold layouts in which one story took over
the whole front page (J. Campbell 2001). Newspapers became consumer
goods, as concerned with advertising themselves and increasing their ad
revenues as with reporting the day’s events. Progressives also seized on this
growing taste for the sensational in a variety of “muckraking” books,
newspaper exposés, and magazine articles. Although these texts assembled a
large national audience around important political issues, they hinted at a
growing susceptibility to spectacle among the public (Ewen 1996). The label
“sensationalist” also had implications for news consumers; it suggested that
readers’ or spectators’ interests in a particular calamity were maudlin or
voyeuristic, concerned with tawdry emotions or vicarious thrills rather than
reasoned deliberation of facts.
Enthusiasm for natural disasters continued to grow among the American
public at the dawn of the twentieth century, and Americans often found
themselves reveling in tales of fires, hurricanes, and earthquakes. Even many
survivors of such calamities declared the experiences exhilarating (Rozario
2007). Stores in New York sold a booklet that served as a key to the fire
department’s bell system; it allowed curious onlookers to find their way to
the scene of a fire just by listening to the fire bells (Schudson 1978). Other
novel forms of disaster consumption were developing, as well. From 1904 to
1911, various Coney Island amusements centered on reenactments of famous
disasters such as the Johnstown, Pennsylvania, flood of 1889; the Galveston,
Texas, hurricane of 1900; the volcanic eruption of Mount Pelée in Martinique
in 1902; and a ride in which firefighters had to save people trapped in
simulated New York tenement fires (Sandy 2001; T. Steinberg 2000). The
film industry has also been involved in the depiction of disaster almost since
its inception. One early British film, The Launch of the H.M.S. Albion (1898),
captured the real-life drowning of thirty-four people when a landing collapsed
during the ship’s launch. It became the subject of much controversy when
another film producer at the scene wrote an editorial against its exhibition.
While documentary footage of real disasters remained a rarity for some time
thereafter, real-life catastrophes remained the inspiration for many films.
Bulwer-Lytton’s dramatic account of Pompeii’s destruction was the most
filmed novel of the early years of cinema, with four movie versions made
between 1903 and 1919, although they were not American productions
(Davis 1999). The American film industry began to depict disasters as well,
and the American Biograph Company even produced a fake documentary on
the San Francisco earthquake and fire of 1906 by building a miniature city
out of cardboard and setting it ablaze (Rozario 2007).
The invention and widespread popularity of radio telegraphy and motion
pictures at the beginning of the twentieth century, coupled with the steady
rise of consumer culture in general, would seem to have threatened the
disaster’s unique presence in time and space. What might have come to
replace this aura, according to Benjamin, was “shock.” Aesthetic experience
in the age of mechanically reproduced art such as cinema replaced the
contemplative immersion of classical art with a disorienting form of almost
tactile experience. The constant flicker of images that simulate motion in the
cinema, and the various edits between those sets of images, provided
Benjamin with an analogue to modern urban living. “The spectator’s process
of association in view of these images is indeed interrupted by their constant,
sudden change,” he wrote. “This constitutes the shock effect of the film”
(Benjamin 1969, 238). In one note on the “Work of Art” essay, Benjamin
compared this shock effect to a man on a street in city traffic and argued that
“the film is the art form that is in keeping with the increased threat to his life
which modern man has to face. Man’s need to expose himself to shock
effects is his adjustment to the dangers threatening him” (Benjamin 1969,
250n19). He also drew comparisons between the sensory shock effect of new
communication technologies and the moral shock effect of Dadaist artwork,
with its obscene collages and crude, anti-art stance. The critique of
sensationalism combines precisely these two forms of shock: sensory and
moral. As new technologies of mass communication make possible new
forms of human sensory experience, they also allow the dissemination of new
kinds of information that many find unsettling or offensive. The effect is a
kind of disorientation, “an experience of estrangement which then requires
recomposition and readjustment” (Vattimo 1992, 51). But although aura and
shock are often set in opposition to each other, with shock being the
sensationalist antidote to the aura’s more careful form of spectatorship, many
important twentieth-century disasters demonstrate a kind of coexistence
between these two aesthetic concepts.

The Titanic as Archetype of Disaster Consumption


One of the most famous disasters in history, the sinking of the Titanic, first
shocked the American public via the new technology of wireless telegraphy.
At the beginning of the twentieth century, more and more ships were
equipped with this early form of radio in the hopes of preventing maritime
disasters (Barnouw 1966). On April 15, 1912, a twenty-one-year-old
telegraph operator stationed at the Wanamaker’s department store in New
York heard a faint signal coming over the wireless with the message, “S.S.
Titanic ran into iceberg. Sinking fast.” The operator, David Sarnoff, gave the
information to the press, alerted other ships he could reach, and established
communications with the Carpathia after that ship had picked up the
Titanic’s survivors. Sarnoff stayed at his post until a complete list of
survivors had been relayed seventy-two hours later; by that time, the
Wanamaker’s store was filled with policemen holding back a crowd of
reporters, friends and relatives of passengers, and curious onlookers
(Barnouw 1966; Heyer 1995). The event made Sarnoff famous and launched
an illustrious career in which he went on to head the Radio Corporation of
America (RCA) and found the National Broadcasting Company (NBC),
although many now suggest that parts of that story are exaggerated or
apocryphal (see “Sarnoff, David” n.d.).
The Titanic’s almost mythic place in history is taken for granted today,
but it is worth reiterating that the sinking of the unsinkable ship was
enshrined in popular culture through myriad forms of mass consumption
occurring with an unprecedented rapidity relative to previous disasters and
catastrophes (Heyer 1995). A seemingly endless flow of commentary and
reflection began almost as soon as radio waves containing word of its
impending sinking reached the shore. New York newspapers initially
speculated on whether the ship had truly sunk or was simply being towed
back to shore by the Carpathia—initial wireless reports were unclear on this
matter. For instance, the April 15 issue of the Syracuse Herald ran the
headline “Titanic’s Passengers All Rescued” above a giant drawing of
passengers in lifeboats in a choppy sea, with the Titanic looming large in the
background, a broken steam pipe its only visible sign of damage (Groom
2012). By contrast, the New York Times made its journalistic reputation partly
through its coverage of the Titanic, which the paper correctly surmised had
sunk when rival publications were still cautiously optimistic. In its widely
praised coverage, the Times examined a variety of hypothetical scenarios
concerning the crash and rescue and published speculative opinions gleaned
from interviews with maritime experts to tell Titanic’s story before the
Carpathia had even returned (Heyer 1995).
But the story of the Titanic was told, and sold, to the public through
more than just newspapers; survivors’ accounts, novels, poems, plays, songs,
and films relayed the tale to an enthralled audience. The actress Dorothy
Gibson, a real-life Titanic survivor, wrote and starred in a short silent film in
which she retold the story of her escape and rescue to a group of actors
portraying her family. The film was shot in a week and debuted less than a
month after the Titanic had sunk. Literary figures such as Joseph Conrad,
George Bernard Shaw, Arthur Conan Doyle, and Thomas Hardy published a
series of responses to the great tragedy (Heyer 1995). Even the blues legend
Leadbelly performed a song that told a fictional tale about the African
American boxer Jack Johnson being prevented from boarding the doomed
ocean liner by its racist white captain.
In many ways, the Titanic catastrophe has become a kind of archetype of
disaster consumption. Today, new technologies continue to be used to
increase the speed with which information about disasters is transmitted to
the public. News agencies continue to blend speculative elements with factual
news reporting. Firsthand accounts from survivors are still emphasized, and
eye-catching images are given as much prominence as the stories themselves.
Novels, plays, films, and other kinds of pop culture still dramatize or
fictionalize the spectacular events surrounding catastrophes. And strong
emotional reactions from audiences remain important, and expected, in the
consumption of contemporary catastrophes.
As such, it is tempting to see the consumption of the Titanic tragedy
solely as an example of the media’s increasing penchant for shock, spectacle,
and sensationalism. Critics such as Neil Postman (1985) adopt such a view of
all media since the invention of the telegraph, which he argues first placed
immediacy over content and led publics and journalists to eschew careful
exposition in favor of a “peek-a-boo” world of various short-lived events and
sensations. In this view, the decline of the aura of the written word precludes
any meaningful engagement with the social world in general. But there are
also important ways in which the Titanic disaster maintains a kind of
profound and mysterious connection to the real, even with its hyper-mediated
and over-consumed legacy. The ship’s mythic place in modern culture as a
cautionary tale about technologically induced hubris has imbued it with a
kind of ritualistic power. Moreover, the ship’s brief and tragic history has
retroactively endowed the few photographs of it with a kind of haunting,
otherworldly quality. The same can be said for other Titanic memorabilia,
and especially for the sunken ship itself, which remained lost until 1985.
Thus, although the wreckage of the Titanic has since been scoured by both
treasure hunters and Hollywood directors, as in James Cameron’s 3D IMAX
film Ghosts of the Abyss (2003), Postman’s argument rings hollow here. If
the development of electronic communication technologies has stifled certain
possibilities for reasoned exposition—a dubious claim in and of itself—it has
also made possible new forms of identification and emotional connection
with an ever increasing number of distant others, and it has done so in ways
that are not limited to the literate upper classes. Today, anyone can purchase
authentic pieces of coal recovered from the wreck, or reproductions of the
New York Times headlines from its sinking, or original Titanic stock
certificates and at least potentially use these products to reflect more deeply
on the disaster, its continued significance, and the lives of those who perished
there.

Media Panics and the Inauthentic


This democratizing aspect of mass communication and consumption has had
its own critics, however, especially in relation to disasters. As early as 1841,
the journalist Charles Mackay had compiled a historical account of various
“popular delusions” resulting from the gregarious, suggestible nature of
mankind (Mackay [1841] 1980). But with the growth of mass democracy and
the popular press, this penchant for delusion became more problematic.
Gustave Le Bon viewed such behavior as a tendency toward mob mentality
and argued that the throngs of lower-class voters had become a dangerous,
irrational element of democratic society (Le Bon [1895] 1960). Psychologists
such as Sigmund Freud and Wilfred Trotter built on and critiqued Le Bon’s
analysis; Trotter saw the “herd instinct” as a natural function of human
evolution, while Freud saw mass suggestibility as the result of powerful
libidinal ties formed between group members and certain leaders who
functioned as ego ideals for the rest of the group (Freud [1921] 1959; Trotter
[1919] 1953). Following Freud, the implications of mass irrationality for
governments and markets became important concerns of men such as John
Dewey, Walter Lippmann, and Edward Bernays. Although Dewey
championed the decision-making ability of the people, Lippmann believed
that enlightened social scientists and technocrats had to steer public policy
away from the frivolity of the masses, while Bernays accepted the public’s
irrationality and developed psychological techniques of persuasion for use in
the emerging field of public relations (Ewen 1996).
The supposed irrationality of the masses was on display in 1938 when
Orson Welles’s “War of the Worlds” radio broadcast convinced millions of
Americans that an alien invasion was under way. In The Invasion from Mars
(1940), the social psychologist Hadley Cantril performed an extensive survey
of radio listeners to try to determine what kinds of social and economic
factors affected their responses to the simulated catastrophe. The study,
which argued that those who panicked in the face of the broadcast lacked
“critical ability,” has been highly influential in subsequent sociological
debates concerning mass panic during disasters, although its methodology
has more recently been called into question (Quarantelli 2001). Although
nineteenth-century newspapers had frequently featured outlandish hoax
stories, which they would later reveal as false to the amusement of their
readership (see Goodman 2008), Welles’s broadcast directly called into
question the authenticity of human emotions generated by mass media. By
mimicking the aesthetic features of a real news bulletin while making the
actual content of the news an almost obvious fabrication, Welles exposed the
possibility that audiences were responding to the style of news stories rather
than their content—the spectacle of mediation itself rather than the gravity of
actual events.
This insight has been further explored in the “moral panic” literature in
sociology, which emerged from Stanley Cohen’s (1980) investigation of
public fears in 1960s Britain about violent youth gangs known as “mods” and
“rockers.” One of Cohen’s core insights, and one that has been confirmed in
subsequent studies of panics concerning communists (Ungar 1990), Satanists
(Victor 1991), and homosexuals (Heatley 2007), is that the threat to the social
order posed by these stigmatized groups was actually very small, but the
news media had given them a disproportionately large amount of coverage,
thereby inflaming an exaggerated and irrational sense of threat around them.
The belief in the public’s susceptibility to irrationality in the face of
crisis has added weight to concerns over mass conformity more broadly.
With the rise of fascism and the growing sophistication of mass propaganda
in Germany and the United States, the post–World War II period has borne
witness to a further loss of trust in the authenticity of mass communication
and the genuineness of the emotional responses it solicited (Ewen 1996). The
shock of new media technologies became associated not only with a sort of
inflamed sensationalism but also with trauma, with a benumbing of
individual consciousness in the face of the overwhelming machinery of
modernity and its instruments of persuasion.
The postwar period also revealed an increasing discomfort with explicit
images of war and human suffering. Writing in 1945, James Agee first
described newsreel footage of the battle of Iwo Jima as pornographic because
“we have no business seeing this sort of experience” (quoted in Dean 2004,
21). The label “pornographic” was soon applied to images of the Holocaust,
as well, although, as Carolyn Dean has noted, the critique behind such a label
has not been always been clear: “Does it encourage us to identify with
victims or with perpetrators? Does it excite us or numb us or both” (Dean
2004, 18)? Nonetheless, this strain of critique has persisted to the present day
in the epithet “disaster porn” that is frequently lobbied at contemporary
disaster-related media, even those devoted to fictional disasters (Recuber
2013).
Of course, America in the midst of postwar suburbanization has also
been romanticized as a period of stability and calm. This era did see fewer of
the deadly domestic disasters that plagued the United States around the turn
of the twentieth century: the Galveston hurricane of 1900 killed 6,000–
15,000 people, and the San Francisco earthquake and fire of 1906 killed
3,000–6,000, while no subsequent American natural disaster of the twentieth
century claimed nearly as many lives. Still, the very unnatural disaster of
World War II had provided the United States with the economic engine and
political will to promote this period of growing consumer culture in the first
place (see L. Cohen 2003). At the same time, the country’s triumphalist
“victory culture” would not last long, with the emergence of the threat of
nuclear confrontation with the Soviets, increasing military entanglement in
the Vietnam War, and the national tragedy of John F. Kennedy’s
assassination (Englehardt 2007).

The Kennedy Assassination as a New Archetype


The gradual ascendance of television journalism also changed Americans’
experience of tragedies and disasters. To many observers, the power of film
and television to disseminate news and, by extension, to create spectacle was
not fully realized until the 1960s. “John Kennedy defeated Richard Nixon on
television; Lee Harvey Oswald was shot on television; presidents dissembled,
protestors protested, in front of cameras, indeed with their eyes fixed upon
cameras” (Stephens 1988, 282). The Kennedy assassination and the events
that surrounded it became seminal moments in American history, and they
provided a dramatic turning point in the mass-mediated consumption of
tragedy and disasters. Film and television not only brought the story of
Kennedy’s assassination in increasing detail to an immense audience but also
became part of that story themselves.
John F. Kennedy, the “television president,” was widely believed to have
won the 1960 election because of his understanding of that emerging
medium. Just as his skillful embrace of TV helped legitimize his presidential
candidacy, it also led in some ways to television’s legitimization as an
instrument of political discourse. Even many television journalists considered
TV news an inferior counterpart to print media at the beginning of Kennedy’s
ascent to the presidency (Zelizer 1992). But the assassination in Dallas on
November 22, 1963, cemented the position of television as the primary news-
disseminating apparatus in American life. Most of the press initially on-site
in Dallas were corralled in two busses at the time of the assassination, so the
coverage of the shooting began not as it happened but immediately afterward.
Only one Associated Press (AP) photographer witnessed and photographed
the event: James Altgens stood only fifteen feet away when the president was
shot, close enough to nearly be struck by fragments of Kennedy’s head, and
shocked enough to miss the moment of impact, despite having already
focused his camera (Lubin 2003). Still, his photo of a Secret Service agent
climbing over the back of Kennedy’s limousine was transmitted to AP
twenty-five minutes after the shooting and ended up on the front page of
thousands of newspapers across the globe the next day. By contrast, Walter
Cronkite had already interrupted CBS’s regular television broadcast ten
minutes after the shots were fired to inform the audience of the attack on the
president’s motorcade. More than half of the nation—and as many as 68
percent, by one estimate—had heard news of the shooting before Kennedy
was even pronounced dead (Stephens 1988; Zelizer 1992). As a point of
contrast from almost a century earlier, President Abraham Lincoln was shot
on a Thursday evening and died that Friday morning, but with the telegraph
and the newspaper delivering the news, it took most of Friday and into
Saturday for the country to become fully aware, and the national period of
mourning really began on that Saturday, April 15, 1865—a day and a half
later (Harper 1951; Lewis 1957).
In any case, although print and radio journalists worked alongside and
together with television journalists in the harrowing hours and days following
the assassination, television inserted itself into the story more prominently
than other media. Two days after Kennedy’s death, Jack Ruby emerged from
a crowd of reporters, photographers, and cameramen to shoot the suspected
assassin Lee Harvey Oswald as Oswald was being transferred to county jail.
This marked the first time that a real homicide was carried on live television
(Zelizer 1992), and it occurred in the midst of three days of non-stop
television news coverage of the aftermath of the assassination. Such an
abandonment of normal TV format has remained, in the years following, a
signal of very important news (Gans 1979). The culmination of the coverage
was Kennedy’s funeral, which 93 percent of Americans viewed live on
television (Zelizer 1992). This also seems worth contrasting with Lincoln’s
case a century earlier: the train carrying his body back to Springfield, Illinois,
drew thousands of onlookers at each of the twelve cities in which it stopped
(Harper 1951), but there was, of course, no way for the rest of the nation to
act as live participants in this mourning ritual.
Kennedy’s assassination inaugurated an era in which the tragic,
disastrous, and catastrophic would frequently be caught on camera and often
broadcast live on television. The ascendance of television news and the
increasing ubiquity of TV, film, and video cameras in contemporary life have
not only enabled such frequent broadcasts of macabre events but also created
the expectation that such events should and will be televised. Twenty-four-
hour news networks, which appeared first in 1961 on the radio and on
television in 1980, require an even greater surfeit of events to cover, and
bleak or tragic news stories are rarely in short supply. “With the vast pool of
occurrences available to modern news organs, our ancestors’ need to be alert
to potential threats is now satisfied by daily, hourly immersions in a selection
of tragedies so unrelievedly black that the world itself, always grim when
viewed through the news, may appear to actually have darkened” (Stephens
1988, 291). While it is hard to argue that the amount of disaster, tragedy, and
misery in the world has grown, the quantum of such misfortune to which we
may be exposed, and the speed and intimacy with which such exposure
occurs, certainly have increased.
The Kennedy assassination produced some iconic images that have
remained central parts of American history and culture, such as John John’s
salute to his father’s passing funeral procession, Vice President Lyndon
Johnson’s somber swearing-in next to Jackie Kennedy aboard Air Force One,
or Lee Harvey Oswald’s pained grimace during his own assassination. But
what roles do such images play in American culture today? In one sense,
iconic photographs of tragedies and death have become taken-for-granted
aspects of daily, mass-mediated life. David Lubin (2003, xi) argues that
“these images are so famous that they have in a sense become invisible.”
Yet the “aesthetically familiar forms” of iconic images allow them to
help us confront “basic contradiction[s] or recurrent cris[es],” according to
Robert Hariman and John Louis Lucaites (2007, 29). By capturing troubling
or traumatic events in conventional forms of photojournalism or framing
them with time-honored themes of heroism or sacrifice, iconic photos have
served as powerful resources for American civic discourse (Harriman and
Lucaites 2007). Thus, the ubiquity of Kennedy-related mass culture allows
the trauma of his assassination to be reframed in the familiar terms of
heroism and sacrifice, rather than as simply tragic or unjust, and made real
for subsequent generations who were not alive to witness it.
Yet in another way the mystery of Kennedy’s death persists through
media, as well, embodied in the single, twenty-six-second piece of celluloid
known as the Zapruder film. The Zapruder film was once a heavily guarded,
enigmatic, almost sacred artifact. Although it was recorded on the date of the
assassination in 1963, the public did not get its first nationally televised view
of the Zapruder film until 1975. Life magazine had purchased the film from
Abraham Zapruder shortly after the assassination for the sum of $150,000,
and three copies of the initial negative were made, with one going to the
magazine, one to Zapruder, and one to the Secret Service. For more than a
decade after that, the film appeared only as a selection of still frames in the
pages of Life or to small audiences with special clearance, such as
government investigators or the jury in Jim Garrison’s trial of Clay Shaw,
famously depicted in Oliver Stone’s JFK (1991). However, bootleg copies of
the film began to appear in the hands of conspiracy theorists and in college
lecture halls not long after its creation. A photo technician named Robert
Groden had covertly made a copy of the film when working on it for Life in
1968 and had optically enhanced it to provide clearer details of the shots
hitting the president. This higher-resolution version was finally shown to the
nation on Good Night America by Geraldo Rivera in April 1975, causing “a
national sensation” (Granberry 2013; see also Lubin 2003; Simon 1996).
The history of the Zapruder film suggests that even the modern,
mechanically reproduced medium of film can create objects with the
cloistered or secret qualities of classical art forms such as painting and
sculpture. Though just twenty-six seconds long, the film appeared only in still
fragments, or to small bands of authorized elites, or in underground settings
organized by bootleggers for the first decade of its existence. Like a statue in
a cella, or a covered Madonna, the Zapruder film gained its uniquely
powerful status precisely because it remained hidden from public view. And
like the religious relics exhibited at irregular intervals for only brief periods
of time by churches in the Middle Ages (see Ewen and Ewen 2006; Man
2002), a grieving nation believed that the Zapruder film might contain
healing powers—in this case, the power to heal the wounded trust in
government that rampant conspiracy theories revealed. It also required a kind
of religious faith—not in God or government but in the power of film, and
vision more generally, to capture truth (Simon 1996). As an inversion of the
cult of the beautiful associated with classical art, these twenty-six seconds of
celluloid were believed to contain truth precisely because of their stark,
unadulterated recording of a brutal murder. This same claim to truth or
authenticity explains much of the appeal of disaster consumption today.
Once the film was publicly televised and Life relinquished its copyright
claims, this faith in visual truth was tested by numerous reinterpretations
based on careful forensic measurement, further technological enhancement,
and continued frame-by-frame dissection. An audio recording made from
Dallas police radio broadcasts at the time of the shooting was also eventually
added to the mix and pored over by acoustics experts and assassination buffs
(Simon 1996). But in the end, the film offered proof of theories involving
multiple-assassin conspiracies as well as a lone gunman, depending on who
analyzed it. Over time, the reproduction and dissemination of these images,
which had been long delayed, managed to modify the public perception of the
Zapruder film. But it did not destroy its arresting power.
The Zapruder film today maintains a kind of unique presence in
American popular culture despite, or perhaps because of, its ubiquity. Now
easily accessible to anyone with an Internet connection, and thus no longer
containing the aura of some hidden artifact, the images have their own
haunting and mysterious essence nonetheless. Currently, six different
versions of the film have been viewed more than a million times each on
YouTube, with the most popular version closing in on four million views.
The film is no longer distant from the public, but it continues to captivate
with its stubborn obfuscation of truth, its mysterious ability to hide the real
story seemingly in plain sight. The film haunts us today as the frustratingly
indecipherable key to solving a mystery, an unintelligible whisper from
beyond the grave. Its frequent reproduction in magazines, television
programs, forensic reenactments, documentaries, and Hollywood movies—
and the iconic status that such reproductions reinforce—has not resolved its
mysteries. Clare Birchall has argued that “the fact that the Zapruder film
‘proves’ so many conflicting versions of events says something about the
inherent instability of film as factual record” (quoted in Rose 2013, para. 10).
Audiovisual media’s simultaneous claim to truth and amenability to
interpretation have inspired similar conspiracy theories around more recent
disasters such as the September 11 attacks as well (Rose 2013). Thus, the
Zapruder film speaks above all else to the ineffability of disaster and tragedy.
Even when it is captured on film, or broadcast live, or commemorated, or
consumed, the pain of others is always difficult to fully grasp. Yet this
difficulty does not dim its appeal to consumers.
As Art Simon put it, “Perhaps no set of imagery has toured the cultural
landscape as much as that referring in some way to the death of JFK” (Simon
1996, 1). JFK commemorative coins, Christmas ornaments, pocket watches,
utensils, and apparel are sold in many places, including the John F. Kennedy
Presidential Museum and Library, and works of art such as Andy Warhol’s
series of “Jackie” prints from 1963 to 1964 and Oliver Stone’s movie JFK
attest to the wide influence of the assassination throughout the culture
industry over a long period of time. Thus, as with the Titanic tragedy, the
JFK assassination has been spun off and packaged for mass consumption in a
variety of forms. Imagery surrounding the assassination has even been
reappropriated to shock or transgress, as in the 1992 concert poster by Frank
Kozik that altered the image of Lee Harvey Oswald at the moment of his own
assassination to look like the photograph of a rock-and-roll band. In it, a
wincing Oswald appears to be singing into a microphone, Jack Ruby holds a
guitar, and a keyboard player stands behind them.
But how can consumption of such crass, cheap, or kitschy memorabilia
really have anything to do with authenticity? I want to suggest that even this
kind of consumption may maintain an indexical trace of the real, the
disastrous, and the traumatic. The nature of modern consumerism suggests
that even these sorts of objects may maintain a slight but unbridgeable sense
of distance or mystery. These traces of real pain and tragedy constitute the
aura of disaster consumption. At the very least, such commodities’
connections to real tragedies allow consumers to imagine them as authentic.
Since consumption is partly based on consumers’ imagined relationships with
the things they consume, then the connection to the real at the heart of
disaster consumption is “real in its consequences,” to borrow from the
sociologist W. I. Thomas’s famous maxim. Moreover, the perceived
authenticity of disaster images and products allows consumers to engage in
deeper emotional and imaginative relationships with these commodities—
one’s fear, grief, anxiety, and empathy are more appropriately expressed in
even the most outlandish forms of consumerism when such consumerism is
connected to a real-life disaster or tragedy. Through such affective
connections, one is able to join in a real or imagined communion with other
spectators, victims, and even the dead.
In sum, the assassination of JFK marked the ascendance of a new set of
relationships between aura and disaster, just as the sinking of the Titanic did
a half century before that. Disasters have become more and more likely to be
captured on film, radio, and television as they happen. The power of live,
televised news broadcasts, showcased in the events surrounding the
assassinations of Kennedy and Oswald and at Kennedy’s funeral, has marked
a push toward increasing use of live news and, eventually, the first of what
are now many twenty-four-hour TV news networks. And with the growth of
media technology at the consumer level, “citizen journalists,” as they are
called today—and of which Abraham Zapruder may have be the prototypical
case—are often the ones who actually capture the most shocking, powerful,
or iconic images of disaster. Accompanying these developments have been an
increasing commercialization, recycling, and reproduction of disasters in
consumer culture and a growing audience who also feels itself upset, moved,
or even traumatized by the vicarious, mediated experience of disaster. In this
sense, the disaster as a multimedia event may be the seat of its aura—not so
much one image as the sum total of these shots, their blending or composite
into general motifs across individual recollections and collective memory
(see Dahmen and Miller 2012). Thus is born the contemporary model of
disaster consumption: artifacts and images from the moment or scene of the
disaster maintain a haunting aura, an authentic quality derived from the
unfathomable magnitude or significance of the tragedy that they represent,
and yet such authenticity makes a disaster the subject of constant
reproduction and consumption that attempts to trade on its significance for
power and profit.
Using the Kennedy assassination as the model for contemporary disaster
consumption does, however, expand the definition of “disaster”: while
Kennedy’s death was certainly a tragedy of immense weight and significance,
is it really the same as the large-scale destruction of life and property that we
usually associate with the term “disaster”? I believe that it is, although not,
perhaps, for communities that are actually affected by a disaster. In terms of
popular culture, individual tragedies and large-scale disasters are presented
and consumed in very similar ways. The past thirty or forty years, in fact,
have revealed an expanding definition of victimhood and trauma. For
instance, television talk shows encourage guests to construct narratives of the
self that are framed by suffering or distress. This suffering is usually caused
not by earthquakes or wars but by the personal relationships and
entanglements of everyday life (Illouz 2003). In such a culture, it is no
surprise that “victim stories” have become a common feature of most
television news broadcasts, since they play on the recognition that our daily
lives are subject to horrible disruptions at a moment’s notice (Langer 1992).
Thus, an odd equivalence exists between mass disasters and individual
tragedies: both remind audiences of the ever present possibility of their own
victimization, and both can produce the same kind of vicarious emotional
responses in viewers. Both also allow for the creation of larger communities
around specific misfortunes and increase our opportunities to feel for the
distant others whom those misfortunes have befallen.

The Space Shuttle Challenger, Princess Diana, and Mass-


Mediated Mourning
In today’s hyper-mediated pop culture landscape, even those who simply
view images of traumatic events can lay claim to being traumatized
themselves (see Kaplan 2005). The idea of vicarious, media-induced trauma
amounts to an expansion of the aura to include televised live events. That is,
after all, the basis of the national exercises in mourning surrounding the
Kennedy assassination or a later tragedy such as the explosion of the space
shuttle Challenger in 1986. Although far fewer people died in the Challenger
explosion than in the Titanic sinking, the tragedy dominated popular culture
and the national consciousness in much the same way. However, the
Challenger exploded on live TV in front of millions of children who were
watching the launch during school hours in connection with the “Teacher-in-
Space” program. An estimated 40 percent of late elementary and secondary
school children in the United States witnessed the launch live on TV, and 95
percent of Americans had watched some of the Challenger explosion on
television by the end of the day (Zinner 1999). Indeed, the footage was
repeated on television so much that it seemed inescapable. As one Time
Magazine writer described it, “Over and over, the bright extinction played on
the television screen, almost ghoulishly repeated until it had sunk into the
collective memory” (quoted in Hariman and Lucaites 2007, 251). This kind
of endless looping of disaster footage was perhaps even more intense, and at
least equally traumatizing, to television audiences in the wake of September
11.
Within hours of the Challenger explosion, President Ronald Reagan—
another leader known for his skillful use of television—set the tone for
mourning with a nationally televised speech. The Teacher-in-Space program
had been his proposal, and the charismatic “teachernaut” Christa McAuliffe
had already been introduced to the nation through a series of interviews in the
run-up to the launch. In his speech, Reagan reaffirmed his faith in the space
program in a way that “model[ed] childlike deference to the state rather than
rational assessment and democratic deliberation” (Hariman and Lucaites
2007, 266). Of course, like the many other “pseudo-events” (see Boorstin
1987) of dubious importance with which public culture is populated today,
the Teacher-in-Space program was designed specifically as a public relations
mission. In an irony likely to be repeated in many future tragedies, the heavy
public relations efforts leading up to the launch contributed extra attention to
the mission’s disastrous outcome. Nonetheless, Reagan’s speech after the
Challenger disaster helped reassert the legitimacy of the National
Aeronautics and Space Administration (NASA) in spite of its costliness and
the high risks involved (Hariman and Lucaites 2007).
Still, as with Kennedy’s assassination, a government investigation
ensued, focusing eventually on defective “O-rings” and the culture of
groupthink pervading NASA. But one somewhat overlooked aspect of the
investigation was the fate of the crew members’ bodies. The live footage of
the fiery explosion made it seem as if the shuttle and crew members had been
incinerated in midair. But, in fact, the crew compartment had hurtled in a
three-minute-long free-fall into the ocean, where it was later recovered.
NASA’s original transcript of the voice recorder omitted the pilot Michael
Smith’s final “Uh oh,” and NASA only later revealed that some of the crew
members had actually used their emergency air packs during the descent,
suggesting that some of the shuttle passengers may have been alive and
conscious as they fell to Earth—a fact that neither NASA nor the
government’s investigators were willing to admit (Larabee 2001). Many
Americans saw NASA’s official position as part of a cover-up, and news
agencies sued under the Freedom of Information Act to get access to the
crew’s voice recordings (Zinner 1999). They hoped the recordings would
capture the truth about the tragedy in ways similar to the public’s hopes about
the Zapruder film.
Thus, even images with the kind of haunting, tragic aura of the
Challenger’s midair explosion leave doubt as to their veracity and the
authenticity of the responses of the viewing or consuming public. What really
happened beyond what we can see and hear on television? How much is it
appropriate to grieve for people one has never met? Is it legitimate to feel that
one has been traumatized simply by watching a catastrophe unfold on a
screen? And how much can we even trust what we see on the screen? After
all, the harrowing images of the Challenger’s explosion revealed little about
the bureaucratic and technological causes behind the tragedy and even
confused the whereabouts of the crew members’ bodies. If these images
maintain an aura today, it is due to the mysteries they conceal, the
unfathomable last seconds of the crew members that one cannot help but
ponder, the grief of family and friends watching from the ground, and the
communal experience of instantaneous loss suffered by so many that day. All
of this remains embedded, at least in traces, in the well-worn images of the
ship’s explosion and the various forms of commemoration that continue to
summon them. As with most mass-consumed catastrophes, nothing can fully
answer these questions, but people are often drawn together as they consider
them.
In an age of niche marketing and political fragmentation, the ability to
call forth such strong emotions from such wide audiences is rare. As Charles
Taylor (1991, 117) put it, “A fragmented society is one whose members find
it harder and harder to identify with their political society as a community.
This lack of identification may reflect an atomistic outlook, in which people
come to see society purely instrumentally. But it also helps to entrench
atomism, because the absence of effective common action throws people
back on themselves.” While not necessitating any individual action, the
affective strength of disaster pulls people together; it reaffirms the bonds of
community, nation, and humanity that are often viewed as being in decline.
In fact, image-based media can often do this in ways that print media cannot,
by “providing resources for thought and feeling that are not registered in the
norms of literate rationality that constitute the discourse of political
legitimacy in Western societies” (Hariman and Lucaites 2007, 14).
The general scarcity of such communal sentiment in modern nation-
states makes the aura of disaster so valuable. In the United Kingdom, the
death of Princess Diana in 1997 provided another striking example of this.
Diana’s death “led to more newsprint, and her funeral to a bigger global
television audience, than had any previous event” (Davies 1999, 3). Hundreds
of thousands of people made pilgrimages to Kensington Palace in London
and elsewhere across the British Isles (Davies 1999, 3). One million copies of
Andrew Morton’s 1992 biography of Diana were reprinted and distributed to
bookstores, and even across the United States vendors sold Princess Diana T-
shirts, posters and other memorabilia near the sites of spontaneous Diana
shrines (Haney and Davis 1999, 233). This combination of real-life suffering
and mass-mediated celebrity has much in common with the aesthetics of
reality television, which was beginning its cultural ascent at this moment (see
van Zoonen 1998, 115). Some have also argued that this widespread form of
communal grieving showcased a shift in British values from the traditional
“stiff upper lip” to a more emotional set of social conventions with less
deference for authorities and greater multicultural aspirations (Jeleniewski
Seidler 2013; Turnock 2000).
Yet the massive crowds at various public sites of mourning across
London may reflect more of “a compulsion to attend, to ‘feel the mood,’ to
see for [ones]self ” (Turnock 2000, 72) than the deeply shared sense of
mourning that was often interpreted and encouraged by the press. As one
critic explained, “This involved interviewers going on about how sad it all is
until the interviewee started to blub and the camera zoomed in on tears… .
Such manipulation by interviewers of their subjects then provided a warrant
for a new news item about the depth of grief of ordinary people for someone
they had never met. After three days of this anyone not already near to tears
felt there was something wrong with them” (Harris 1999, 100).
Disasters thus provide a powerful means of steering public sentiment.
Princess Diana’s death became, at the very least, a boon to television ratings
and newspaper and book sales. Before that, President Reagan had used his
televised address to the nation after the Challenger explosion to deflect
attention from political and bureaucratic mistakes and reaffirm American
faith in technologically mediated progress. Even as far back as the Lisbon
earthquake of 1755, one finds elites using disasters as the justification for the
disenfranchisement of a maligned minority group. It should not have been
surprising, then, when all of these themes came back into play around the
terrorist attacks of September 11, 2001. But for such elite efforts to bear fruit,
they must resonate with their audiences. The ineffability of disasters is key in
that regard.

Conclusion: The Ineffability of Disaster


As we have seen, disasters lay claim to a kind of authenticity that has, at its
core, the reality of their victims’ pain. Yet physical pain, as Elaine Scarry
(1985, 4–5) argued, “resists objectification in language” and thus “whatever
pain achieves, it achieves in part through its unsharability.” Indeed, the pain
of others is “at once that which cannot be denied and that which cannot be
confirmed” (Scarry 1985, 4). While her focus was on physical, embodied
pain, not its emotional or psychological variants, this perspective is the final
key to understanding the appeal of disaster consumption and spectatorship.
Just as Scarry speaks of the “inexpressibility” of one’s own physical pain,
one can consider the incomprehensibility of others’ pain. All pain—or, at
least, all testimony about pain—impels its recipients to try to understand but
leaves them uncertain about how well they have done so.
This sort of uncertainty is a fundamental part of mass communication
itself. In Speaking into the Air, John Durham Peters (1999, 177) explained
that even as modern technologies of recording and transmission have
enlarged the possibilities for mass communication, they “multiply the
opportunities for mishaps and breakdowns.” For Peters, modern
communication is animated by “the dream of spirit-to-spirit contact
unimpaired by distance or embodiment,” but at the same time it is marked by
the sense that “all action, especially all communicative action aimed at
coming into conjunction with another soul, is action at a distance” (J. D.
Peters 1999, 178). In this view, communication is always imperfect, always
subject to some unbridgeable distance between phenomenological experience
and the thought or utterance that expresses it. That distance is then multiplied
as utterances are transmitted to others. The potential to communicate with
others thrills us, but there is always doubt left over in the wake of our
communication. This is especially true in times of uncertainty and distress:
“The common world may be habitual and sound, but breakdown allows all
the primal uncanniness to return. In a blackout, or the telephone’s suddenly
going dead, or the static caught between stations, we discover the gaps, not
the bridges” (J. D. Peters 1999, 205).Rather than discouraging us from
engaging with disasters, however, the incomprehensibility of others’ pain and
the veracity gap in others’ testimony about that pain are precisely the sort of
features that make disasters such powerful resources for the imagination and,
thus, for mass consumption.
Colin Campbell’s (1987) work on the psychosocial roots of modern
consumerism reminds us that modern consumers have come to focus not on
the immediate, sensate pleasures of goods but on an imaginative relationship
based on the emotional anticipation of those pleasures. In modern
consumerism, “if a product is capable of being represented as possessing
unknown characteristics then it is open to the pleasure-seeker to imagine the
nature of its gratifications… . [In this way … greater desire is experienced for
the unknown than the known” (C. Campbell 1987, 86). Indeed, such desire
and pleasure are “constituted in a subjective imagining of consumption’s
meanings for the self” (Dunn 2008, 46). Imagination not only heightens the
pleasures of the act of consumption. It also enables us to feel certain ways
about ourselves based on what we consume.
At the same time, Campbell (1987, 86) argues that the actual experiences
of consumption “are unlikely to compare favorably” with those encountered
in one’s own imagination. For Campbell, a cycle of enchantment,
disenchantment, and re-enchantment explains the psychosocial appeal of
mass consumption (see also Ritzer 1999). “The consummation of desire is
thus a necessarily disillusioning experience” that prompts a turn back to
fantasy and imagination, so “the dream will be carried forward and attached
to some new object of desire such that the illusory pleasures may, once more,
be re-experienced” (C. Campbell 1987, 86). As such, the actual consumption
of commodities never quite lives up to their imagined pleasures. Campbell
believes that this ethic of “autonomous, self-illusory hedonism” can explain
the exploding desire for consumer goods that allowed the Industrial
Revolution to succeed and that continues to animate the hyper-consumption
of Western populations today.
It also ties together the themes that run throughout this chapter: the rise
of mass media and mass consumption, the growing normative encouragement
to imagine the pain and suffering of distant others, and the privileged place of
disasters as carriers of authenticity. Modern mass consumption—at least
beyond the satisfaction of the basic necessities of life—depends on this gap
between what is imagined and what is actually experienced. This is much the
same as the act of mass communication, in which the excitement of
exchanging information and experiences is always subject to doubt over their
veracity. In both cases, the mass audience for these processes turns this
epistemological quandary into a social problem, as huge numbers of
audiences and consumers are driven to keep reading, listening, viewing, and
consuming, spurred on as much by the desires that remain unfulfilled as by
those that are actually satiated. This helps explain, for one thing, why the
earliest moments of disaster news—in which information is often unreliable
—are so widely watched anyway. Our desire to know what’s going on, to
understand the risks, and to appreciate what others are suffering is inflamed
by the uncertainty pervading what we actually find out.
We arrive, then, at a psychosocial model that explains the appeal of
disaster media and commodities. In this model, the ineffability of disaster is
its chief appeal to distant spectators. Disasters are novel and highly emotional
phenomena. They happen to everyday, relatable people. They expose our
own potential vulnerabilities. They pose moral dilemmas. And yet they offer
few answers. They are complex. They spin tangled webs of culpability.
Victims lose everything and survivors escape unscathed seemingly at
random. All of this uncertainty means that—unlike basic needs for food,
shelter, and other, simpler kinds of information—disaster media and culture
spur more and more spectatorship and consumption precisely because the
promise of understanding always necessarily remains partially unfulfilled.
And so each new disaster strikes us as eerily or heartbreakingly
reminiscent of others but also offers the hope of finally learning the right
lessons—or, at least, finally understanding the awful complexity of such
tragedies. The traces of real pain and loss at the heart of disaster-related
media appear to confirm this. Benjamin (1999, 510) found this transcendent
aura in early photographs, where “the beholder feels an irresistible urge to
search such a picture for the tiny spark of contingency, of the here and now,
with which reality has (so to speak) seared the subject.” One sees the same
traces of the here and now, the same seared markers of reality, in the
Zapruder film or the footage of the Challenger explosion. That same trace of
reality, that aura of disaster, is also apparent in the incredible array of images
from September 11, as well as in certain footage of flooded New Orleans
streets and stranded rooftop survivors during Hurricane Katrina. The
haunting traces of catastrophes in consumer culture and their stubborn refusal
to reveal their secrets speak to the diminishing yet still unbridgeable distance
between others who suffer and those who consume that suffering. This is the
aura of disaster.
As such, the central problem of contemporary disaster consumption is
not the inauthenticity of disaster consumption or of those engaged in it, but
the ability of cultural and political elites to frame a narrow range of emotional
or political responses as the only appropriate ones. The consumption of
catastrophe is most threatened—or, perhaps, most threatening—when
dominant interests are able to channel the wide range of emotions that
surround disasters into a few politically or economically useful contexts. The
aura of disaster is not only a source of deep emotion for audiences and
victims; it is a contested terrain, a site of struggle for control over the fleeting
essence of reality itself. But as this book shows, at least during the first
decade of the twenty-first century that contest tended to heavily favor elite
interpretations and definitions.
Since the Enlightenment, the importance of genuine emotional responses
to the suffering of others has been a subject of public discussion and debate.
In the intervening centuries, the contours of that debate have changed
alongside new developments in media technology and new styles of
consumer culture, but always some belief in the possibility of an authentic
public reaction has obtained, even if that possibility seemed a diminishing
one. This remains true today, at a time when consumer culture puts a
premium on authentic selfhood despite the doubt cast on the entire notion of
authenticity by modern and postmodern critics of media culture (see
Featherstone 1991; Goulding 2000). Disasters partially resolve this problem
by providing, at least in extreme cases, cultural products with an undeniable
relation to reality, regardless of their mediation or reproduction. Emotional
investment in such cultural products has become accepted and even expected
precisely because of this connection to real loss, mass suffering, and unjust
death—though the outcome of such investment is liable to encompass a wide
range of responses. Disasters, after all, are complicated; they tend to
transcend simple designations of cause and effect or blame and victimhood,
and they generate multiple meanings based on the context in which they are
experienced, viewed, or consumed. Nevertheless, disasters always demand
our attention, emotion, and contemplation. They cast a shadow over their
distant spectators, haunting them with the lingering ghosts of collective
traumas. This aura remains in the traces and fragments left behind in a
disaster’s wake, not only in the physical landscape, but also in the landscape
of media and consumer culture. And it is this trace of authenticity that allows
spectators to believe that they can truly empathize with a disaster’s distant
victims simply by consuming its media representations, as the next chapter
demonstrates.
2

THE LIMITS OF EMPATHY

Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech Shootings

W hen Hurricane Katrina made landfall in Louisiana, Paula Bealer


watched on television from 350 miles away. Despite the fact that she and her
family had safely evacuated, she began to weep. This weeping continued in
the weeks following the storm, as she described in an essay written for the
website Helium, “I grieved intensely for those that were lost in the hurricane
as though they were my own loved ones. I cried tears of pain for the homes
and all the family mementos lost in the devastation. I cried for businesses that
people worked so hard to establish just to have them washed away so
quickly. I felt the weariness of the rescue workers who despite all their efforts
were unable to save everyone” (Bealer 2007, para. 3).
Coleman Collins, a former basketball player at Virginia Polytechnic
Institute and State University (Virginia Tech), experienced the tragic
shootings on his campus in somewhat similar terms. He watched the
television coverage from the safety of his girlfriend’s house while making
phone calls and using Facebook to figure out whether anyone he knew had
been harmed. In an entry on ESPN’s TrueHoop blog, he explained:

As it turned out I didn’t know anyone personally. People always


give off a sigh of relief when I tell them this… . How could I
explain that because I didn’t know anyone who was killed that day,
that everyone I know was killed that day? There will be people that
read this who personally knew victims. Trust me, I can’t compete
with your pain, but God … I didn’t know I could feel that way. I
think they call it empathy. So yeah, that was the day I realized what
empathy was. (Collins 2010, para. 7–8)

Bealer also described her experience as one of empathy. She lauded this
powerful sentiment and wrote, “As intense of an emotion as empathy is, I
never regret being able to feel it. In my opinion, empathy is an emotion that
connects us to each other. How else would we begin to understand the pain of
others without actually feeling it” (Bealer 2007, para. 13)?
Of course, her question need not be taken rhetorically. The pain of others
has not always been apprehended in the ways that American culture
encourages us to experience it today. Disasters have obviously always evoked
strong emotions in those they have directly affected, as well as in those who
have watched from afar or who have learned of them after the fact; bearing
witness to the misfortunes of others has always had the potential to generate a
feeling of commiseration and a desire to help those unfortunate others. But
the precise nature of this feeling and the socially appropriate forms of help
have changed over time. As disasters have assumed a prominent role in
contemporary popular culture, and as the news media have developed the
ability to transmit footage of mass catastrophes across the globe almost
instantaneously, the norms surrounding emotion and the spectatorship of
suffering have adapted and evolved. Alternative “structures of feeling”
(Williams 1977) and new “emotional regimes” (Reddy 2001) have appeared
to challenge the prevailing norms and rituals governing emotional expression
in today’s heavily mediated and consumed experience of disasters.
When contrasted with Enlightenment ideals of emotional expression, and
even with more recent examples of mass-mediated emotion in the wake of
tragic events, American mass culture in the first decade of the twenty-first
century encouraged a more intimate form of spectatorship focused on an in-
depth understanding and vicarious experience of the emotional pain of others.
Certainly, all media bring the experiences of others closer to us and thus can
surely be experienced as intimate or in-depth. For instance, an iconic war
photograph such as “Accidental Napalm” intimately exposed viewers to the
intense suffering of a Vietnamese child. Similarly, a radio broadcast such as
Herbert Morrison’s infamous narration of the explosion of the Hindenburg
captured in the subtle, audible details of his voice the despair of witnessing
that tragedy. Nonetheless, recent technological developments such as
camcorders and smart phones have the potential to do more than even this.
They can bring us the innermost thoughts of disaster victims, recorded as the
disaster unfolded in the midst of their struggle to survive. They can even
reveal the last words of a mass murderer, spoken directly to his own camera
and broadcast across the globe a mere two days after his murderous rampage
ended in suicide. In such texts, and in more mundane forms of contemporary
media, a new empathetic way of looking is both encouraged and implicated.
Scholars such as Alison Landsberg argue that such media engagement can
force audiences to empathize with others who are radically different from
themselves and might therefore encourage “more radical forms of democracy
aimed at advancing egalitarian social goals” (Landsberg 2009, 221). But is
the empathetic, mediated engagement with disasters necessarily so
democratic or egalitarian?
This chapter examines the cultural products that emerged from
Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech shootings, paying specific attention
to the codes surrounding emotional expression that they exhibit. After a
general overview of the consumption and mediation of both disasters, the
chapter focuses on four particular media products that exemplify current
trends. A close reading of the September 1, 2005, broadcast of CNN’s
Anderson Cooper 360 Degrees (AC 360) and the documentary Trouble the
Water (2008) provides evidence about specific features of the consumption of
disaster during Hurricane Katrina, while the NBC Nightly News broadcast
from April 18, 2007, and an episode of the Biography channel’s show I
Survived, which dealt with the Virginia Tech shootings, offer similar
evidence concerning that tragedy’s mediation.
These two news broadcasts were chosen because of their particular
cultural importance in the unfolding of these disasters, and the two other texts
were selected because of the ways they exemplify the empathy-generating
power of factual media and disaster narratives. For instance, Anderson
Cooper’s highly emotional performance in this particular broadcast was
called “a breakthrough for the future of television news” (Van Meter 2005,
para. 1). Similarly, the exclusive broadcast of the Virginia Tech killer Seung-
Hui Cho’s package of self-made footage on NBC Nightly News was largely
unprecedented. As the Washington Post explained, “Until the package arrived
at NBC, the story had almost started following what might be considered a
template for national tragedies, a series of stages that has become
dismayingly familiar: the initial shock; reaction to the event; essays on
historical perspective that keep the story in the forefront of news; and, finally,
criticism of the media for how the story has been played—or, more likely,
overplayed. The Virginia Tech tragedy was clearly about to enter that last
phase when the prototype was shattered, and in a uniquely 21st-century way”
(Shales 2007, para. 12–13). The I Survived series has been lauded for its
focus on “real people and candor” and for the unique and inspirational nature
of the “raw humanity” it portrays in its stark depictions of near-death
experiences (Courson 2009, para. 1–2). Finally, Trouble the Water’s
emotional focus on real people and the authenticity of their encounters with
disaster has led critics to proclaim that “only the most heartless of individuals
would fail to empathize with the victims” (“‘Trouble the Water’ Examines
Katrina Aftermath” 2008, para. 9).
In these four programs, aesthetic and technological cues about the
authenticity of media texts served as de facto evidence of the personal,
emotional authenticity of their producers and audiences, as well as the
performances of the subjects on screen. Moreover, these cultural products
announced a change in notions of spectatorship relative to classical
discussions concerning the moral ramifications of the suffering of others.
Whereas classical notions of sympathy required one to act or speak out on
behalf of the suffering other, these texts evinced a shift away from sympathy
and toward empathy as the moral responsibility of the spectator. This chapter
argues that as mass mediation has increased the amount of attention paid to
tragedies and catastrophes, and as therapeutic culture has placed increasing
value on emotional intelligence and the ability to adapt to multiple roles or
identities, and as reality television has cemented intimate new styles of
viewing others’ emotional lives, a new empathetic gaze has emerged. This
empathetic way of relating to narratives of others’ suffering, which prioritizes
simply understanding what others are going through, has developed as a kind
of alternative to an older, sympathetic moral requirement that more explicitly
linked such understanding with concrete action to help alleviate the suffering
of others. The narratives examined here still “create a particular kind of social
world, with specified heroes and villains, deserving and undeserving people
and … the construction of social problems” (Bennett and Edelman 1985,
157). Yet this chapter argues that the empathetic way of looking at social
problems may steer us away from the kinds of long-term actions that such
problems often require.
In sum, the four texts analyzed in this chapter all rely on a way of
looking at others’ suffering that is designed to induce empathy in spectators.
The presence of this empathetic gaze points to the growing normative value
placed on empathizing with others’ suffering in contemporary American
culture at large. This emergent norm and the forms of mass culture that
embody it encourage spectators to try to really feel what others have felt, to
vicariously experience the pain of others. But by lauding this kind of deep,
intimate engagement with the suffering of distant others, and the concurrent
performance of having been moved by it, the empathetic gaze places less
importance on correcting the social and political conditions that facilitated
such suffering in the first place.

Charity, Mass Media, and Mass Consumption


Although the U.S. government and residents of the Gulf Coast had been
informed by meteorologists and news services for two to three days about
Hurricane Katrina’s impending landfall in the region, the storm that hit New
Orleans on August 29, 2005, found a city unprepared. The storm caused an
estimated $81 billion worth of damage in the area (Nordhaus 2006) and
resulted in the deaths of at least 1,836 people. As the deadly aftermath of the
storm came into focus, officials such as President George Bush and Michael
Brown of the Federal Emergency Management Agency (FEMA) emphasized,
as many officials had done after September 11, that no one could have
imagined this kind of devastation, despite the fact that weather forecasters
had accurately predicted the strength of the storm and that the weakness of
the city’s levees and its vulnerability to hurricanes had been well established
in the mainstream press and in FEMA’s own reports. Mayor Ray Nagin’s late
evacuation plans also made no allowance for public transportation, thereby
leaving the city’s poor or otherwise immobile residents essentially on their
own, while state and federal preparations were similarly short-sighted or
inadequate (Dyson 2006).
Katrina was the first major hurricane to hit the United States with the
accompaniment of continuous coverage by the twenty-four-hour news
networks. Initially, the inaccessibility of many affected areas of the Gulf
Coast to the news media meant that small pockets of survivors received a
disproportionate amount of coverage (Shrum 2007). The immediacy
demanded of such coverage during disaster situations tended to contravene
the generally time-consuming processes of collecting and reporting facts,
which led in this case to a particularly virulent strain of traffic in rumor and
innuendo in the storm’s immediate aftermath (Rodríguez and Dynes 2006).
The news media has received harsh criticism for its depiction of racial
minorities in New Orleans as either violent looters or passive victims and its
sensational implications that the city had fallen into chaos (Rodríguez and
Dynes 2006; Voorhees, Vick, and Perkins 2007). These reports became a sort
of self-fulfilling prophecy as law enforcement officers and residents alike
began to believe that the city had indeed fallen into lawlessness and
responded in ways that exacerbated this lack of civic trust (D. Miller 2006).
However, news media were also frequently critical of the inadequate scope
and insufficient pace of government rescue and recovery efforts. Without the
usual level of access to government sources in the early days of the storm,
news reporters broke from the kinds of unifying themes so prominent after
September 11 and instead adopted an outraged, populist tone (Durham 2008).
In fact, television news frequently portrayed its own reporters, producers, and
camera crews as heroes “fighting the evil that was government ineptitude”
(Fry 2006, 83).
Thousands of Americans were moved by this media coverage to
volunteer their time or money to relief efforts for Hurricane Katrina victims,
and Hurricane Rita’s victims were eventually added to many relief funds as
that storm hit the area a month later. Just eleven weeks after Katrina, private
donations totaled $2.7 billion (Frank 2005), and the total amount of donations
eventually exceeded $5 billion (Aaron Smith 2011). Although organizations
such as the Red Cross, which by one estimate received 60 percent of all
Katrina-related donations (Strom 2006), handled the bulk of the immediate
relief work, new constituencies came together, especially in the African
American community. Black churches and political organizations raised
millions, and many African American artists and athletes organized telethons,
raised money, and promoted volunteer efforts (Dyson 2006). In fact,
celebrities from all walks of life teamed up for a variety of charitable efforts
—perhaps the most notable of these was “A Concert for Hurricane Relief,”
which was broadcast live on NBC and its affiliated networks on September 2,
2005, and in which Kanye West went off script to pronounce that, among
other things, “George Bush doesn’t care about black people.” Americans
engaged with the storm through more mundane consumption choices, as well,
of everything from commemorative Katrina T-shirts, bumper stickers, and
Beanie Babies to a variety of documentary films and even eventually a
Hollywood feature film called Hurricane Season (2009), starring Forrest
Whitaker.
The April 16, 2007, shootings at Virginia Tech, while similarly
dominating the news media, had somewhat less staying power in popular
culture. However, the demands for immediate coverage, constant updates of
news stories, and frequent interviews with victims or survivors that were so
apparent during Hurricane Katrina remained part of the news network
protocol in this tragedy. Reporters quickly flocked to the campus of Virginia
Tech as word spread of a shooting there, and they, or the stations’ news
anchors, relayed each new tidbit of information as soon as it was released.
The reporters pushed for interviews with clearly shaken students who were
still trying to cope with the shooting and learn the whereabouts of friends.
Television networks set up temporary studios on campus, broadcasting entire
programs, such as NBC’s Today, from inside the school, and backlash against
the heavy media presence on campus quickly emerged among students and
faculty (Gravois and Hoover 2007).
The most controversial news coverage came two days later, when NBC
Nightly News with Brian Williams decided to air portions of a package it had
received from Seung-Hui Cho himself, likely mailed between his double
murder at the West Ambler Johnston residence hall and his mass shooting at
the Norris Hall classroom building later that morning. The package contained
what Williams referred to on-air as a “multimedia manifesto,” consisting of
various kinds of electronic images, videos, and text created by Cho to be
aired after the shootings. Many criticized NBC’s decision to show some of
these photos and videos, but it helped make the show the most watched of the
evening newscasts that week by a large margin (J. Steinberg 2007). Cho’s
familiarity with new electronic media was matched by that of Virginia Tech’s
students, who used social networking sites such as MySpace and Facebook to
communicate with one another and memorialize fallen friends in the
aftermath of the shootings (Creamer 2007).
Beside their electronic commemorations, students at Virginia Tech set
up several makeshift memorials in the physical space of the campus, and
consumers across America and the world took it upon themselves to support
the university by purchasing Virginia Tech athletic apparel and other Hokies
memorabilia. Wholesale sales of such items rose to more than $5.6 million
for the period between April 1 and June 30; this represented a jump of
between $1 million and $2.6 million over similar quarters in years past. In the
weeks after the shootings, the school also received numerous phone calls
from vendors seeking licenses to sell Virginia Tech products, but they were
all turned down (Bowman 2007). Thousands of other spontaneous donations
to the university in the wake of the shootings were eventually culled into the
Hokie Spirit Memorial Fund, $8 million of which has now been distributed
among the seventeen injured and the families of the thirty-two killed in the
shootings. One victim’s tragic death was even transformed into an
inspirational book entitled Lifting Our Eyes: Finding God’s Grace through
the Virginia Tech Tragedy. The Lauren McCain Story.
Critics used the Virginia Tech shootings as an indictment against popular
culture in many respects. As has become routine in the wake of school
shootings, commentators suggested that violent media were to blame (Furedi
2007b). Some focused on Cho’s “addiction to a ghastly, violent video game
called Counter-Strike” (Stephen 2007, 20), while others noticed the similarity
between a pose in one of Cho’s photos and a scene from the South Korean
revenge film Oldboy (2003), which then began to receive blame even though
no one could confirm that Cho had ever seen it (Scott 2007). Many were
troubled by NBC’s handling of Cho’s words and images, in terms of both
their potential effects on already traumatized victims and their families and
their potential to inspire other disaffected youth to commit “copycat” killings
—a concern made less far-fetched by the fact that Cho specifically referred to
the Columbine shooters in his writings (Deppa 2007). The American
Psychiatric Association even issued a press release on April 20 urging the
news media to stop airing Cho’s images. As a result, many questioned the
value of news reporting and the propriety of its conventions during a tragedy
such as this. One critic pointed out the particularly crass way in which news
channels used graphics to brand their coverage of catastrophes, noting, for
instance, that “CNN’s animated massacre at virginia tech logo throbbed and
twirled with all the subtlety of an ‘American Idol’ bumper” (Dumenco 2007,
34). Others criticized the tone of such news broadcasts: “Shortly after
announcing that the shooting had become the largest campus massacre ever,
eclipsing the 1966 Texas Tower sniping, television commentators declared,
with nearly gleeful enthusiasm, that it had surpassed in carnage all other mass
shootings in the United States at any venue. For the remainder of the day,
viewers were told repeatedly that the Virginia Tech massacre had been the
biggest, the bloodiest, the absolute worst, the most devastating, or whatever
other superlatives came to mind” (Fox 2008, para. 3). These critics
nonetheless called for a broader examination of the production of news
reports and other violent media as a way to avoid future tragedies. Although
some find this very line of criticism hypocritical (see Kellner 2008), it
remains a recurring theme in the discourse on disaster and mediation and one
that some television networks have taken to heart. For instance, Fox News
Channel decided to stop showing clips from Cho’s manifesto, stating that it
saw “no reason to continue assaulting the public with these disturbing and
demented images” (quoted in A. Park 2008, 1).
Similar themes appeared in the debate over Hurricane Katrina’s media
coverage. The frequent reports of looting, sniper fire, rape, and murder in
New Orleans in the aftermath of the storm turned out largely to be
fabrications, but the absence of significant government intervention in the
region during that first week made the reporting of such unconfirmed rumors
more problematic than usual, as many government decision makers believed
these reports and tailored their relief plans accordingly or echoed them back
to other media outlets. Mayor Nagin dramatically demonstrated this process
when he appeared on Oprah parroting claims about “hooligans killing people,
raping people” in the Superdome, which were subsequently proved false
(quoted in Dyson 2006, 171). These visions of chaos resonated with the
conventional wisdom, roundly debunked by many disaster sociologists (see,
e.g., Rodríguez, Trainor, and Quarantelli 2006) but perpetuated by
Hollywood disaster movies, that mass catastrophes invariably cause social
breakdown and anarchy. They also resonated with a white audience’s
negative racial stereotypes about the predominantly poor, African American
population who remained in the city (Tierney, Bevc, and Kuligowski 2006;
Voorhees, Vick, and Perkins 2007). Thus, as with the Virginia Tech
shootings, much media criticism of Hurricane Katrina coverage focused on
the issue of sensationalism. In New Orleans, at a time when few state or
federal officials, and none of the general public, were in a position to know
what was really happening on the ground, the news media could not resist
putting the most dramatic and sensational spin on these already incredibly
dramatic events and did so by appealing in many cases to people’s worst
opinions of human nature or their vilest racial prejudices.
Nevertheless, millions watched the television coverage of both tragedies.
Many donated money directly to relief efforts or memorial funds, while
others bought athletic apparel, charity T-shirts, commemorative books, and
benefit concert tickets or recordings. Still others consumed in ways that
provided no direct economic assistance to the victims at all, as with certain
Hurricane Katrina souvenir T-shirts or fictional novels set during the storm.
But more than simply enabling charity or expressions of solidarity, consumer
culture and mass media were the focus of many of the proposed solutions to
the problems that remained in these tragedies’ aftermaths. The main set of
preventative measures adopted at colleges and universities across the country
in the wake of those shootings involved the creation of early warning systems
that sent e-mails and text messages to students’ computers and cell phones
(Fox and Savage 2009). And New Orleans has attempted to quickly rebound
from the disaster with the help of tourism, since its French Quarter has
always been the most visited area of the city and was least affected by the
flooding. Many companies even offered tours of the devastated and still
barely rebuilt areas of the city (M. Park 2006).
One can safely say, then, that mass media and consumer culture are
fundamental to the American experience of these two disasters. Although
criticisms of the inaccuracy and stereotyping in early news coverage of both
disasters have certainly proved valid, it remains important to understand the
normative construction of pain and suffering in this coverage. After all, the
moral and ethical problems posed by the suffering of distant others have been
a subject of philosophical discourse for centuries. However, dominant views
on the subject have changed over time, as have norms concerning the
appropriate behavior of those bearing witness to others’ misfortune. Such a
change appears to be at work in the contemporary experience of disaster as
well, requiring a new effort to understand the emotional style of disaster
consumption and its place among older ways of apprehending tragedy and the
pain of others.

The Meaning of Empathy


The previous chapter showed how the emergence of mass media and mass
consumption in the eighteenth century helped made the expression of feeling
for suffering of others into a modern virtue. In the past hundred years,
however, and especially the past half century, an alternative to older notions
of compassion or sympathy has emerged. “Empathy” was coined in 1909 as a
translation from the German einfühlung, meaning roughly the ability to
project the self into a perceived object. Eventually coming to refer to one’s
awareness in imagination of the emotions of another person, it has become
the word of choice in psychology (Wispé 1986). Psychologists have been
encouraged to improve their “empathic accuracy” (Ickes 1997) by adopting a
listening stance not just attuned to but oriented from within the patient’s
emotions and perspective. Empathy, for psychoanalysts, has become a
process of “vicarious introspection” (Kohut 1984; quoted in Bouson 1989,
22). Even President Barack Obama has suggested that “when you choose to
broaden your ambit of concern and empathize with the plight of others,
whether they are close friends or distant strangers—it becomes harder not to
act, harder not to help” (quoted in Bloom 2013, para. 2).
Yet many dispute this activist interpretation of empathy. In fact, one
crucial distinction between Enlightenment notions of sympathy and the more
recent belief in the virtues of empathy is that the latter may actually signal a
decreased moral obligation to act. As the psychologist Lauren Wispé (1986,
314) put it, “Sympathy refers to a heightened awareness of another’s plight as
something to be alleviated. Empathy refers to the attempt of one self-aware
self to understand the subjective experiences of another self.” Similarly, the
sociologist Candace Clark (1997) has argued that empathy is simply the first
step in a process that can lead to sympathy but can also lead to indifference or
even disgust toward the other. As a purely emotional exercise in identifying
with another, empathy blunts the political or activist implications associated
with sympathy.
Thus, rather than simply feeling sorry for someone less fortunate, or
feeling an emotion that corresponds to another’s emotional state, or
sympathizing with that other in a way that accepts a moral obligation to help,
empathy refers to an intersubjective understanding of the other’s plight
devoid of the obligation to intervene. Although sympathy proved
fundamental to democratic politics and egalitarian societies, as Alexis de
Tocqueville (2000) noted when describing the breadth of compassion he saw
in America, contemporary American culture has tended to venerate empathy
not only in conjunction with the growing popularity of psychoanalysis but
also, more generally, as psychoanalytic ideas have penetrated the
marketplace. For instance, self-help books on everything from leadership to
anger management emphasize the ability to empathize with the needs and
perspectives of those in one’s family as well as those with whom one works.
Such empathic skills are seen as both strategic and moral. But rather than
directing those skills toward helping others attain their needs, the act of
empathizing is often seen as an end in itself or simply as a way to gain
others’ trust (Illouz 2008). In this manner, the explicitly political character of
sympathy as an active concern for another has given way to empathy’s more
passive, vicarious character. This alternative, empathetic stance is embedded
in a particular way of looking at disaster-related media, particularly those
media texts that demonstrate the kind of authenticity discussed in previous
chapters.

Empathy, Authenticity, and the Virginia Tech Shootings


As mentioned, one of the most controversial aspects of media coverage of the
Virginia Tech shootings was the decision by NBC Nightly News to air
portions of the digital package of pictures, videos, and text that Seung-Hui
Cho sent to NBC sometime between his initial double homicide and his
larger mass shooting later that day. Although many found this decision
inexcusable, and half of the respondents in one survey found the coverage of
these shootings excessive (Pew Research Center for the People and the Press
2007), a closer examination of this broadcast can illuminate some of the
meanings and motivations behind this decision. The more macabre or
sensationalist elements of the broadcast do not simply stem from a desire for
spectacle. Rather, they appear to emerge out of the producers’ attempts to
elicit deeper psychological understandings of Cho and the suffering of his
victims, coupled with a preoccupation with the authentic quality of the media
that Cho created. In this way, the network established itself as having the
only truly authentic coverage of Cho, his motivations, his mindset, and the
terrible tragedy he had wrought.
In the opening moments of the broadcast on April 18, 2007, the anchor,
Brian Williams, provocatively advertised that the program would air Cho’s
“last recorded words” and described the package that NBC News had
received as a “multimedia manifesto.” As a way to establish the authenticity
of the images and videos being displayed, Williams brought out a color
photocopy of the Priority Mail package in which Cho sent them, pointing out
Cho’s handwriting; explaining the potential significance of “A. Ishmael,” the
name he signed; identifying the post office’s time stamp; and explaining how
the incorrect address Cho left had delayed receipt of the package by NBC for
a day. The real envelope, Williams said, had already been handed over to the
police, a nod to the fact that this “manifesto” was indeed evidence in a
murder investigation.
Williams then began to make a somewhat more substantial
acknowledgment of the ethical ramifications of broadcasting portions of
Cho’s package, stating, “We are sensitive to how all of this will be seen by
those affected, and we know we are in effect airing the words of a murderer
here tonight.” The statement was an oddly unbalanced one, however,
seemingly missing a second half that explained what the benefits of
broadcasting the manifesto might be and why they outweighed the concerns
of “those affected.” Such a statement never came. The news value of Cho’s
manifesto, and the uniqueness of such a piece of media, seemed so self-
evidently important that no justification appeared to be required. NBC News
apparently felt it was enough for Williams to state matter-of-factly that he
and the rest of his news organization “are sensitive” before relaying Cho’s
words and images to the masses.
One implicit motivation for this, exemplified in one way or another by
all of those on the program who commented on the images and videos, was to
understand Cho. His manifesto was treated as a window into his soul, as an
explanation for the seemingly inexplicable horror of his actions. This
psychoanalytic approach was on display in an exchange between Williams
and the former FBI profiler Clint Van Zandt, both of whom diagnosed Cho
on the basis of his manifesto as egotistic and narcissistic and then tried to tie
those personality traits to other infamous school shooters. Van Zandt
described the point of the exercise this way: “What I hope we’re able to gain
is not only perhaps motive that we’re starting to hear right now, but what was
the final catalyst, Brian, what finally broke the camel’s back and moved him
on. Why Monday instead of last Monday and not a week from now?”
Interestingly, neither Williams nor Van Zandt made the rhetorical leap of
using that information to identify and stop other potential shooters. Without
it, the empathetic ideal took a turn for the macabre, and the airing of Cho’s
video became mainly about reconstructing his mental state and decision-
making process.
This darker form of empathy came into stark focus in the actual display
of Cho’s photos and images. As a montage of Cho’s still photos began, the
NBC correspondent Pete Williams narrated in voiceover, “He looks like a
normal, smiling college student in only the first two. In the rest, he presents
the stern face and strikes the pose that was very likely what his victims saw
later on Monday. In eleven of the pictures, he aims handguns at the camera,
likely the very ones he bought in the past two months.” Williams went to
great lengths to ascribe a kind of authenticity to these images, this time in the
hope of giving his audience some real sense of what the victims must have
experienced. This sort of empathy is tantamount to a vicarious thrill ride for
audiences who may be equally concerned for the victims and titillated by
access to a perspective on this tragedy that is usually inaccessible. In fact,
Williams’s mix of solemnity and excitement about Cho’s manifesto attested
to a kind of aura surrounding it; these were uniquely dangerous images that
Cho, in his role as their singular creator, imbued with potentially traumatizing
properties. As Van Zandt put it, “This is his lifetime victory, this is the way
he’s victimizing, further victimizing all of us by reaching out from beyond
the grave and grabbing us and getting our attention and making us listen to
his last rambling words and pictures.”
Of course, rather than recognizing their complicity in Cho’s plot to reach
out “from beyond the grave,” NBC’s commentators presented themselves as
somewhat powerless in the face of the incredible newsworthiness of Cho’s
manifesto. During the thirty-minute program, they aired at least ten different
images produced by Cho a total of fourteen times, including many in which
he pointed weapons at the camera, and broadcast eight different clips of
Cho’s videos, in which he angrily railed against a series of anonymous targets
for more than two minutes. Yet all the while, NBC’s commentators counted
themselves simply as members of a rhetorical “us” whom Cho had forced to
listen. This was in keeping with the empathetic ideal; the media suffered
Cho’s ranting alongside the audience, neither of whom had any responsibility
to do anything other than try to understand. Rather than discrediting NBC
Nightly News or marking it as less serious or sincere than the other news
networks, all of which also probably would have aired Cho’s manifesto
(Kellner 2008), this should suggest that the cultural injunction to understand
works in tandem with a taste for the spectacular or sensational and that one
need not rule out the other. There is a pleasure in understanding, in
empathizing, and occasionally that pleasure manifests itself in morbid
fascination. Or, as Jean-Jacques Rousseau (1997, 228) once put it, “Pity is
such a delicious sentiment that it is not surprising one seeks to experience it.”
After some other news segments concerning a Supreme Court ruling on
“partial birth” abortion, the third section of the half-hour program involved
brief interviews with family members of deceased victims. Then, after an
update on the Iraq war, the final segment of the program contained more
footage from Cho’s press kit, which Brian Williams introduced by reminding
viewers that “the same warning pertains about the sensitive nature of the
following.” Then he simply added, “Here is some more of what we received
of video of Cho Seung-Hui, sent today to NBC.” The program aired more of
Cho’s videos at that point, which were followed by more discussion from the
correspondent Pete Williams. The program ended with Brian Williams
promising that NBC would air more of Cho’s manifesto the next day, after
law enforcement had combed through it, “because we don’t want to create
any more heroes or martyrs from this.” As an explanation of the channel’s
moral or legal duties, the remarks once again rang hollow, since NBC had
already done as Cho wished and broadcast his manifesto. But as a testament
to the influence that Williams and NBC believed the manifesto contained to
inspire other potential “heroes or martyrs,” the remarks showcased an
insistent belief in the unique power of this particular media artifact.
Although Benjamin’s use of the term “aura,” as discussed in Chapter 1,
has generally been hostile to processes of reproduction, the digital character
of this “manifesto” seemed actually to have enhanced its authenticity and its
aura. Were some handwritten copy of a printed manifesto to have shown up
in NBC’s mailroom with Cho as its purported author, it would likely not have
been read on the air that same evening. Determining its authorship and
authenticity would have been more difficult, and its less spectacular character
—no moving images or sounds, no inflammatory images, none of the
intimate details of Cho’s monotone voice and brief, angry inflections—might
have marked it as less newsworthy once authorship had been confirmed. But
Cho’s videos and images contained more than just his angry, demented
words. They exhibited the self-produced style of webcam videos and images
on social networking sites that have now become a familiar popular culture
aesthetic. This new aesthetic serves the same function that the hand-held
camcorder style did beginning in the 1980s and continues to today: a
guarantor of authenticity. These technical and aesthetic considerations about
the look or feel of reality create the conditions within which empathy is
acceptable or appropriate. In such a context, the ease with which amateurs
can create digital media allows even a disturbed, violent young person such
as Cho to exercise control over his media representation, creating digital
artifacts that the news media will read as authentic and publicize accordingly.
Of course, like the Zapruder film before it, Cho’s manifesto
demonstrates that stubborn quality of such genuine, mass-mediated disaster
artifacts: its ineffability. Although it hints at a much greater, deeper
understanding of the tragic, violent events during which it was created, it
ultimately conceals as much as it reveals. Such “understanding” is the siren
song of authenticity: it lures audiences and consumers close to some
dangerous shores, promising clarity but only ever exposing us to its horrific
complexity.
When direct audiovisual evidence from such tragic events is unavailable,
the empathetic ideal can still work through documentation of intimate, first-
person, subjective experience. One program that reflects this emphasis more
than most is the Biography channel’s I Survived. The program normally
consists of three or four interviews over an hour of running time with
survivors of some type of near-death experiences. These experiences range
from assaults and abductions to plane crashes and wild animal attacks, and
the stories are told by the survivors themselves, who are always seated in
front of a black background, with no attempt to re-create or reenact the events
described. Instead, I Survived supplements its interviews with only current
footage of the locations where these near-death experiences happened: an
empty field where a woman was left for dead, the gas station where men and
women were held hostage, the river where a family clung to a capsized boat
overnight. The stark, unadorned presentation of such narratives speaks to the
ways that “raw experiences and subsequent stories of suffering tell us about
selves laid bare and open to view” (Charmaz 1999, 364). In I Survived the
effect is one in which the emotional reactions of the interviewees are brought
to the fore, and audience members are left to imagine themselves in the
locations pictured, facing the horrible circumstances that the interviewees
describe.
For the ninth episode of its first season, which began airing in 2008, I
Survived chose two highly visible recent American catastrophes as its
subjects: the Virginia Tech shootings and the collapse of a bridge on highway
I-35 in Minneapolis. Although three interviewees discussed the Minneapolis
bridge collapse over about half of the program, the focus of this inquiry is the
other half of the show that dealt with the shootings at Virginia Tech. Three
survivors of the shootings were interviewed: a student named Derek, who
was shot in his classroom and then helped barricade a door with other
wounded students to prevent Cho from returning; a student named Colin,
who was shot multiple times in the classroom where Cho eventually killed
himself; and a professor named Ishwar, who hid with others in his office
while the shooting took place.
The entire I Survived series is based on an ideal of audience empathy for
survivors, and the Virginia Tech shooting segments were certainly no
exception. Derek, Colin, and Ishwar all went to great lengths in their
interviews to let the audience know what it felt like to be there during the
massacre, emotionally and in some cases physically. Derek described the
“repetitive sound of gunshots over and over” and how making eye contact
with Cho was “one of the scariest moments of [his] life” because of the
“emptiness in [Cho’s] face.” Colin described what it felt like to be shot in the
leg and hip. The show alternated between close-ups of the survivors’ faces as
they told their stories and footage taken in the classrooms where the students
were shot. Although this footage could have been of any empty classroom,
the show labeled it “Derek’s Classroom” and “Colin’s Classroom” so that the
audience could understand this was the real site where a real tragedy took
place. Avoiding staged reenactments, I Survived tried to capture the lingering,
haunting traces of tragedy by filming the locations as they existed long after
tragic events had taken place.
At times during the program, the interviewees added the kind of small
details that only those who had truly experienced such a tragedy could
provide. Derek described the way gunshot residue hung in the air, and Colin
talked about hearing cell phones ringing in the pockets and backpacks of
dead and wounded students lying in the classroom after the shooting. At other
times, their narration resembled the kinds of terrifying scenes that could have
been scripted by Hollywood screenwriters. Derek told of barricading the door
with three other wounded but mobile students as Cho returned and tried to
reenter the classroom by pushing the door open about six inches and firing
into the space. Colin described himself as wounded and defenseless, lying on
the ground and trying to play dead as Cho returned to his classroom. As Colin
peeked across the classroom, he watched Cho’s boots while the killer
methodically walked around the room shooting into the limp bodies of
wounded students. These narratives allowed audiences to behave morally, by
trying to understand even the mundane aspects of surviving such a harrowing
ordeal, and yet still access the small vicarious thrill that came from
consuming such dramatic tales.
All episodes of I Survived end with each interviewee explaining why
they believe they survived. These answers generally take either a spiritual
approach, in which god or fate is cited, or acknowledge the survivor’s
preparedness and resilience. In this episode, Colin sidestepped the question,
suggesting that he also wondered why he had survived and others had not,
and the third interviewee, Ishwar, discussed how hard it is for a group of
people to oppose someone with automatic weapons who has “lost
rationality.” But Derek gave the lengthiest answer, suggesting that he
survived because of “quick reactions, not only of myself, but because of my
classmates, and the professors on our floor. In our classroom … teamwork
definitely played a huge role in not only my survival, but maybe in the
survival of other students as well.” While the show did not make any
suggestions about charitable giving with which the audience could have aided
these and other survivors, it did offer the audience a lesson about survival in
case the audience members ever found themselves in a similar situation. This
amounted to a kind of self-help for other potential victims, a way to better
oneself through consumption similar to the consumerism of security after
September 11. Contrary to the sympathetic ideal in which spectatorship
necessitates action to alleviate the other’s suffering, the focus on empathy in I
Survived encouraged audiences to learn from the suffering of others, to better
themselves by simply understanding that suffering’s effects.
Of course, this combination of a therapeutic, self-help ideal with an
almost voyeuristic level of intimacy is characteristic not only of I Survived
but also of the entire genre of reality television. Given the powerful influence
on popular culture that reality television exudes today, the genre itself
requires a more detailed examination. Reality television creates an empathetic
way of looking and encourages an empathetic approach to the pain and
suffering of others in general, which must be further investigated to
understand contemporary norms concerning disaster consumption.

Reality Television and the Empathetic Gaze


As increasingly sophisticated electronic communication technologies have
come to expose audiences to the lives of others with increasing clarity and
intimacy, many critics have come to worry about the propagation of
voyeurism. As Luc Boltanski (1999, 26) has noted, Enlightenment
conceptions of sympathy were predicated on the spectator’s “ability to see
without being seen.” This position gave the spectator of suffering tremendous
power and created the potential for voyeuristic visual pleasure within the
sympathetic relationship:
Sympathy is implicated as a particularly perverse, panopticon
strategy. It is particularly perverse because its spectator is supposed
to be a moral authority moved by images; but he is also like the
faceless prison guard who reflects bureaucratic violence in the name
of “reform.” Sympathy is supposed to encourage the movement of
“feeling,” through vicarious affect and identification with someone
else’s emotion. Yet the process of vision prevents any true
movement associated with “feeling.” Hence, sympathy unleashes its
own psychical conflict. Sympathy, even more than the figure of the
panopticon, conceals the desire for and use of power through
identification. Through sympathy, the aggressivity of sentiment is
safely, perversely, released. (Hinton 1999, 16)

Hinton argued that modern notions of sympathy were predicated on a


sadomasochistic male gaze, as evidenced by Adam Smith’s assertion that
sympathy was a male-identified practice, and David Hume’s notion that
sympathetic moral judgments rely on the spectator’s experience of pleasure
or discomfort.
However, sympathy’s inherent injunction to act or speak out was based
on precisely the possibility of this accusation: sympathy required the
spectator to take some political stance to demonstrate that he was not taking
enjoyment in the spectacle of others’ suffering (Boltanski 1999). So while
this scopophilic, sadomasochistic impulse may indeed be a latent feature of
Enlightenment sympathy, it is perhaps more appropriate to discuss the
combination of mass-mediated emotion and visual pleasure in conjunction
with the contemporary shift toward empathy. Indeed, reality television is the
one genre of media that has emerged over the past twenty-five years based
precisely on this combination of empathetic emotional appeals and seemingly
voyeuristic viewing conditions.
Reality television is, of course, a broad term that encompasses some very
different kinds of programming, but certain themes and particular aesthetic
techniques tend to recur in everything from competition-based shows such as
Survivor to programs such as Rescue 911, which rely on retellings and
reenactments of real events. Some have suggested that at least two strains of
reality television exist—one based on confessional, therapeutic experiences
and the other based on more sensational representations of, for example,
crime or sexuality—and that these should be analyzed separately (see Dovey
2000). However, both types of reality-based programming exhibit salient
features of what I have called the empathetic gaze.
Most obviously, reality television relies on a claim to “the real” that sets
it apart from other genres of televised entertainment, despite the fact that
much of reality programming is produced, scripted, and edited like any other
fictional TV show. The documentary genre no longer has a monopoly on this
claim to the real, and although many aspects of documentary making have
been absorbed within reality television, new elements have been added to the
mix within our now “post-documentary” culture of television (Corner 2002,
257). These new elements reflect a shift in what is considered appropriately
public and private: contemporary reality TV emphasizes individual,
subjective experience, particularly when individuals have experienced some
sort of trauma or tragedy “which would once have remained private but
which [is] now restaged for public consumption” (Dovey 2000, 21–22).
This emphasis on the reality of subjective experience in the face of
misfortune suggests a crisis in the perception of reality itself. If these are the
lengths that television needs to go to in order to claim access to the real, by
staging and exposing “real life” suffering, then perhaps Guy Debord (2006),
Jean Baudrillard (1994), and other scholars of spectacle and simulation are
correct in asserting that reality has been lost. But as Mark Andrejevic (2004,
223) has pointed out, “Such programming stages not the dissolution of the
real but the inescapably real inadequacy of the concept of reality upon which
it relies.” He argues that reality programming tends not to produce dupes who
buy into its artifice as much as savvy viewers who recognize that what they
are watching is not truly real but then consume, critique, and enjoy the
programs nonetheless.
In any case, reality TV’s focus on the subjective experiences of the
participants who are the objects of the camera’s gaze marks the genre as an
exercise in empathizing. Media culture is increasingly populated with
“ordinary people,” and reality television puts the selfhood of those people on
display (Turner 2006). When those selves are seen to suffer, it allows us to
believe that their reactions are genuine, that they represent authentic
responses to interactions in even the most artificially constructed reality game
shows. On a wide variety of television shows, from the risqué couples retreat
Temptation Island to the therapeutic, discussion-based Oprah Winfrey Show,
suffering is seen as a means to achieve personal growth and a more fully
realized selfhood (Andrejevic 2004; Illouz 2003). Typically, film theorists
have defined voyeurism as the pleasure in identifying with the camera and its
gaze (see Metz 1992; Mulvey 1992). But in reality television, the pleasure of
the spectator comes more from identifying with the subject of the camera’s
gaze. The spectator is involved not in a relationship of voyeurism and
exhibitionism as much as engaged in a “transaction of vicarious witness and
empathy” (Corner 2002, 256). Participants in reality-based programming put
themselves on display, experiencing what appears to be genuine emotion, and
audiences exercise a kind of empathy that is at times savvy or skeptical but
ultimately taken as proof of the authenticity of both audience and performer.
This new set of viewing conditions, as well as the relationship between
spectator and screen associated with them, constitutes the empathetic gaze.
Although it emerged within the genre of reality television, as that genre
gained popularity and came to have a pervasive influence across much of
Western media entertainment, the empathetic gaze has found its way into
most of our mediated interactions with the suffering of others. Thus,
contemporary disaster consumption has come to exhibit this empathetic gaze,
as well. Just as reality shows such as Extreme Makeover: Home Edition used
the rebuilding of post–Katrina New Orleans as the setting for its specific
brand of uplifting personal transformations (see McMurria 2008), cable news
stories and documentaries about Hurricane Katrina have employed a focus on
individual suffering and its transformative possibilities in ways similar to
those employed in reality TV. Television programs about the Virginia Tech
shootings have used similar tropes, as has already been demonstrated. The
particular notions of authenticity and emotional identification at work in the
empathetic gaze appear frequently in all kinds of disaster consumption. But
these sorts of authenticity and identification have their limits, as a closer look
at two media texts related to Hurricane Katrina demonstrates.

Hurricane Katrina and the Limits of Empathy


While the empathetic gaze at work in disaster-related media has moved away
from the standard model of voyeuristic subject and exhibitionist object,
current viewing situations do still reflect and amplify certain relations of
power. The empathetic gaze is not innocuous, and the ideal of identifying
with and understanding the other’s suffering is subject to certain limits and
biases, especially concerning race and ethnicity. Those with the power to
control their positioning in front of the camera are likely to receive a more
fully empathetic depiction, as even NBC’s handling of Seung-Hui Cho’s
Virginia Tech manifesto attests. However, as much Hurricane Katrina news
coverage attests, the camera can also exaggerate difference and therefore
impede empathetic identification. An analysis of one cable news broadcast
and one documentary film about Katrina reveals more about the limits of
mass-consumed empathy.
On September 1, 2005, Anderson Cooper had been broadcasting from
the Gulf Coast area for four days. Although he was unable to get into New
Orleans with his crew until later, Cooper had set up live broadcasts of his AC
360 from the nearby suburb of Waveland, Mississippi. The September 1
broadcast of the program exhibited just how thoroughly the empathetic ideal
has permeated the news media, but also how blatantly limited that empathy
can be. Of course, it is worth repeating that many Americans contributed their
time and money to relief efforts in the wake of the hurricane, and the
assertion that empathy is an ascendant emotional reaction to contemporary
disasters should not be taken to mean that no one offers direct assistance in
the wake of disasters any longer. Rather, emergent norms concerning
empathy within popular culture now offer an emotional and ethical
alternative to the requirements of sympathetic action.
The tone of the September 1 AC 360 broadcast oscillated from a deeply
emotional response to the storm, evinced by Cooper himself and many of his
reporters and their interviewees, to a wildly exaggerated description of its
chaotic aftermath. Although the distinction was not completely clear-cut,
African American hurricane victims frequently were associated with the
“chaotic” portion of this narrative while white victims were more often
involved in an empathetic interaction or portrayal. While Cooper frequently
blamed federal and state governments for their failure or inability to act, the
recurring footage of looting and lawlessness in New Orleans presented a
highly problematic image of the city’s African American residents.
Cooper was widely praised for his coverage of the hurricane and
specifically for two moments in this particular broadcast. In the first, Cooper
angrily confronted Louisiana’s Senator Mary Landrieu during an interview,
as she appeared via remote broadcast from Baton Rouge. Cooper started by
asking Landrieu whether the federal government was responsible and should
apologize to the people of the Gulf Coast. Landrieu immediately began to
sidestep the question, offering thanks to former presidents Bush and Clinton
for their words of support, and senators Frist and Reid, before Cooper
interrupted, telling Landrieu:

For the last four days, I’ve been seeing dead bodies in the streets
here in Mississippi. And to listen to politicians thanking each other
and complimenting each other, you know, I’ve got to tell you, there
are a lot of people here who are very upset, and very angry, and
very frustrated. And when they hear politicians slap—you know,
thanking one another, it just, you know, it kind of cuts them the
wrong way right now, because literally there was a body on the
streets of this town yesterday being eaten by rats because this
woman had been laying in the street for 48 hours. And there’s not
enough facilities to take her up. Do you get the anger that is out
here?

Interestingly, although the interview began with a question about the material
inadequacy of the government’s response, the substance of Cooper’s anger at
Landrieu involved the emotional inadequacy of her personal response, which
he felt did not reflect the gravity of the situation and was insufficiently
sensitive to the suffering of those on the ground—including himself. The
visual elements of the exchange reflected this imbalance of empathy. While
Landrieu was thanking politicians, CNN cut to aerial shots of flooded
swampland and overturned boats, then back to the senator on dry ground in
front of a government building with people leisurely talking in groups behind
her and SUVs driving in and out of the frame. In contrast to the pristinely
made up Landrieu, Cooper was filmed with his sleeves rolled up, in front of a
giant pile of debris and wooden planks that used to be houses.
Later in the program, Cooper offered himself as an example of a
properly empathetic emotional response to such suffering. The show
broadcast footage of a family in a pickup truck parked in front of piles of
wooden beams, an overturned boat, and other debris while the white men and
girls in the back of the truck held up a torn and muddy American flag for the
camera. The camera cut back to Cooper, who began to explain the footage in
very emotional, therapeutic terms, stating, “We are seeing things like this,
just an outpouring of love and care for, uh, for people in this community, and
people in this community are helping one another, and standing by one
another. There has been some looting, yeah, but uh, but uh, well …” At that
point, Cooper appeared to wave to the people in the truck who were off-
camera, then tried to resume speaking, with an obvious lump in his throat.
His voice cracked as he sputtered out another “um,” then he paused and
looked away from the camera for three or four seconds of dead air as he tried
to compose himself, clearly fighting off tears. Excusing himself to the
audience for his emotional outburst with a quick “sorry,” he preceded then to
the next segment.
This moment of dead air and choked emotion had a big impact on
audiences and media critics alike. During this first week of hurricane
coverage, viewership of AC 360 increased by 400 percent (Van Meter 2005).
Cooper was hailed for his empathy, for allowing viewers a peak behind the
news anchor veneer to his genuine humanity. Even before the hurricane,
Cooper had been regarded as a new breed of “emoanchor,” an exemplar of “a
reality TV ‘authenticity,’ with human dimensions, rather than the stentorian,
scripted authority of the network era” (Hagan 2005, para. 11). But his
reaction to the suffering of Hurricane Katrina’s victims cemented that
position and seemed to confirm a shift in expectations about the emotional
responses of the news media to tragic events. As one commentator put it,
“Not long ago, television was a no-cry zone. The top newsmen were
celebrated for their emotional control in the face of gut-punching
developments. War, death, terrorism, plague—nothing rattled their
composure… . These days, everywhere you look you see anchors seemingly
on the verge of losing their composure” (Gillette 2009, para. 2, 9). Although
Walter Cronkite famously choked up when he announced President
Kennedy’s death, he later expressed regret, explaining that his momentary
loss of composure had been inappropriate for a news anchor (Lloyd 2009).
Cooper and the new generation of emotional cable news personalities like
him are largely unrepentant about their on-air displays of emotion (Gillette
2009; Van Meter 2005).
But there are limitations to this kind of on-air empathy. Cooper’s
broadcast crew were stationed in the predominantly white suburb of
Waveland, and the anchor’s personal interactions with others took place
there, including his coverage of a husband and wife returning to find that
their home was little more than a pile of wreckage. As the wife picked out
photos and other possessions from the rubble in the background, Cooper
intoned that “reporters are supposed to remain distant observers. There is no
distance in Waveland anymore.” Such a statement, especially as CNN’s
cameras focused uncomfortably closely on this sobbing woman kneeling in
the littered debris that was her home, served to excuse that kind of intensely
intimate coverage of the suffering of others. After all, audiences saw how
moved Cooper had been by the devastation in Waveland and the resilience of
its residents, and he had expressed their anger to Senator Landrieu. Clearly he
had their best interests in mind. But even though emotionally identifying with
the people of Waveland offered some justification for publicly broadcasting
their suffering in intimate detail, it seemed to forestall identification with
slightly more distant others.
Despite Cooper’s attempts to extend the reach of his empathy to the
predominantly African American residents of New Orleans, many of the
segments that focused on the city and its residents were filled with
stereotypes about looting and chaos. There were as many examples of
“othering” as of empathizing, and this fear of violence and lawlessness
loomed large over the entire broadcast. Perhaps because the network lacked
enough footage of this sort of behavior to match the frequency with which the
topic was discussed, at least four different video clips containing antisocial
behavior or violence in New Orleans were broadcast more than once during
this hour-long program. The need to replay these same images of inner-city
chaos should have clued producers in to the potentially overstated quality of
this threat, but it did not. Instead, voiceover narration reframed the reused
footage without acknowledging its previous context. For instance, one shot of
a man with his back to the camera drawing a gun on an apparent looter was
broadcast in black and white at the beginning of the program as the narrator
declared “shop owners armed and dangerous.” Later, when the same footage
was broadcast in color, it became apparent that the gunman was a law
enforcement officer, not a shopkeeper, and the footage was part of a segment
on lawmen “restoring order.” In both cases, the image portrayed an African
American, who may or may not have actually been engaged in illegal
activity, as a kind of inhuman or stereotypical other, the target of a defensive
shopkeeper or a courageous police officer, not a victim himself of the larger
circumstances surrounding the hurricane and its aftermath.
Perhaps the most egregious form of racial othering on this broadcast
came from a series of images of a black man attempting to break into a store.
The footage showed a young, shirtless man with his back to the camera
repeatedly swinging a metal baseball bat into the glass door of what appeared
to be an upscale store or bank. In many ways this young man epitomized the
type of male African American who scares mainstream white America, with
his dark skin and muscular frame and his low-hanging, baggy jeans exposing
the top of his buttocks. As if the subtext about this stereotypical image
needed emphasizing, the voiceover during these images did not describe this
particular man’s story or even talk about looting in conjunction with the
image. Instead, CNN’s Chris Lawrence reported that “some women were
walking by. The police officers told them—ordered them, in fact—that they
could not go down one particular street, told them that there have been
groups of young men going around, shooting people, attempting to rape
women, and ordered them to continue walking in the other direction.” The
fact that the image of this man’s violent—though ultimately unsuccessful—
attempt to break into a store was accompanied by an anecdote about the
threat of rape suggests, once again, that the African American population of
New Orleans was subject to frequent racial stereotyping almost as a
counterweight to the hyper-empathetic coverage of whites in Waveland.
Of course, many moments of pathos were exhibited by black New
Orleans residents during the program, and some very humane, empathetic
representations of those residents were exhibited during the course of the
show. One man, interviewed at the start of the program moments after he had
disembarked from a bus in Houston that had picked him up from the
Superdome, described in a voice fraught with tension, “I’m just disgusted
right now. My head is killing me. I’m just stressed out right now. I’m tired. I
need a bed. I need a bath. I’m just overdue, for everything.” The man spoke
with the camera in a closeup shot of his face the entire time, his palpably
fragile emotional state a testament to the toll that the storm had taken on the
New Orleans evacuees.
But CNN’s Adori Udoji immediately followed that footage up by
mentioning lawlessness and looting, using the oft-repeated, if
unsubstantiated, claim that “some took only what they needed to survive,
others took whatever they could: appliances, clothes, guns.” The footage that
accompanied this claim involved African Americans walking into and out of
a closed Walgreens pharmacy. The first woman caught on camera covered
her face as she exited with apparently looted groceries, including a package
of Huggies diapers. Real pathos could have been found in that image, as well,
and the reporter could have urged the audience to imagine the conditions that
would drive this woman, clearly uncomfortable with her decision, to have to
steal diapers in the middle of a flooded, dangerous city. But the image was
instead presented as little more than a virtual “perp walk”—not a means to
elicit fellow feeling but an impediment to audience identification and
empathy.
None of this is to say that the program’s producers maliciously edited
their footage or scripted their stories with explicitly racist intent. Certainly,
the logistical difficulties of reporting from New Orleans in the storm’s
aftermath contributed to a lack of footage and sources through which a more
nuanced and factual take could have been constructed. But without even
speculating about the producers’ intent, the broadcast itself tells a story in
which the empathetic ideal does not extend equally to all demographics of
storm victims. This was reflected in the imbalance with which blacks and
whites were portrayed as empathetic victims; although empathy sometimes
extended to black victims, shown waiting desperately at the Superdome or
begging the government on-camera for help, it always extended to the white
residents of Waveland, even occasionally transforming into acts of
sympathetic aid. Twice the program offered a white hurricane survivor the
chance to say his name and have his picture on camera to let his family and
friends know that he was safe. No similar announcements were made by
nonwhite survivors. The show also told the story of Tad and Helena Breaux,
a white couple who had been trying to track down their baby, who had been
left in an evacuating New Orleans hospital. With the help of media outlets,
including CNN, they were able to locate their infant son and were about to go
to Fort Worth, Texas, to pick him up when they appeared on AC 360. Again,
no nonwhite couple appeared to receive a similar level of assistance from the
show or network. While this may be due to the logistics of producing a news
program outside a major city in which normal lines of communication have
been disrupted, the over-reliance on whites for the most in-depth, humane
coverage in the broadcast served to magnify the stereotypical representations
of African Americans. This disjunction in news media coverage was reflected
in large racial differences in attitudes about the storm, with black audiences
more likely to feel that race was a factor in the government’s treatment of
victims (Herring 2006) and more likely to strongly empathize with those
victims (Haider-Markel, Delehanty, and Beverlin 2007).
The empathetic ideal requires the spectator to identify emotionally with
an unfortunate victim, but the representation of that victim is highly
susceptible to racial stereotyping and othering. The same can probably be
said for audiences themselves, who bring their own class, racial, and political
biases to the viewing situation. Classical expressions of sympathy were, at
least in theory, free from such problems in that they required the sympathetic
spectator to prove his emotional commitment was based on only rational
consideration for the suffering of another. A valid commitment had to “be
purely moral, that is to say free from any determination by interests and
consequently from any prior communal ties” (Boltanski 1999, 31). Such
morality had to be established “without recourse to notions of tribal solidarity
or emotional community” (Boltanski 1999, 38). The same cannot be said of
the contemporary empathetic ideal—the kind of vicarious, intersubjective
emotional bond that constitutes this ideal appears vulnerable to a variety of
prejudices.
One might wonder, however, what the story of Hurricane Katrina and its
poor African American victims would look like when told by one of those
victims and whether different processes of emotional expression and
audience identification might be at work. Certainly, initial coverage of
Katrina in the black press was more critical of both the government and
mainstream news sources (Dolan, Sonnett, and Johnson 2009). But one film
that further explored these issues was Trouble the Water (2008), which told
the story of Kimberly Roberts, a twenty-four-year-old aspiring hip-hop artist
who rode out the storm in her Lower Ninth Ward house with her husband,
Scott, and their neighbors. Although the film was directed by Tia Lessin and
Carl Deal, collaborators of Michael Moore’s who had come to New Orleans
to do a story on the return of the Louisiana National Guard from Iraq to its
flooded hometown, much of the film consisted of camcorder footage Roberts
shot of her neighborhood and her experiences before, during, and after the
storm. Upon meeting up with Lessin and Deal, in addition to being filmed by
their crew, Roberts continued to record her experiences on a camcorder as
she and her husband tried to reconnect with family and friends and begin a
new life. With a title that references the old spiritual song “Wade in the
Water,” the film is ultimately a story of redemption for Kim and Scott,
though with some pessimistic undertones about the fate of New Orleans as a
whole.
At film festivals, during its limited theatrical release, and when it was
broadcast on the HBO network, the film received a host of positive reviews,
many of which made reference to the film’s ability to expand the empathic
capacity of its audience. As one reviewer put it, “No human being I can
imagine could watch ‘Trouble the Water’ and not be overwhelmed by grief
and joy, and humbled by one’s sudden awareness of one’s own prejudices
about the lives, passions and dreams of poor people. George W. Bush would
weep buckets at this movie” (O’Hehir 2008, para. 7). It is not hard to
understand why critics found Trouble the Water so emotionally resonant. The
film contained numerous acts of heroism: Kim offered food and shelter to
neighbors in her flooded house’s attic; she videotaped her neighbor Larry
ferrying stranded people back and forth between houses using a punching bag
as a flotation device; and she commandeered an unused truck with her
husband and neighbors and drove everyone out of the city after four days
stranded there. It also exhibited the harsh and often maddening realities of
post–Katrina New Orleans, specifically the bureaucratic indifference with
which the local and federal authorities handled the storm’s poorest victims. In
one scene, Kim, Scott, and a friend named Brian return to Kim’s uncle’s
house in New Orleans and find his corpse there, despite the fact that search-
and-rescue teams have already marked the house as having no bodies inside.
Later in the film, Kim’s brother tells of being abandoned in a New Orleans
prison as guards evacuated without explaining to the prisoners what was
happening and without providing food or water. The grandmother who raised
Kim also died during Katrina in a New Orleans hospital, and the film briefly
records the funeral.
Certainly, through all of this there were many moments of emotional
expression that seemed likely to inspire empathetic audience responses. The
aesthetic features of the footage itself contributed to this authenticity. The
low-resolution “rawness” of such amateur video often “conveys both the
massive scale and strikingly intimate details of suffering” (McCosker 2013,
383). Some of these are small moments: after Kim and Scott drive their
fellow refugees out of the city, one of the elderly neighbors thanks Kim for
saving her life, and Kim’s sheepish, almost embarrassed grin proves
revealing and heartwarming. Others are focal points of the film: when Kim’s
cousin meets her at her temporary residence in Memphis, while playing the
only surviving copy of her music on his car stereo, her unbridled joy is quite
powerful. It also leads to perhaps the most iconic moment in the film, in
which Kim raps along to a song she wrote and recorded about her life and the
obstacles that she had faced and overcome.
But that moment also exposed some of the film’s weaknesses and some
shortcomings of the empathetic gaze in general. Throughout the film, one
could not escape the feeling that one already knew the outcome.
Paradoxically, in the case of such a major disaster, the audience understood
from the outset that the story would be a tale of overcoming and
perseverance, of forging a better self through adversity and suffering. While
such narratives perhaps have always had their appeal, the merger of
psychotherapeutic ideas with popular entertainment in formats such as
television talk shows has made them more commonplace (Illouz 2003). Not
only have audiences come to expect this theme; in this case, the film’s
subject seemed to be hyper-aware of the potential public interest in the
footage before Hurricane Katrina even hit. Early in the film, when she took
her camera into a small grocery store to record people stocking up for the
storm, she declared, “This is a little doc I’m doing, just in case it’s all gone, I
got it all on tape. See, I’m showing the world that we did have a world,
before the storm came.” Her almost eerily prescient comment there was
followed by a later discussion with some neighbors of the more explicitly
promotional possibilities of her recording. “If I get some exciting shit,” she
joked, “I might gonna send it to them white folks, ya heard!” And indeed, at
the start of the film the audience is shown footage of Kim and Scott
approaching the filmmakers and promoting the footage that she collected.
She tells them that “this needs to be worldwide. All the footage I’ve seen on
TV, nobody ain’t got what I got. I got right there in the hurricane!”
Of course, this is not to cast aspersions on Kim, her husband, or the
documentary filmmakers with whom she created Trouble the Water. Her
actions during and after Katrina were indeed heroic, and her desire to
promote herself and her fledging music career using the footage of those
actions was certainly no different from the motives of any of the thousands of
reality television contestants, although her story was far more compelling.
But that is also part of the problem. In the end, while the film was highly
critical of the government’s response to the hurricane, its need to graft the
standard narrative of overcoming and perseverance onto Kim’s life story felt
almost unfair to the thousands of other Katrina victims for whom the storm
offered no redemptive possibilities. Certainly, the film’s narrative did justice
to Kim’s personal interpretation of suffering as the key to building a better
self, which she emphasized throughout. Discussing her impending move to
Memphis, she stated that she planned to “go out there, start my music career,
find me a church where I can go worship. I’m already at the bottom, I can’t
go down, I can’t do nothing but go up. Hope I can put this hurricane stuff
behind me, but if not I’m ready to face them head on, nose to nose, neck to
neck too. It don’t matter to me, but at least I’m trying to do something
different, trying to, you know, trying. When you try, you know, you get
results, so I’m trying to better my life.”
Scott expressed a similar desire to start his life over, to “see how it is to
do it right from the beginning,” and Kim explained how she was refusing to
let her fear about the move control her. While these were laudable sentiments,
they didn’t sound that different from the concluding remarks of reality show
contestants on even tawdry shows such as Temptation Island. One such
contestant, whose long-term relationship was almost ruined because of his
behavior on that show, put it this way: “Every time I made a choice, I made
the difficult choice because I knew that would be the way of growing and that
would be my way of learning about myself and becoming who I am and
learning about my individuality” (quoted in Andrejevic 2004, 192). In both
cases, suffering was seen as an opportunity for personal growth.
However, if such giant catastrophes as Hurricane Katrina end up boiling
down simply to opportunities for their victims’ self-improvement, then
certainly the onus is no longer on spectators to take sympathetic action in the
wakes of catastrophes. Rather, the emotional work of empathizing with
suffering others as they attempt to better themselves is proof enough of one’s
moral worth and a chance to improve oneself vicariously in the process. At
the end of the film, Kim is shown working on a song in a music studio, and
her husband is seen enjoying his new job doing construction work. Both are
back in New Orleans, seemingly better for the experience. These are
definitely stories to be celebrated, especially given how hard the storm hit so
many of the area’s other poor African American residents. Yet the viewer’s
identification with this against-all-odds success story offers a sense of
narrative closure that is perhaps anathema to the film’s larger political
mission. After all, the film’s advertising tagline, “It’s not about a hurricane.
It’s about America,” suggests that it will offer a systemic critique of
inequality and racism in the urban United States, but in Kim and Scott’s
story, one may instead see a variant of the Horatio Alger myth. By displaying
these two disaster victims as actually empowered and improved by the
experience, the film establishes the vicarious consumption of others’
suffering as the audience member’s primary moral requirement: viewers can
feel good about themselves simply by feeling for these ultimately fortunate
protagonists.
Thus, in stories of tragedy or triumph, the empathetic ideal drains
disaster of its political potential. Although anger at the government’s inept
response to Hurricane Katrina was certainly a big part of the emotional
response to Trouble the Water and AC 360, that anger was steered away from
some explicitly political avenues. The process of translating emotional
identification with a suffering unfortunate into an active critique of the social,
economic, or governmental forces behind that suffering, and of making
compensatory demands on the responsible parties, exemplifies classical
notions of sympathy within a robust public sphere. Although such a process
was at times suggested by these two texts, both ultimately went in other
directions that highlight some of empathy’s limitations. In this way, the
conditions for an active, critical, and sympathetic public sphere are
challenged by this alternative, empathetic, consumerist style of apprehending
the suffering of others and the potential for racial and class bias in its
emotional forms of identification.
Mainstream American culture in the first decade of the twenty-first
century was more familiar with individualistic narratives of self-help than
collective struggles for civil rights or fair labor practices, a fact that helps
explain why individualistic, empathetic ways of looking at disaster resonated
so much. Coupled with the almost limitless amount of others’ suffering to
which contemporary mass media can expose audiences today, one can see
why a kind of depoliticization of such suffering may be desirable for
audiences. This is especially true when one considers the time frame over
which these events develop. News stories in a consumer society, even ones as
monumental as Hurricane Katrina, have a shelf life; they get consumed and
quickly lose their appeal. Eight months after the hurricane, news coverage of
the painstakingly slow reconstruction of New Orleans had dissipated, due
supposedly to audiences’ and producers’ “Katrina fatigue” (Kurtz 2006).
Even Anderson Cooper was criticized for CNN’s seeming abandonment of
the story he himself promised not to give up on in a June 21, 2006, interview
on The Daily Show with Jon Stewart. The empathetic gaze offers the
assurance of personal catharsis as an alternative to the uncertainties of
political commitment in our fast-moving, media-saturated world. Thus, the
deeply empathetic response to the suffering caused by Katrina could not
outlast the speed of contemporary news cycles and, less than a year later,
seemed to have made little difference in on-the-ground reconstruction efforts
that have continued into the present day to privatize the city’s public goods,
gentrify its neighborhoods, and leave out its poorest residents (Akers 2012; L.
Graham 2012; Green, Kouassi, and Mambo 2013).
Conclusion: Empathy and the Paradoxes of Authenticity
In some ways, Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech shootings were very
different kinds of catastrophes. In terms of the loss of life and property, and
their immediate political implications, the two events varied greatly. The
government’s inadequate response to Katrina was regarded by many as a
referendum on the Bush presidency and on the persistence of racial inequality
in urban America, while the Virginia Tech shootings prompted a brief
“advocacy free-for-all” (Furedi 2007b) that resulted in little public consensus
and in some ways seemed to rehash familiar media frameworks adopted after
the Columbine shooting in 1999. Even the news broadcasts and documentary
films discussed in this chapter have vast differences. The anchors of the two
news broadcasts, Brian Williams and Anderson Cooper, have very different
emotional styles that were reflected in their news coverage. And the
purposefully somber narratives delivered by Virginia Tech shooting victims
on I Survived varied greatly from the eyewitness camcorder footage and
occasional exuberance of Trouble the Water. Yet the mass consumption of
both disasters, as reflected in all four of the media texts examined here,
exhibited certain common themes.
Although the empathetic ideal encourages emotional identification with
the people on screen, it requires some guarantee of the genuineness or
authenticity of what one is watching. In the programs discussed in this
chapter, such guarantees were based on a combination of the technical or
aesthetic qualities of the media at hand and the personal self-performances of
those on-screen. The technical qualities of the slightly shaky and grainy
footage of stranded, grief-stricken, or frightened Katrina victims lent added
weight to their emotional on-camera testimony. When the broadcast lacked
any traces of this aesthetic, as in the footage of Anderson Cooper anchoring
the live broadcast from Waveland, Cooper painted himself as a fellow
sufferer of the storm by losing his composure on camera. Kim Roberts’s
camcorder footage from the eye of the storm served a similar function: it
cemented her identity as a compassionate, heroic, and authentic storm
survivor and propelled that status through the long, post-hurricane portion of
the film, where the camera quality improved and outside filmmakers got
involved.
When no live disaster footage was available, as in the I Survived episode
dedicated to the Virginia Tech shootings, an intense focus on the personal
experience of the victims sufficed as an assurance of authenticity. That
program eschewed the use of recycled news footage and reenactments of
dramatic events, and even edited the interviewer completely out of the
traumatic narratives relayed by the shooting’s survivors, to focus on the
interviewees’ intimate, personal performances of trauma and grief. By
contrast, the episode of NBC Nightly News with Brian Williams that
contained Cho’s multimedia manifesto attested, once again, to the incredible
power of first-person disaster footage, although in this case the person in
question was actually the cause of the disaster. American consumer culture
venerates such footage of the tragic or disastrous precisely because it is
thought to be more authentic than the rest of the media landscape, and in this
case Cho’s authorship of the images imbued them with a powerful aura. This
aura attracted Brian Williams and NBC’s producers enough for them to
ignore the public outrage that airing such controversial documents was bound
to, and did, stir up. But the empathetic ideal extended to Cho, too, as
Williams and his guests led the audience through his words and images on a
search for psychological clues to the killer’s mind-set and motivation.
Film theory has long established the potential of cinema’s projection
technologies and viewing conditions to create audience identification with the
camera’s objectifying gaze. More recently, scholars of reality television have
described the different kinds of audience identification associated with that
genre of entertainment. This chapter has suggested that a kind of empathetic
gaze, derived in part from the ways of seeing associated with reality
television, is embedded in the four media texts analyzed here and the
consumption of disaster more generally. This gaze involves a way of looking
at and identifying with the subjective experiences of those on whom the
camera’s gaze is fixed. Rather than the detached, voyeuristic gaze of
Hollywood cinema, the empathetic gaze elicits the spectator’s vicarious
emotional connection to the subject on the screen and is especially prominent
when that subject has been shown to have genuinely suffered. In a culture
that greatly esteems the ability to empathize with one’s lovers, family
members, or co-workers, the emotional work of empathizing with on-screen
suffering is itself a pleasurable aspect of the viewing experience called forth
by the empathetic gaze.
In stark contrast to the ideal of sympathy, which involves acting or, at
least, speaking out on behalf of those who suffer, this mediated empathy is
more about self-improvement than improving the condition of unfortunates.
In that way, the empathetic gaze meshes well with other forms of mass
consumption such as the purchasing of T-shirts, athletic apparel, CDs, or
souvenirs. While much of the proceeds from these kinds of purchases have
gone to relief efforts for victims of Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech
shootings, such purchases also serve to mark consumers as emotionally
sensitive individuals who care about the fate of others. The positive impact
on one’s own identity of such seemingly altruistic behavior is a motivating
factor even for people who volunteer directly (Hayes 2004; McMurria 2008).
Rather than reawakening the long-standing debate over the possibility of
truly altruistic behavior (see Piliavin 2008), the consumption of disaster
mitigates the tension between egotistic and altruistic actions, suggesting that
empathetically motivated consumption is in and of itself a moral action,
regardless of its limited effect on the conditions of those who suffer. This
ideal works in tandem with contemporary pop-psychological attitudes that
suffering and victimhood can always be transformed by victims themselves
into opportunities for self-improvement and renewal.
This sort of consumption-oriented empathy for distant others has its
limits and lacunae, however. Basing one’s fellow feeling for distant others on
how identifiable one finds them leaves the entire empathetic process
vulnerable to personal prejudices. The philosopher Jesse Prinz (2011, 227)
has noted, “Empathy is partial; we feel greater empathy for those who are
similar to ourselves.” The fact that looped, often out-of-context footage of
African American looters co-existed on AC 360 with a segment in which the
news anchor was close to openly weeping at the site of a truckload of white
hurricane victims suggests no less. Studies, in fact, have confirmed the
existence of empathy’s racial biases; one found that whites who strongly
identified with their own racial group heavily biased their charitable giving
against black hurricane victims (Fong and Luttmer 2007), and another
confirmed that even on a sensory level, we experience more empathy for
people with the same skin color (Avenanti, Sirigu, and Aglioti 2010). In this
sense, Enlightenment notions of sympathy that disqualified communal,
familial, or ethnic considerations in favor of a more rational, objective
consideration of others’ suffering are superior to the empathetic ideal, at least
in theory. Of course, in practice the same racial biases, as well as class and
gender prejudices, likely rendered many unfortunate sufferers invisible to
classical advocates of sympathy such as Smith and Hume.
More than simply racial biases, then, the empathetic gaze is vulnerable
to the larger paradoxes of authenticity. If one is to properly identify with the
suffering of others, one must first be assured that their suffering is genuine.
But unlike the rational consideration of claims to victimhood associated with
sympathy, this empathetic ideal rests on the spectator’s subjective evaluation
of the authenticity of the other’s suffering. Although skillfully presented
personal narratives such as those on I Survived are often enough to guarantee
that the subjects’ emotions are genuine, first-person footage and live
broadcasting from disaster zones are more effective, and the aesthetic and
technological cues associated with these scenarios transform the authenticity
of unfortunates from a question into a given. The results, however, are a
ceaseless quest for increasingly intimate footage of suffering; an increasing
number of reporters on the scene as a disaster unfolds and mounting pressure
to broadcast traumatic images, regardless of who produced them or what their
broadcast might mean for victims or potential imitators.
This is part of the empathetic hedonism of catastrophe consumption.
Disasters are undeniably real, and empathy for their distant victims marks
one as an authentic, moral human being. At the same time, the exhilaration of
these emotions and the novelty of the most harrowing disasters are
themselves pleasures with a very powerful appeal to consumers. “Indeed, so-
called ‘negative’ emotions often evoke stronger feelings than the others, they
actually provide a greater potential for pleasure” (C. Campbell 1987, 70).
But, of course, empathy is never fully achieved. We can never be sure how
well we really understand another’s pain. And coverage of that pain could
always be timelier, more intimate, more emotional. Thus, the appetite for
empathy cannot be easily sated and must be fed repeatedly, frequently
resulting in the kinds of “disaster marathon” (Blondheim and Liebes 2003)
coverage for which news organizations are often criticized.
Such coverage is, in its pursuit of deeply authentic emotional
experiences, often experienced as highly insensitive and inauthentic.
Throwing a camera in the face of a shocked Virginia Tech student moments
after the shootings or following a Waveland homeowner as she combs
through the rubble of her house may generate a certain kind of intimacy, but
it can also appear craven and obvious. What is more, the stubborn distance
between spectator and sufferer persists no matter how intimate the coverage.
The only thing that is certain in the quest for such a fleeting authenticity is
that it will continue to rely on the raw materials of tragedy and disaster,
mining the ore of real emotion that such harrowing events contain.
In strict terms, it is inaccurate to call contemporary disaster consumption
voyeuristic. The contemporary emphasis on empathy means that spectators of
suffering are less likely to objectify the on-screen sufferer and more likely to
identify with him or her. It is similarly unfair to call such consumption
immoral; instead, one might more accurately suggest that alternative moral
and normative codes concerning the suffering of others have emerged that
encourage ethically minded consumers to engage in an empathetic form of
spectatorship. This approach recasts the consumers of disaster from
voyeuristic spectators to ethical bystanders. But the empathetic ideal does
serve to neutralize the political potential of disasters. If, in the face of mass
destruction, one is asked only to empathize with the victims, then even the
most widespread anger, outrage, and sorrow need not motivate any political
act more involved than the purchase of a T-shirt whose proceeds go to
charity.
This discontinuity between actual aid and emotional connection was
perhaps best reflected in a moment on AC 360 in which Kathleen Koch, a
CNN reporter who grew up in Waveland, talked with Cooper about her
emotional response to the devastation there. The lack of resources for
survivors, Koch said, “[made me] want to throw down my microphone and
just take all the water that we have in our vehicle and give it to them and start
driving up and down the streets,” a sentiment with which Cooper appeared to
agree. But, of course, Koch and Cooper did not drop what they were doing
and give away all their water; nor had they planned to. It is particularly
indicative of the contemporary cultural moment that Koch’s failure to follow
through on her desire to help was not seen as an indictment, yet her
expression of the emotional urge to do so was presented as laudatory in and
of itself. In such a context, disaster victims can expect powerful, widespread
public support for their recovery, but that will likely mean emotional support
and psychological recovery. The empathetic gaze is thus a means to cope
with our own powerlessness as we watch tragedies unfold, not a tool to
encourage positive social and political change. What is more, as the next
chapter shows, this sort of empathy can lead to heightened levels of fear and
their manipulation by elite interests.
3

THE AUTHENTICITY OF FEAR

September 11 and the Financial Crisis

O n September 15, 2001, after four days of live coverage of the September
11 attacks without commercial breaks, network television began to return to
its regularly scheduled programming. This pause in the televisual routine was
the longest in American history, surpassing the three days of nonstop
coverage triggered by President John F. Kennedy’s assassination and funeral
in 1963 (Carter and Rutenberg 2001). The nightly news shows and cable
news channels continued their coverage of the attacks, however, focusing as
they had been on the victims and their families, the recovery efforts at the
World Trade Center, and the investigations into who was responsible. And
like the rest of the American public, a majority of whom believed that another
terrorist attack was likely (Pew Research Center for the People and the Press
2001b), television news began to look ahead. As the CBS reporter John
Roberts suggested in one Evening News broadcast, “American fears have
turned to what might be next.” He went on to claim, “This most recent attack
was of such an Apocalyptic nature we may have to redefine the very meaning
of the word ‘terrorism.’”
Roberts’s commentary was prescient on multiple levels. In the month
and a half that followed, the United States launched its global war on terror
with the invasion of Afghanistan and signed into law the Uniting and
Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept
and Obstruct Terrorism Act (the USA PATRIOT Act, which is commonly
referred to as simply the Patriot Act). With these two moves, the word
“terrorism” was indeed redefined; no longer simply describing a particular
tactic, it became the justification for foreign wars, the rationale behind an
explosion of domestic security procedures and surveillance programs, and a
buzzword for a host of new fears and suddenly looming threats. One new
threat was biological warfare. Unknown sources started sending anthrax
through the mail to seemingly random targets in the government and news
media beginning on September 18 and proceeding for several weeks.
Although only seventeen people were infected and five died, these anthrax
attacks were presented as proof that the threat of terrorism persisted in the
United States beyond 9/11 in ways that were not necessarily suggested by
9/11 and that could affect any and all Americans. As one unidentified female
bystander said in an October 12, 2001, edition of CBS Evening News,
“Checking your mail just took on a new meaning.”
Roughly six-and-a-half years later, a very different sort of threat
exploded into public consciousness. From March to October 2008,
Americans came to understand themselves as enmeshed in a global financial
crisis, as major banks and venerable investment houses began to admit to
insolvency and lawmakers started debating the merits of massive federal
intervention in the financial markets. As the months proceeded and new
revelations made clear that the entire U.S. financial industry was threatened,
officials and experts came on television to repeatedly make the case for
government intervention. The resultant federal legislation, the Emergency
Economic Stabilization Act, like the Patriot Act before it, was a wide-
reaching and controversial act of governance with vast consequences that
were only dimly understood at the time.
These two very different catastrophes were nonetheless treated similarly
in American media and political culture. Both inspired extensive news
coverage, political commentary, advertisements, and a variety of consumer
goods and services. Both disasters were described by politicians, financial or
military experts, and journalists as worst-case scenarios that were largely
unforeseeable, even though warning signs and historical precedents existed
for both cases (see Eichenwald 2012; Reinhart and Rogoff 2009). Most
important, the news media presented both terrorism and financial crisis as
potential threats to all Americans, not just those living in major cities or
working in the finance industry. As Diane Swonk, chief economist at
Moody’s, cautioned the audience of ABC World News on March 17, 2008,
“What you care about on Main Street is that this crunch on Wall Street
doesn’t spill over to Main Street.”
Yet although both the Patriot Act and the Emergency Economic
Stabilization Act were successfully signed into law in response to these two
threats, only one of these was the subject of fierce public resistance. The
Patriot Act was quickly enacted with almost unanimous support from
lawmakers, and opinion polls showed widespread public support for it
initially and even two and three years after its passage (Moore 2003; Saad
2004). But the Troubled Asset Relief Program (TARP), the initial name for
the federal government’s proposed intervention into the markets, faced heavy
public opposition, resulting in its rejection in the House of Representatives
(Hulse and Herszenhorn 2008). A few days later, TARP was passed in the
Senate and then in the House in the form of the Emergency Economic
Stabilization Act of 2008, thanks to increased public relations efforts by
government spokespeople and financial industry experts and, presumably,
much behind-the-scenes arm twisting of hesitant elected officials.
Nevertheless, in this case the public had initially reacted much less trustingly
to the government’s proposed solution to a crisis than it had in the days after
September 11.
Understanding the public reaction to these catastrophes necessarily
entails understanding how fear is socially distributed and constructed.
Although the sociological conception of risk or a “risk society” contains
somewhat obvious affective dimensions—as people are likely to have
emotional reactions to the notion that their well-being is in jeopardy—social
science research often neglects this facet of risk perception and rhetoric
(Lupton 2013; Zinn 2006). If one takes both the threat of terrorism after
September 11 and the threat of a financial collapse in 2008 as legitimately
fearful topics, the divergent public reaction to these two possibilities still
begs the question of why. Why do some fears resonate where others do not?
Why do some proposed solutions to these fears seem acceptable while others
do not? When do widespread social fears lead to acceptance of authority, and
when do they lead to resistance?
Examining the ways that television news responded to the threat of
terrorism and financial crisis can help us answer these questions. To do so, it
is not necessary to argue that the news media imposed an agenda concerning
these catastrophes on the public or that the media manipulated public
opinion. After all, the news media may simply reflect public concern over
newsworthy events rather than creating these concerns, and the causal
direction of that relationship can be hard to determine (see Kosicki 1993,
108–110). But it is fairly uncontroversial to suggest that the news media both
shapes and reflects social norms as one component of a broader public
discourse surrounding fear and risk. An examination of television news
broadcasts thus provides access to one important component of mainstream
discourses about the appropriate responses to threats such as terrorism and
financial crisis.
This chapter analyzes the transcripts of television news programs in the
month and a half between the September 11 attacks and the signing into law
of the Patriot Act on October 26, 2001, and compares them with television
news programs from an early point in the financial crisis until the signing of
the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act on October 3, 2008. The analysis
focuses on not only what claims were made about fear, risk, and panic but
also who was allowed to be part of this public discussion. Despite significant
similarities in the discourse at work in both samples, the post–September 11
coverage featured commentary from more average citizens than did the
financial crisis coverage. In that coverage, finance industry experts and
politicians spoke more frequently than average people. This discrepancy
helps us understand the larger public reaction of acquiescence to the Patriot
Act and resistance to TARP: in the case of September 11, the public could
more easily identify and empathize with those people making risk claims
around terrorism since they were often made by people like themselves. The
over-representation of government officials in discourse surrounding the
financial crisis, by contrast, surely contributed to public distrust of those risk
claims. Furthermore, the shared spectacle of the September 11 attacks and the
resulting sense of national unity discouraged critical discourse concerning the
Patriot Act in ways that had no analogue during the financial crisis. As such,
both cases offer larger lessons about the dangerous ways that publics engage
with disasters and come to understand risks.

Risk, Mass Media, and Crisis


Ulrich Beck’s Risk Society (1992), along with Anthony Giddens’s (1990,
1991) work in the early 1990s, first drew attention to a heightened concern
with risk in modern Western societies. These scholars claimed that modernity
had moved past its classical stage devoted to defeating scarcity and creating
wealth and into a new, reflexive stage in which modernity was concerned
with its own byproducts and unintended consequences. The risks that modern
science produced had themselves become the objects of much modern
scientific effort, and the management of such potential hazards had emerged
as a critical part of contemporary social life for technical experts and
governmental authorities, as well as the general public. Giddens explained,
“Many people, as it were, make a ‘bargain with modernity’ in terms of the
trust they vest in symbolic tokens and expert systems. The nature of the
bargain is governed by specific admixtures of deference and skepticism,
comfort and fear” (Giddens 1990, 90). Individuals in a risk society thus
weigh competing expert opinions on risks and assume responsibility for their
own assessments of the variety of threats they face. This development works
in tandem with the neoliberal project of turning individuals into
“entrepreneurial selves,” who must increasingly take care of themselves as
the social safety net recedes (M. Peters 2012). They then make decisions
about where to live, what to eat, where to travel, and how else to protect
themselves based on their trust in technical experts and other authorities.
Although risk society theorists initially focused this framework primarily
on the threats of toxic pollutants and environmental degradation, it has been
applied to terrorism and financial crises, as well. In an essay written shortly
after September 11, Beck added terrorism to the list of global risks with
which citizens of the modern Western world must now contend (U. Beck
2002), and the widely dispersed effects of high-finance decision making
similarly confirmed early on for Giddens (1990) the notion that modernity
produced unintended feedback or boomerang effects. For example, the
uncertainties surrounding the likelihood of terrorist attacks have spawned
new formulas, technologies, and practices of risk assessment and control, but
these have often inspired new fears and increased insecurities related to
terrorism as well (Aradau and van Munster 2007). Just as with techno-
scientific and environmental risks, the threats and uncertainties surrounding
terrorism and financial crises persist even in the wake of policies and
technologies designed to minimize them. As one discussion of the Asian
financial crisis of 1997–1998 concluded, “If the financial realm—dominated
by the confident certainties of mathematics and economics—is in fact
inherently ambiguous, then what spaces of human existence are free from
ambiguity” (Best 2008, 370)?
The recognition of such persistent risks and ambiguities—either despite
or because of the efforts of scientists, security experts, and government
agencies—has led some to conclude that the power of authorities to influence
public perceptions of risks and threats is in decline. Various high-profile
examples of scientific mistakes and cover-ups have fueled public skepticism
about scientific research in general and about the risk claims of its
representatives in business and government. In this way, failures of scientific
technology and examples of governmental or corporate negligence, such as
the nuclear catastrophe at Chernobyl and the Bhopal chemical disaster, have
helped foster a climate of public mistrust concerning subsequent scientific
developments such as genetically modified foods and other biotechnologies
(see Almås 1999; Brown and Michael 2002; Grove-White 1996). Each time
authorities are found to have concealed dangers or, worse yet, dangers
materialize that were unforeseen by such authorities, it calls into question
“the very idea of expertise” (Giddens 1990, 131).
However, the crisis of legitimacy that supposedly describes modern
publics’ growing skepticism of authorities (see Habermas 1975) was not
reflected in the American public’s response to claims made by authorities
regarding terrorism in the wake of September 11. Instead, the public largely
supported government officials and security experts as those entities quickly
assigned responsibility for the attacks and almost immediately made the case
for foreign military intervention, and then again as they acquired much
greater domestic policing and surveillance powers with passage of the Patriot
Act. In the first week after the September 11 attacks, 53 percent of Americans
were willing to “sacrifice civil liberties to curb terrorism,” although 70
percent were opposed to the idea of allowing the government to monitor their
phone calls and e-mail (Pew Research Center for the People and the Press
2001a). In the same survey, President George Bush’s approval rating reached
80 percent, up from 51 percent before the attacks, and 85 percent said they
approved of how he had handled the terrorist attacks. In the following year,
when surveys started measuring attitudes specifically toward the Patriot Act,
there was similar public support—just 11 percent in one survey conducted in
June 2002 thought the act “went too far” in restricting people’s civil liberties,
while 60 percent thought it was “about right” (Moore 2003).
Yet public skepticism about elite narratives and federal intervention did
return by the time the financial crisis hit in 2008. From mid-September, when
the plan was being heavily debated, until mid-November, two weeks after it
had been signed into law, support for the government’s bailout plan
plummeted. The percentage of Americans who thought that the government’s
plan to secure the nation’s financial system was the “right thing to do”
dropped from 57 percent in a poll taken on September 22, to 45 percent on
September 29, and to 40 percent on November 17 (Pew Research Center for
the People and the Press 2008a, 2008b). Many members of the public
expressed their anger during the debates over the legislation leading up to the
first failed vote on TARP by engaging in grassroots protest, signing petitions,
or contacting elected officials in unprecedented numbers (Sirota 2009). So
what accounts for the discrepancy between public reactions to the Patriot Act
and TARP?
Certainly it is not because the proposed solutions to post-9/11 terrorism
were less risky than those proposed for the financial crisis. In hindsight, the
claims of antiwar critics that the invasion of Afghanistan would be a
quagmire, that there was no connection between Saddam Hussein and al-
Qaeda to justify an invasion of Iraq, and that Iraq did not possess weapons of
mass destruction have all been proved correct (Associated Press 2005;
Englehardt 2012; Strobel 2008; Walt 2012). The concerns of civil libertarians
about the domestic dangers of the Patriot Act and the other clandestine
elements of the global war on terror have also proved prescient in the wake of
the Abu Ghraib photos and the Edward Snowden domestic spying revelations
(Roberts and Ackerman 2013; Stanley 2007; Weisbrot 2013). TARP, which
ultimately became the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, has
similarly proved its critics correct. Although it did prevent many major
financial institutions from failing, it did little to protect homeowners with
underwater mortgages from foreclosure and could not get credit flowing to
consumers or get companies hiring again as they had before the crisis.
Ultimately, it did not steer the country away from what has come to be
known as the Great Recession (Mian and Sufi 2014; see also Barofsky 2011;
Glink 2012; Herkenhoff and Ohanian 2011; S. Johnson 2010; Lowrey 2011).
All this is to say that the government’s responses to both of these
catastrophes were flawed and deserving of the public skepticism and
resistance that only the latter fully received.
The news media necessarily played a large role in public discourse
surrounding both the September 11 attacks and the financial crisis of 2008.
“What we now think of as ‘9/11’ is a product of choices made by news
workers, political officials, and others regarding what to say about those
events and how to describe them” (Monahan 2010, 10). Critics such as Brian
Monahan contend that in the case of September 11, “the media’s efforts to
present these events in the most dramatic and emotional terms” meant that
“September 11 became primarily a story about patriotism, loss, and heroes
and, for the most part, not a story about U.S. foreign relations, U.S. military
policy, poor interagency coordination, government inefficiencies, or other
interpretive frames” (Monahan 2010, 10). But such criticisms assume that
military policy or government abuses of power are somehow inherently less
dramatic or emotional than stories about patriotism and heroism, or that these
kinds of frames are mutually exclusive. That may not be the case—after all,
the news media is also frequently accused of being “obsessed with scandal”
(see, e.g., Underwood 2001, 102), and it is not hard to imagine the pre-9/11
incompetence of a variety of government agencies becoming more central to
post-9/11 reporting, if that line of inquiry had been framed appropriately.
This was indeed what happened during the financial crisis. Reporters,
financial analysts, and other television news personalities accustomed to
lauding the virtues of the free market—especially during a period in which
deregulation was the norm—found it very difficult to fall in line behind the
government’s initial $29 billion contribution to the deal that sold Bear
Stearns to JP Morgan. The incredulity of television journalists about this
early federal bailout was clear, for instance, in the remarks of Lou Dobbs,
who intoned on a March 17, 2008, broadcast of Anderson Cooper 360
Degrees (AC 360) that he hoped all the viewers would “let their congressmen
and their senators know that they’re quite aware of the outrage that is being
committed … given what is happening to millions of Americans in this
country who are being denied the same advantage as are the barons of Wall
Street.” These sorts of comments set the tone for financial crisis coverage that
was often critical, or at least ambivalent, about the federal government’s
possible responses to the escalating crisis.
Coverage of terrorism leading up to the signing of the Patriot Act was
much less critical of official responses, at least partly due to widely held
journalistic norms about protecting democracy and comforting the citizenry
during times of distress (Mogensen 2008). Indeed, news coverage of the
disaster constructed a notion of “the American people” that emphasized the
communal responsibilities and emotional resilience of a supposedly unified
electorate (Hart, Jarvis, and Lim 2002). One content analysis of President
Bush’s pre- and post-9/11 speeches found a similar shift in rhetoric toward
more collective, patriotic, and faith-based themes (Bligh, Kohles, and Meindl
2004). Another study found that nightly television news programs in the run-
up to the invasion of Afghanistan were almost twice as likely to employ a
war framework as opposed to a crime or law enforcement frame (Edy and
Meirick 2007). Yet another study found that, although both American and
Canadian news magazines frequently adopted “revenge” or “retaliation”
frames around the war on terror, the American publications were more likely
to justify such actions by demonizing those on the receiving end as “evil” and
showing more emotionally gripping photographs (Deveau and Fouts 2005).
Although only about 20 percent of Americans reported that they or their
friends or relatives knew anyone who was missing, hurt, or killed in the 9/11
attacks (Pew Research Center for the People and the Press 2001a), people
from all walks of life were shaken enough by the events of September 11
that, in one survey, 53 percent believed that they or a family member were
very or somewhat likely to be a victim of terrorism (Pew Research Center for
the People and the Press 2001d). The mysterious anthrax mailings of the
following month confirmed for Americans that the risks of terrorism were not
confined to the attacks of September 11, to the citizens of major cities, or
even to those who traveled in commercial airliners. Television news coverage
reflected these expanded fears. Indeed, in this way disasters and crises—
which are usually the culmination of looming risks and threats—can be
constructed as evidence of even greater risks to come and yet unaddressed
vulnerabilities. This could have been the case for the financial crisis, which
quite clearly had the potential to affect all Americans, not just those who
worked in investment banking or those who owned stocks. Yet as one study
found, “media exposure was not a significant predictor of opinions of
TARP,” and “individuals did not perceive TARP as having a direct impact on
their own lives or being tied to the issues they were experiencing, including
the foreclosure crisis, inflation, unemployment, or the financial crisis” (Sears
2013, 197). This is despite the fact that, as in the lead-up to the Patriot Act,
coverage of the financial crisis did heavily emphasize the fearful nature of the
crisis and the anxieties it was generating. It thus remains to be determined
how the sense of threat posed by both disasters contributed to these two
divergent responses.

Discourse Analysis of Television News Coverage


To solve this mystery, this chapter compares television news coverage of
terrorism leading up to the signing of the Patriot Act with coverage of the
financial crisis leading up to the signing of the Emergency Economic
Stabilization Act. I selected four significant dates in each time period on
which to focus. For 2001, I examined coverage on September 16, the day
after network television began to return to its normal schedule; October 8, the
day after President Bush announced the invasion of Afghanistan and the day
that the first anthrax letters were revealed to the public; October 12, the day
that more anthrax letters were mailed to NBC News; and October 26, the day
that the Patriot Act was signed into law. For 2008, I examined coverage on
March 17, the day after Bear Stearns was bailed out by the federal
government and sold off to JP Morgan for $2 per share; September 15, the
day after Lehman Brothers declared bankruptcy; September 19, the day the
Treasury Department proposed TARP; and October 3, the day that President
Bush signed into law the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008,
which authorized the government to purchase $700 billion in troubled assets
and provide other aid to distressed financial institutions.
For each of these dates I read transcripts from three of the most widely
watched American network television news programs: CBS Evening News,
ABC World News, and NBC Nightly News. I also read transcripts of three
widely watched CNN programs from each time period. For both 2001 and
2008 this included CNN’s Larry King Live.1 In 2001, the other two shows in
the sample were what would become known as NewsNight with Aaron Brown
and American Morning with Paula Zahn, although at the time the names for
the programs hosted by those anchors had not yet emerged. In 2008 the two
other shows were AC 360 and The Situation Room with Wolf Blitzer. The aim
of this sample was to get a sense of the mainstream discourse concerning the
risks posed by terrorism and financial crisis and to see how the federal
government’s responses to these risks were portrayed. I was not interested in
comparing the performance of the various shows or in looking for explicit
political biases between networks, so I excluded programs from more
obviously partisan networks such as MSNBC on the left and Fox News on
the right. Although many Americans read newspapers rather than watch
television news, and an increasing number of Americans receive their news
from websites, television was still the number-one source for news in this
country during both time periods (Gammeltoft 2009; Pew Research Center
for the People and the Press 2001a), and its rhetorical conceits and semiotic
strategies can be expected to inform the discourse around any particular
crisis.
The running time of the network evening news shows was a half hour
each, while the running times for the CNN shows varied between one and as
many as three hours. For all of the CNN programming, only the first hour of
each program was analyzed. In the 2001 programs, almost every segment was
about September 11, the war in Afghanistan, or the anthrax attacks or else it
was filtered through a lens of terrorism—such as how the Columbus Day
Parade was affected by fears of terrorism. For that reason, almost all of the
stories in the 2001 broadcasts were analyzed and coded, since they all
provided examples of how the news depicted the fear of terrorism and the
government’s war on terror. By contrast, the 2008 programs had segments on
many other topics besides the financial crisis. Chief among these was the
campaign for the presidency in 2008. When a topic such as the presidential
campaign was covered through the lens of the financial crisis—for instance,
in a segment about how the candidates were weighing in on economic woes
or the proposed bank bailouts—it was coded and analyzed. But when a story
had nothing to do with the financial crisis—for example, when election
polling and insider campaign strategy were the topics—it was not analyzed.
Thus, the 2008 portion of the sample had fewer people speaking overall and
contained less total coverage of the unfolding financial crisis, a significant
distinction in and of itself.
I analyzed the transcripts that constitute this sample in a manner
consistent with the principles of “critical discourse analysis” (Fairclough
1989, 1995), inasmuch as this approach posits that texts themselves, when
couched in their larger social milieu, provide the cues for their interpretation.
In this chapter, this approach meant that I first coded the transcripts to see
how often fears were explicitly discussed. I coded comments as relating to
“fear” any time they mentioned that particular word or related words such as
“panic,” “worry,” or “anxiety.” Of course, I did not code mentions of these
terms that were not germane to the actual threats being discussed, such as an
anchor’s comment “I fear we are out of time” in the broadcast. To capture the
context of these comments, I did make a distinction in my coding between
comments that discussed fear or panic as something happening or potentially
happening and those that were actually urging the public against fear or
panic. Although the argument can be made that even such inducements
against panic attest to the presence of some looming threat that may indeed
be worth worrying about, it is still an important distinction.
I also coded the transcripts to see who besides the network’s journalists
were speaking as guests or commentators on these shows. I placed these
guests into four categories: average people, government officials,
independent experts, or interested stakeholders (in 2001, these were first
responders, police, and members of the military; in 2008, these were financial
industry employees). In this way, I could examine not only the discourse
surrounding fear and crisis in these programs but also who had the largest and
smallest roles in propagating this discourse. Of course, any individual viewer
brings her own, varied resources to each text’s interpretation (Fairclough
1989), and any given text may be decoded by audiences in ways anathema to
its explicit, encoded meanings (S. Hall 1980). As such, I also coded for
several other common kinds of discourse, including the presence of war,
crime, or disaster frames and comparisons to other historical events, but fear
was the most frequently occurring topic in both samples. In my analysis I
have thus aimed to situate the language about fear in the larger context of not
only the rest of each broadcast but also larger debates, ongoing at the time,
about the appropriate personal and collective responses to the emerging
threats of terrorism and financial crisis.

Fear in Post–September 11 News Coverage


Claims about fear were a regular feature of news coverage after September 11
and leading up to the passage of the Patriot Act. As Table 3.1 indicates,
comments about fear were roughly twice as frequent as reassurances not to be
afraid through the first three days of the sample, and on the final day the ratio
ballooned to 11:1. The most fearful day of coverage in the sample was
October 12, the day that an NBC News employee was revealed to have
contracted anthrax, which marked the fourth confirmed case at that point.
Even as early as September 16, although the fearful images of the
September 11 attacks were still fresh in the public’s mind, news coverage had
begun imagining the next set of terrorist attacks. In one exemplary segment,
journalists from the New York Times who had recently written a book on
biological warfare convened on Larry King Live to discuss such threats, and
one, William Broad, set the tone by suggesting, “There is [sic] new
technologies out there that will let terrorists do things they could never, ever
have imagined doing a decade ago.” Larry King asked Broad’s co-author
Judith Miller whether she “fear[ed that] the people that did what they did last
Tuesday have these weapons,” and Miller confirmed, “We don’t think they
have them yet, but we do know that they have tried very hard, and they are
continuing to try very hard very, very hard to get them.” Broad followed up
by making the assertion “Today we’re vulnerable. We are—people could
come in and hit us just as hard, horribly, much harder than we just got hit at
the World Trade Center and the Pentagon.”

TABLE 3.1. MENTIONS OF FEAR IN NEWS COVERAGE LEADING TO PATRIOT ACT

On his October 8 broadcast, King asked Representative Jane Harman, a


member of the Select Intelligence Committee of the House of
Representatives, a similar question: “How do you balance that fear with
trying to live ordinary lives?” Harman began by offering reassurances that
“there is no option… . [I]f we hide under our beds we become what the
terrorists would hope to make use.” But she quickly pivoted to more alarmist
rhetoric as a way to make the case for new federal legislation. She brought up
the possibilities of a new attack: “There could be one tomorrow, there could
be something else on Thursday. This may be the beginning of a second wave
of attacks, and rather than careen from one attack to the next, I think it is
imperative that … if we can pass a law tomorrow [or] this week … [to] force
all of the agencies of the federal government … to comply with a national
strategy plan.”
This balancing act between fear and reassurance was a frequent feature
of the post–September 11 television news discourse. Many government
officials made sure to sprinkle such reassurances throughout their
descriptions of the new threats facing the country. In remarks aired during
Aaron Brown’s CNN broadcast on October 8, Attorney-General John
Ashcroft urged all Americans “to continue to have a heightened sense of
awareness of their surroundings” and to “report suspicious activity to our
partners in law enforcement” but also reminded the audience that Osama bin
Laden “seeks fear … and swears to steal our sense of security.” For those
reasons, he cautioned, “we must not yield to fear.”
But on October 12, when the story had broken of the anthrax mailed to
NBC News, a growing sense of fear about seemingly unimaginable new
threats had become widespread across the sample. Brown began his program
on a personal, empathetic note, stating, “I am as confused, as anxious, as
angry as anyone… . [T]he country has a real anthrax scare on its hands.”
Similarly, Dan Rather began his CBS Evening News broadcast by stating, “In
this time of heightened alert and anxiety for America, there is a new source of
fear and worry tonight: another case of anthrax.” Rather’s program that night
was filled with claims about fear, from the possibility that there was a
“biological Unabomber” on the loose who “gets his jollies scaring the bejesus
out of the rest of us,” to the idea that these latest anthrax revelations were
“enough to send an already jittery nation right to the brink of panic.”
By October 26, when the Patriot Act was signed into law, such fear had
subsided a bit, though the act was not explicitly mentioned as the reason for
this. In fact, the Patriot Act was not heavily covered in these broadcasts; it
was mentioned only twelve times in the six broadcasts in the sample on this
date, with CNN’s Paula Zahn covering it the most extensively. Zahn’s
program contained one of the only substantive moments of criticism of the
Patriot Act in the entire sample, from the columnist Julianne Malveaux. She
stated, “It’s a horrible piece of legislation … because we rushed into it,
because there are not enough checks and balances, because all these things
that are directed at terrorists can also be directed at ordinary Americans.” She
went on to assert, “I think the terrorists have won, if we end up deciding our
normal way of life is going to be changed because of our fears, that we are
going to take away the civil liberties of ordinary people because of fears.”
The other shows in the sample made passing nods to the legislation and
its critics but often gave the last word to government sources who insisted
that no one’s rights would be violated or that “we will preserve the rule of
law,” as Attorney-General Ashcroft put it on ABC’s World News Tonight. On
programs such as Brown’s, however, another group of experts was convened
to discuss “worst-case scenarios and solutions” to problems such as
“cyberterror.” Guests such as the so-called infrastructure warfare expert Peter
Black advocated for “unconventional thinking, built around the premise of
coming up with fast, agile and unexpected responses to these kinds of
attacks.” Even the security adviser Richard Clarke, who worked for three
presidents—George H. W. Bush, Bill Clinton, and George W. Bush—
claimed that terrorists could take down the Internet, as they could “reroute
traffic … disrupt content flows. In the financial industry, they could disrupt
the markets.”
Frank Furedi (2007a) has connected such post-9/11 rhetoric to a broader
cultural trend in which “fear entrepreneurs” on topics ranging from crime to
child safety to terrorism focus on “possibilistic,” not probabilistic, thinking
about threats that are not statistically likely but simply imaginable as the
worst possible outcome: “Worst-case thinking encourages society to adopt
fear as one of the dominant principles around which the public, its
government and institutions should organize their lives. Through
popularizing the belief that worst cases are normal, it incites people to feel
defenceless and vulnerable to a wide range of future threats” (Furedi 2007a,
73). Such fear is “one of the few perspectives that citizens share today”
(Altheide 2002, 3). According to critics such as David Altheide, the mass
media shoulders the blame for this persistent fear-mongering: “News and
popular culture are laced with fear. Both play significant roles in shaping
audience members’ expectations and their criteria for self-preservation”
(Altheide 2002, 9). Others, such as Peter Stearns, blame larger changes in
social norms, of which the media is but one reflection, such that “it has
become more acceptable … to talk about fears, and therefore … to
acknowledge them to oneself” (Stearns 2006, 13). But whether or not the
news media, the government, or the public at large is responsible for pushing
this increase in public fearfulness, one certainly saw it reflected in the
coverage of terrorism leading up to the Patriot Act.

Fear in Financial Crisis News Coverage


Even higher amounts of fear discourse were contained in the 2008 financial
crisis coverage, however. In comparison with the 2001 sample, there were
slightly more mentions of fear overall (101 in 2008 to 76 in 2001; if
comments urging audiences not to fear are included, the comparison is 120 in
2008 to 108 in 2001). But the raw numbers hide the fact that almost half the
segments in the 2008 sample were not about the financial crisis at all and so
were not coded. That was not the case in the 2001 sample, which was almost
always covering something related to the war on terrorism or the September
11 attacks. So in the 2008 sample there are more total mentions of fear in
what amounted to about half the actual number of news stories. Moreover,
the ratio of fear to admonishments not to be afraid is much more pronounced
in 2008, never even approaching the roughly 2:1 balance of the 2001 sample.
Instead, the ratio of fear-to-“don’t fear” is a little under 3:1 in the first day of
the sample and 29:1 by the fourth day, when the Emergency Economic
Stabilization Act was passed (see Table 3.2).
Indeed, television journalists immediately labeled the collapse of Bear
Stearns cause for serious concern. As Wolf Blitzer put it in his March 17
CNN broadcast, “Economic nightmares are coming true for many Americans
right now, and the political leadership knows they can’t ignore the growing
sense of fear that is out there.” With allusions to the Great Depression, Brian
Williams intoned on NBC Nightly News, “You can’t help people for being
worried when they see this coverage. They hear expressions like ‘a run on the
bank,’ and that conjures up bad memories, depending on your age.” On CBS
Evening News that night, the anchor Russ Mitchell succinctly labeled it “a
bear of a scare.”
At the same time, these early programs took pains to explain that this
was not cause for panic. They urged investors not to pull their money out of
the markets and reassured them that deposits in traditional banks were safely
insured by the federal government. They also hopefully speculated that the
government’s unprecedented actions would calm the markets and help
prevent further financial problems. For instance, on the March 17 edition of
World News, ABC’s Dan Harris posed the question “The sky is not falling.
Why not?” and later answered himself by claiming, “What may really have
prevented the market from going into full panic mode today was the Fed’s
historic move to set up a loan program to help investment banks get the
money they need to stay in business.” On Larry King Live, the author Jean
Chatzky cautioned investors that “what we need to do about it is not panic. If
you try to guess the market, you’re going to get out and get in at precisely the
wrong time.”

TABLE 3.2. MENTIONS OF FEAR IN NEWS COVERAGE LEADING TO EMERGENCY


ECONOMIC STABILIZATION ACT
But while these broadcasts all contained agreement on the fearful
possibilities brought up by the failure of one of America’s major financial
institutions, there was less consensus on the appropriateness of the federal
government’s intervention and its long-term effects on the country’s financial
security. By spending $25 billion to bail out Bear Stearns and broker its sale
to JP Morgan, the federal government had violated norms that many guests
appeared to hold dear, and had opened itself up to much scrutiny and
criticism. On that same Larry King broadcast, the author Robert Kiyosaki
criticized Ben Bernanke, chairman of the Federal Reserve, by arguing, “I
think he saved the rich. What Bernanke did is called welfare for the super-
rich. The investment bankers made a huge mistake on betting on those
subprime and CDO mortgages, and now we’re going to bail them out.” On
AC 360, the CNN correspondent Tom Foreman highlighted the issue of
executive compensation in these terms: “Who’s afraid of the big, bad
mortgage crisis? Financial analysts say Bear Stearns executives should not
be. They could well walk away with millions, even as their company
collapses.” Correspondent Ali Velshi agreed that “even when these guys get
kicked out … they earn more than most Americans will ever see in their
entire lives.”
On September 15, when Lehman Brothers collapsed, television news
broadcasts once again recognized the dire scope and searched for precedents
or analogies. On CBS Evening News, Katie Couric accurately called
Lehman’s “the biggest bankruptcy in U.S. history.” The CBS reporter Jeff
Glor similarly spoke of “the worst housing crisis since the Great Depression”
and reminded viewers that “a lot of people are scared right now.” Still, on
that same program, Smart Money magazine’s editor Russell Pearlman
appeared to caution investors, “Don’t panic. As bad as things look today,
they’re just going to be a blip on the market radar 10, 20 years from now.”
Even Glor ended his report on a hopeful note, saying, “There’s a growing
consensus on Wall Street today that this past weekend may have been the
worst of it,” although he admitted that “it will likely still be well into next
year before the economy’s fully back on track.”
Other journalists and guests were less sanguine. Wolf Blitzer described
the nation’s “financial anxiety” concerning Lehman Brothers and the sale of
Merrill Lynch very personally: “It’s one punch in the gut after another for all
of us who have money in the stock market or in some of the nation’s biggest
investment banks, our retirement funds, all of this at risk right now.” On the
September 15 edition of Larry King Live, a panel began to discuss who was
to blame for this cascading crisis, with Fortune magazine’s editor Andy
Serwer pointing to “greed and fear going on on Wall Street.” Later, he
claimed that “regulators clearly did not do enough here. And the CEOs of
some of these firms believed their own voodoo.” On the same program, the
Wall Street Journal’s Stephen Moore and the Princeton economist and New
York Times columnist Paul Krugman put the blame on Alan Greenspan, who,
according to Krugman, was repeatedly “standing in the way of any oversight
on sub prime” and offering “repeated assurances that … it was impossible to
have a housing bubble.” The program followed those remarks with comments
from presidential candidate Barack Obama attesting to the impact of policies
that “loosened oversight and regulation and encouraged outsized bonuses to
CEOs while ignoring middle class Americans.” Meanwhile, on NBC Nightly
News, the reporter Carlos Quintanilla spelled out the consequences even for
those without investments because of “a new era of tight credit, where banks
are nervous about giving loans for appliances, cars, homes. Making Wall
Street’s troubles a Main Street issue.”
This rhetorical connection between Main Street and Wall Street was a
recurring theme throughout the financial crisis coverage, occurring thirty
times in the twenty-four broadcasts. For example, in her September 19 CBS
Evening News broadcast, Katie Couric spoke of “jitters on Wall Street and
questions from Main Street.” Reporting shortly thereafter, CBS’s Ben Tracy
confirmed that “Wall Street’s woes are weighing heavily on the minds of
Main Street.” The repetition of these two terms in connection with one
another seemed a subtle rejoinder to criticisms of the federal bailouts for
favoring the rich—indeed, such framing established the fortunes of average
citizens and Wall Street tycoons as inherently bound together. Sometimes
these programs went further, implicating those same average citizens in the
overall economic woes of the large financial institutions. Dylan Ratigan
explained the situation this way on a September 19 broadcast of NBC Nightly
News: “So who’s to blame? In a sense, we all are, from the small mom and
pop that took advantage of the low minimum payment on their credit cards to
grow their business to trillion dollar institutions. If you thought you could
reap the rewards of easy credit without the consequences, this is the proof
that you can’t.” Leaving aside the somewhat obvious point that the banks are
the ones tasked with determining who should be able to secure how much
credit at what rates, this framing was part of a subtle shift that began around
September 19, the day that the TARP proposal was made public.
Much of the coverage of TARP was about the behind-the-scenes
decision-making process. “Fear” became a term that not only described
investors or bankers or even the general public but was also applied to
politicians. On ABC’s World News, Charles Gibson described how the
Federal Reserve “put the fear of God into congressional leaders” at a briefing
that day. The reporter and former Clinton staff member George
Stephanopoulos agreed, adding that “Fed Chairman Ben Bernanke was
especially frightening” to members of Congress, as he declared that the
country was “days away from a financial collapse.” An appearance by
Senator Chris Dodd on the September 19 edition of The Situation Room was
particularly noteworthy in this respect. Asked to describe the same briefing,
Dodd said:

Well, I’m going to be reluctant to repeat exactly the words, not


because I can’t remember them, but, because, if you were to repeat
them exactly, I’m fearful it might cause even more concern. I can’t
begin to tell you. I have been here for twenty-eight years, Wolf
[Blitzer], been in a lot of very critical meetings involving a lot of
important events over the last quarter of a century. I can’t recall
another occasion when I was in a room where statements were made
about the conditions of not only our economy, but the global
economy, that caused every member in that room, the leadership of
the House, the Senate, Republicans, Democrats, leaders of
committees, that, when Chairman Bernanke finished his appraisal, a
brief appraisal, along with Hank Paulson, there was dead silence in
the room for maybe five to ten seconds. The oxygen went out of the
room. People were stunned by what they heard.
When Blitzer asked Dodd whether he thought the American people had a
right to know what members of Congress were told about the consequences
of doing nothing, Dodd responded, “Well, again, I’m telling you how dire it
was without, without getting into specific wording.”
Dodd’s response was perhaps the best example of a new way of
explaining risk that appeared in coverage of the financial crisis as well as in
the aftermath of September 11. In both cases, although authorities asked the
public to trust that they would be taken care of, they also sought to reaffirm
the frightening possibilities of the risks of future terrorism or further financial
collapse. Traditionally, official communications about risk have sought to
reassure publics that the risks in question are manageable and that authorities
are in control. Essentially, the message of this sort of risk communication has
been “trust us and be reassured.” But post-9/11 risk communication has
evinced a shift in rhetoric that emphasizes the continued dangers of certain
risks, despite the limited threat that they pose to most citizens, using rhetoric
that states, in effect, “Trust us and be scared” (Handmer and James 2007). In
this form of risk communication, “the first priority of some governments is to
spread fear and implement a range of expensive measures in the name of
dealing with a threat that may make little difference locally” (Handmer and
James 2007, 129). Although the problems posed by the collapse of many
large financial institutions would likely have transcended particular localities
and affected many millions of Americans, the fact that unemployment and
home foreclosures rose tremendously in the wake of this crisis, consumer
credit dried up, and Americans saw huge losses in their 401(k)s and other
retirement savings, suggests that the government’s bailout has indeed made
less difference for average Americans than its supporters claimed it would
(see Mian and Sufi 2014). In any case, Dodd’s insistence on the dire
consequences of inaction coupled with his reluctance to actually explain these
consequences contributed to a hazy sense of looming dread on that program.
Still, although politicians from Dodd to Mitch McConnell to John
McCain to Barack Obama all affirmed their support for TARP in the news
programs analyzed here, the simple act of laying bare the machinations
behind the scenes of this giant form of “disaster capitalism” (Klein 2007)
offered space for critique and skepticism. This was especially true after the
TARP proposal was voted down on September 29, thanks to a flood of calls
and e-mails to legislators by angry constituents. By the time it was passed on
October 3, in an only slightly modified form but with many reluctant
legislators having been persuaded to shift their votes, the populist anger had
not subsided from television coverage.
On his October 3 program, Charles Gibson described the “week of high
anxiety” leading up to the successful vote and the “dire predictions about
what would happen if the measure failed again.” Later in the same broadcast,
Jake Tapper called President Bush’s initial explanation of TARP a “poor
sales job.” Others on the program, such as House Republican Roy Blunt,
agreed: “Using words like ‘Wall Street,’ ‘bailout,’ ‘illiquid assets’ was a
formula for the kinds of concern that developed around the country.” Katie
Couric attributed the reversal on TARP to “pressure from skittish markets
and voters worried about dwindling nest eggs.” And on the October 3 edition
of The Situation Room, the correspondent Jessica Yellin laid bare the framing
strategy of TARP supporters: “Some of the leaders are saying the biggest
mistake they ever made with this bill was saying that it’s a bailout for Wall
Street. They say this is about Main Street, and they needed to communicate
that message all along. That’s what they failed to do effectively.”
But the House Democrats Brad Sherman and Peter DeFazio had another
explanation for the bill’s passage on the October 3 edition of AC 360.
Sherman explained, “Wall Street wants the $700 billion so bad, they can taste
it. To get it, they need two things. First, you create panic. Then you block
alternatives. And then you heard the stampeding cattle toward passing a bad
bill.” DeFazio concurred that “Henry Paulson set this up … saying the world
is going to collapse and then going out to the public and saying if Congress
doesn’t pass this in three days, the world economy crashes.” Comments such
as these highlight a crucial distinction between the 2001 coverage of
terrorism and the 2008 coverage of the financial crisis. Throughout the entire
debate about and passage of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act,
there was a high level of criticism of the government’s response to this crisis
that had no analogue in the coverage of the invasion of Afghanistan and the
Patriot Act, despite their similarities. In one particularly broad critique of the
bailouts, on the September 19, 2008, edition of AC 360, the author Peter
Schiff voiced his opposition to TARP in these terms: “Government loves
crises, because they get more power… . The problem is, the government
never cedes this power.” Although equally applicable to, for example, the
Patriot Act, whose provisions were supposed to expire in four years but have
been consistently renewed and even expanded thereafter, criticisms such as
this were either not considered at all by television journalists and their guests
in the run-up to the Patriot Act or were not considered appropriate for
mainstream television audiences at that time.

Who Speaks in Crisis Coverage?


The affiliation or identification of speakers is another important factor in the
tone of the discourse surrounding these two catastrophes. In both the 2001
and 2008 samples, experts and analysts made up a little under a quarter of the
guests (24 percent in 2001; 22 percent in 2008). Similarly, a small amount of
both samples were made up of what I have called “stakeholders”—in 2001,
these were defined as members of the police and other first responders or
members of the military, since the government’s responses to terrorism
covered in this sample directly involved rescue efforts around the World
Trade Center, criminal investigations into the September 11 attacks and the
anthrax mailings, and, of course, the war in Afghanistan. In 2008, these
stakeholders were defined as bankers or other members of the financial
industry, who had a more immediate stake in the bailout of failing financial
institutions than did the rest of the American public. But somewhat curiously,
as shown in Table 3.3, these stakeholders were the least represented group in
both samples (9 percent in 2001; 12 percent in 2008).

TABLE 3.3. WHO SPEAKS IN CRISIS COVERAGE?

The main distinction between these two samples, however, came from
the number of government sources and the number of average citizens who
appeared on these broadcasts. Average citizens, defined as members of the
general public who did not fit into any of the other categories in the sample,
made up the largest percentage of speakers in the post-9/11 coverage, at 39
percent. And yet these accounted for only 18 percent of the financial crisis
news. This ratio was reversed with government officials, who made up a little
over a quarter of the post-9/11 sample (at 28 percent) but who accounted for
almost half of the financial crisis guests, at 48 percent. What accounts for this
discrepancy?
The “mood of the nation,” as Peter Jennings called it in a segment on his
October 8, 2001, World News Tonight broadcast, became an important story
after 9/11. Much coverage in this sample was devoted to the way ordinary
Americans coped with the emotional aftermath of the attacks. Although
Jennings’s segment featured one unidentified man asserting, “We can’t live
in fear,” other average citizens on the broadcast expressed fears such as “I
don’t think that the terrorist attacks are over” or attested to anxiety such that
they “just keep looking over [their] shoulder.” Still others in that same
segment voiced support for the invasion of Afghanistan, as when one man
intoned, “It’s going to be a hard, maybe long fight. But we got to do it.”
Another segment on a September 16 broadcast of CBS Evening News focused
on how “a congregation looked for hope after a week of horror.” On that
broadcast, even the minister of a church in Ridgewood, New Jersey, said, “It
does sound that in some way we are going to go to some variety of war.” In
these ways, the discourse of post-9/11 national unity (see Hucheson et al.
2004; Spigel 2005) was reflected and amplified in these programs by this
inclusion of average citizens voicing the same sorts of fears and concerns,
and supporting the same sorts of policies, as government officials.
Interestingly, other content analyses have argued that post–September 11
news coverage leaned too heavily on government sources. Immediately after
the attacks, on September 11 and 12, newspapers and television news
programs relied mainly on government officials as sources (Li and Izard
2003), though this may have been a result of the demands of breaking news
coverage, since government sources are likely to be more readily available in
the beginning stages of this sort of crisis than those with opposing or minority
viewpoints. Similarly, Altheide (2006, 417) compared newspaper coverage
from eighteen months before and after the 9/11 attacks and found that
“reliance on government officials as news sources promoted reports that
joined fear to terrorism and victimization.” This finding might be true for my
sample, as well, if one were to count the total number of words uttered by
each variety of speaker, since government officials often had more to say and
more time to say it than average people. But it is still important to note that in
comparison with the financial crisis, the post-9/11 coverage of terrorism
actually looks more balanced.
After all, the many average citizens quoted in the post-9/11 coverage
largely disappeared in the 2008 sample. Despite the fact that the financial
problems of “Main Street” were a frequent concern voiced by journalists,
government officials, and financial experts in these samples, actual voices
from Main Street were few and far between. Instead, it was more common for
the program’s elite guests to speculate about the effects of the crisis and the
bailouts on average people. For instance, on September 15, Larry King asked
his guests, Andy Serwer and Paul Krugman, about what would be “the effect
on a bus driver in Hialeah” of the bailouts. Sensibly enough, Krugman
reminded King that “if he’s got a 401(k), he has to worry … and also, he’s
got to worry about his job,” but, of course, an average person could have
been asked about her worries for her job or her 401(k). A week later, this
trend of elites speaking for average people reached perhaps its most absurd
moment when King asked Donald Trump to “try to put yourself in their
shoes, the average American family,” to which Trump replied, “It’s both a
very tough time and a great opportunity” before urging average Americans to
“go out and make a deal.”
On aggregate, then, the financial crisis coverage featured much discourse
concerning the fate of average Americans, either explicitly or through
framing that implicitly connected Main Street and Wall Street as rhetorical
equals in the crisis and equal beneficiaries of the resultant bailouts. But few
average Americans were actually allowed to participate in that discourse. In
this way, the crisis coverage both reflected and likely amplified the public’s
initial distaste toward the bailouts and distrust of the TARP proposal—a
distrust that led directly to TARP’s initial defeat in the House of
Representatives.

Conclusion: Empathy, Authenticity, and Fear in Public


Discourse
Television news is, of course, only part of the public discourse surrounding
these two catastrophes. Mass media and consumer culture offered almost
innumerable responses to the 9/11 attacks. From American flags, 116,000 of
which were sold at Walmart stores on September 11 alone (Scanlon 2005), to
September 11–themed comic books (Foster 2005), country music songs (Hart
2005), FDNY and NYPD teddy bears (Sturken 2007), and other 9/11-themed
collectibles (Broderick and Gibson 2005), Americans were encouraged to
express their grief and patriotism through mass consumption. Consumption in
general took on an explicitly patriotic and politicized meaning when Vice
President Dick Cheney told Americans to “stick their thumb in the eye of the
terrorists and … not let what happened here in any way throw off their
normal level of economic activity” (quoted in Reich 2001, B1). Americans
were even able to make themselves and their families feel safer and more
secure through the purchase of products such as terrorism survival guides
(Lockard 2005) and executive parachutes (ABC News n.d.).
Mass culture responded to the financial crisis with a similar array of
products and messages. Television after the crisis produced more “down
market sitcoms” focusing on the plight of poor or laid-off protagonists (Gay
2009) and an explosion of home remodeling shows in which houses are
renovated to take in renters or in which people compete for mortgage
payments (Patterson 2009). Reality television also picked up on the post-
crisis concerns of the emerging Great Recession by producing shows about
pawn shops, salvagers, and hoarders (Mrozowski 2013). Kirk Boyle and
Daniel Mrozowski label this “bust culture” in their research on “post-crash
mass cultural artifacts inflected by diminishment, influenced by scarcity, and
infused with anxiety” (Boyle and Mrozowski 2013, xi). Perhaps the best
example of such consumer anxiety was the rush to purchase gold amid
inflated fears about the U.S. dollar’s impending collapse (Mencimer 2010).
Returning to television news broadcasts with this larger cultural context
in mind allows one to hone in on ways that disasters generate either support
for or resistance to elite policies. Clearly, identification with the people who
are visibly engaged in public discourse concerning disasters and disaster
response is key in this regard. When those people are “average citizens” with
whom the viewer might sense a similarity, or who at least seem to have the
same sort of stake in the outcome of these debates, then the discourse is likely
to be greeted with empathy and trust. This is true even if that discourse itself
is quite fearful and not reassuring. This, at least, was a central difference
between those who spoke in the 2001 terrorism coverage and the 2008
financial crisis coverage, and it helps us understand the divergent public
reactions to those two catastrophes.
Such a divergence is partly explainable by the “identifiable victim
effect,” in which bystanders or distant spectators are more inclined to want to
help a known victim than an unidentified victim or one identified only as part
of a statistic (see Jenni and Loewenstein 1997). But it is also a question of
empathy, since merely identifying an individual victim does not necessarily
increase one’s trust in that person or, as one study has shown, does not
increase one’s desire to help if that person is seen as having been responsible
for his own plight (Kogut 2011). Clearly, the investment bankers and finance
industry chief executives who stood to benefit most directly from government
bailouts were often framed on television news as having caused their own
problems and thus unworthy of taxpayer assistance. Yet they also did not
appear frequently on these programs and instead let experts and government
officials make the case for them.
The distinction between empathy and identification is one that
psychologists and therapists have struggled to delineate (see Greenson 1960;
Marwell 1964). Nonetheless, it is safe to say that television audiences may
identify with people they see on-screen (see J. Cohen 2001; Hoffner and
Cantor 1991). If these are presumed to be real people, not fictional characters,
as we saw in the previous chapter’s discussion of the documentary Trouble
the Water and the reality television show I Survived, then audiences may
especially empathize with the plight of those they see on-screen. But as with
those media, such identification and empathy is not necessarily an accurate or
just way to assess the experiences and claims of others. As discussed in
Chapter 2, studies have shown that audiences tend to experience more
empathy for people who are similar to them (see Avenanti, Sirigu, and
Aglioti 2010; Fong and Luttmer 2007). So it certainly makes sense that
public discourse in which average citizens play a leading role is likely to
appear more authentic, and generate more empathy, than discourse in which
elites take center stage.
The lack of average citizens on the news during the financial crisis thus
rendered the fearful language around that disaster less authentic. Instead, the
preponderance of government officials making claims about the risks of
inaction in the run-up to the passage of the Emergency Economic
Stabilization Act set off alarm bells for the general public, who could not
identify with these elite claims makers or the most immediate victims in need
of assistance: the members of the financial industry. Somewhat clumsy
attempts to rhetorically connect Wall Street and Main Street aside, the public
debate around the financial crisis and its federal resolution was initially
resisted by a public that did not see itself authentically included in the
discussion.
Of course, another important element of these programs is certainly the
fact that those average people and financial experts who did speak about the
financial crisis and the bailouts were much more critical of the government
than those who spoke about terrorism and the Patriot Act. It suggests that the
spectacular nature of a crisis—its visual novelty, its brevity and shock value
—plays a substantial role in determining social fears and public acceptance of
official risk claims. September 11 was such a spectacle, at least as it was
initially received on television by so many Americans. As Lilie Chouliaraki
(2004, 191) put it, “The main features of the Manhattan visuals are random
shots, erratic camera movements, imperfect focus and framing, and camera
lenses covered in white dust. This is clearly a projection of unstaged reality.”
In that initial moment of horror, “the repercussions of the event were so
strong that, while watching the news, viewers found themselves mirroring the
feelings they viewed” (Gonçalves 2012, 233). The images from September
11 of planes striking the towers, people fleeing a giant cloud of dust and
debris, and firefighters combing the smoking wreckage thus quickly attained
a serious emotional weight and iconic status. The same cannot be said for any
single image or set of images from the financial crisis. Without this aura of
authenticity, without the powerful collective trauma of 9/11 creating “a
certain uncritical sense of sacredness” (Smelser 2004, 34), television
journalists and their guests were emboldened to criticize the government’s
actions during the financial crisis in ways they were not in the aftermath of
September 11.
Given the lack of any defining image or discrete, encapsulating moment
of shared national spectatorship related to the financial crisis, and given the
fact that average people were shut out of the public discourse surrounding the
financial crisis in favor of government officials and experts, it makes sense
that the public failed to find the financial crisis as authentic a threat as
terrorism and failed to accept official assessments of risks or proposed policy
solutions as readily as they had after September 11, despite the very similar
deployment of fear discourse in the media coverage of the two catastrophes.
The solution to this public intransigence would seem to be simple, however,
at least for elites looking to steer a fearful public toward support for their
preferred policies in the wake of some future disaster. The discourse
surrounding September 11 and terrorism is a model for that. It simply
requires finding enough average people who support your preferred policy,
feel the level of fear you believe is appropriate, fear the types of others you
want them to fear, and trust authorities in ways that are helpful to you, and
getting those people out in front of the television cameras as much as
possible.
Thus, the connection described here between empathy and risk is cause
for concern. If our assessment of risks and our trust in official responses to
those risks stem from these highly subjective and malleable forms of affect,
then our ability to protect ourselves is truly in peril. After all, it is doubtful
that the threats most likely to adversely affect us will match up so easily with
those catastrophes that produce the largest spectacles or the most widely
shared experiences, or that generate the most emotion and discussion among
average citizens with whom we might identify. Some threats, such as the
financial crisis, are slow, take time to accumulate, and produce little in the
way of mass-mediated spectacle. Discourse about such ambiguous threats
and their potential solutions is likely to be greeted with incredulity, as it
deservedly was in the case of the financial crisis and TARP. But such
suspicion will not always be the right response. In fact, one of the greatest
risks to our entire civilization, climate change, is an even more slowly
moving threat that lately is being met with increasing public skepticism
(Leiserowitz et al. 2014), thanks to the efforts of increasingly well-funded
political advocacy organizations that are skilled at simulating or inciting a
sense of distrust around climate science among average citizens (see Brulle
2014). This alone should be enough to cast doubt on the larger cultural
patterns in which fear and empathy currently intertwine. At the very least, it
points to the need for new cultural norms around the consumption of
catastrophe and the assessment of risk, and perhaps new media technologies
that can help us envision them. It is to such new media technologies, and the
ways they allow us to commemorate disasters, that I turn in the next chapter.

1. Three of the dates in the financial crisis had to be shifted slightly for Larry King Live because many
of his shows dealt with a single, predetermined issue and thus did not cover breaking developments in
the financial crisis until a day or two after they happened.
4

MEMORY AS THERAPY

September 11, Hurricane Katrina, and Online Commemoration

A recent CNN.com article told the story of Judson Box, a man whose
firefighter son, Gary, had died in the attacks of September 11. Buoyed by
their daughter’s visit to the National 9/11 Museum’s Tribute Center in 2009,
Mr. Box and his wife, Helen, spent hours scouring images available at the
museum and those directly uploaded by users on the museum’s website. They
hoped to find an image of Gary and learn more about what he had done that
day and how he had died. The Boxes eventually did find a photo online,
taken by a Danish businessman who had been stranded in traffic in the
Brooklyn Battery Tunnel. It showed their son rushing on foot through the
tunnel from Brooklyn to Manhattan, since his company’s fire truck could not
get through the traffic. Mr. Box described his reaction to the photo as “out of
control, emotionally … [t]hanking God, being so happy that [we] had
something to see” (quoted in Solomon 2010, para. 10). Since finding the
photo and eventually meeting the photographer during a fundraiser, Judson
Box has helped promote the National 9/11 Museum because, in his words,
“too many people forget” (quoted in Solomon 2010, para. 21).
Thanks to this relatively new form of online commemoration and
archiving, the Box family was provided with the comfort of a new image of
their son, and a new understanding of his last day on Earth, nine years after
his passing. As this story illustrates, the Internet is changing the way that
society stores information and relates to the past. Of course, collective
memory has always been constituted through the development of “mnemonic
technologies” used to extend social capacities for storage and recollection
beyond those of the individual human brain (Olick 1999, 342). From the “arts
of memory” associated with medieval storytellers to the nineteenth-century
creation of museums and archives in Europe and more recent developments
in broadcast media, technologies of information collection and
communication have helped shape the ways in which societies remember
(Olick 1999). Yet there are distinctive features of new online forms of
commemoration that require further investigation, especially given the
critiques of mass culture in the preceding chapters. Many scholars have
highlighted the revolutionary potential of the Internet’s public accessibility.
“Just as the printing press gave everyone access to readership,” Douglas
Rushkoff has proffered, “the computer and internet give everyone access to
authorship. The first Renaissance took us from the position of passive
recipient to active interpreter. Our current renaissance brings us from a
position of active interpretation to one of authorship” (Rushkoff 2002, para.
13). Similarly, Clay Shirky has suggested that new online forms of
communication offer “long-term tools that can strengthen civil society and
the public sphere” (Shirky 2011, para. 17). But when disaster strikes, does it
matter? Do spaces of digital commemoration offer a distinct alternative to
television news and documentary media? Are the forms of emotional
expression in online spaces and the uses to which they are put noticeably
different?
One way to investigate these questions is to explore the growing variety
of websites that are devoted to the exercise of collective memory and the
creation of memorials devoted to tragic or catastrophic events. In addition to
the online component of the National 9/11 Museum, the September 11
attacks have been commemorated and memorialized online in a number of
other websites, as has another recent disaster, Hurricane Katrina. This chapter
focuses on two digital memory banks devoted to these disasters, the
September 11 Digital Archive (http://911digitalarchive.org/) and the
Hurricane Digital Memory Bank (http://hurricanearchive.org/), to examine
the kinds of meaning created for, and by, contributors to these new online
sites of commemoration.
Digital archives and memory banks are online databases that allow users
to upload images, music files, links, news items, and personal messages or
stories to an archive that other users may then browse or search. Although the
roots of such databases predate the September 11 attacks, a software platform
developed by the Center for History and New Media (CHNM) at George
Mason University has been used since 2001 to create digital memory banks
for many historical events, not only the attacks of September 11 but also
hurricanes Katrina and Rita and the Virginia Tech shootings, among others.
The architecture of these memory banks seeks to “embody the relationships
of participatory cultures and communal memories that are being constructed
through next-generation Internet technologies such as Second Life, blogs,
wikis, and social networking sites such as Facebook and MySpace” (Jesiek
and Hunsinger 2008, 193). Although the objects in these memorials are not
rewritable in the same vein as Wikipedia entries, some memory banks allow
users to add tags to existing items, and memory bank developers are currently
exploring new possibilities for added interactivity in future iterations (Jesiek
and Hunsinger 2008, 193).
This chapter examines the September 11 Digital Archive and the
Hurricane Digital Memory Bank as forms of prosumption, because the users
who produce and upload content to these sites are also the consumers of the
sites. By analyzing the stories and messages uploaded to these two digital
archives, this chapter attempts to better understand the uses and rhetoric of
online commemoration. It argues that the messages and stories left at these
sites frequently featured claims about emotions, trauma, and healing that
reflected a therapeutic ideal, in which the restoration of one’s mental health
after a tragic or difficult event is of paramount importance. Although this
therapeutic ideal has been a salient feature of American culture for a century,
by some accounts (see Moskowitz 2001), it has emerged as a goal of
commemoration and collective memory only in the past thirty years (Savage
2006). The contemporary convergence of therapeutic principles with new
forms of online collective memory accounts for the power of digital archives
today, as exemplified by the Box family’s experience. However, their story is
also in many ways exceptional, and the everyday uses of online memory
banks rarely feature such dramatic ends. Instead, the sort of therapeutic
experience on offer at the digital memory banks studied here was primarily
about individual catharsis, not helping others. Thus, what one views at digital
archives and memory banks is the convergence of the practice of therapeutic
self-help with new forms of user-generated online media. This chapter seeks
to discover whether these new spaces of online collective memory might still
offer challenges to the memorial strategies of traditional media, and how they
may either confront or reinforce many of the inequities embedded in
mainstream responses to September 11 and Hurricane Katrina.

Prosumption as Self-Help
Visitors who submit messages to digital memory banks can be described as
prosumers. Like other forms of online activity associated with the
phenomenon commonly described as Web 2.0, in which websites offer users
a platform or framework that they can add to or modify, contributing to a
digital memory bank is simultaneously a form of production and
consumption. The consumption of these online archives and memory banks
constitutes a form of production, as well, because users frequently add their
own stories, submit files, add links, tag existing content, or even simply
search through the database as a means of customizing their experiences.
Today, an ever growing number and variety of websites are devoted to
various forms of user participation and information exchange (Beer and
Burrows 2010).
The ramifications of these interactive, participatory forms of online
prosumption remain hotly debated. Their advantages over older models of
web portals, which simply presented visitors with a one-way flow of
information, are in some ways obvious. Today, social networking sites, blogs,
and wikis can create new communities scattered over wide geographical areas
(Feenberg 2009), supplement face-to-face interaction and increase
participation in voluntary organizations (Wellman et al. 2001), and provide a
more reflexive, open, and democratic alternative to older forms of journalism
(Goode 2009), to name but a few benefits. However, many view this
incorporation of consumers into the production process as simply an
advanced form of exploitation. The popularity of open-source software,
online product reviews, and so-called citizen journalism does not change the
fact that today “consumers do these formerly paid tasks for no recompense”
(Ritzer and Jurgenson 2010, 26). Contemporary capitalism has sought to
increase the rate of innovation and invention by drawing consumers more
fully into the process (Thrift 2006), and these consumers generally receive
little economic reward for their work beyond the simple pleasures of co-
creation itself or the benefits when products and services are improved as a
result.
But the blurring of consumption and production far predates the
computer or the Internet. Alvin Toffler, who coined the term “prosumption”
(Toffler 1980), has pointed out that the ascendance of market economies
during the Industrial Revolution cleaved productive work from consumption,
and before then most economic activity consisted of a kind of “production for
self-use” (Toffler 1980, 295) similar to contemporary forms of prosumption.
One of Toffler’s earliest examples of modern prosumption involved the
growth of self-care and self-help in the 1970s. With the appearance on the
market of home pregnancy tests and blood pressure kits, and then the
increasing popularity of bereavement groups and twelve-step programs,
millions of people began to perform services for themselves that previously
would have been performed for them by a doctor—in other words, they
began actively prosuming their own physical and mental health care.
As Toffler explained, such self-help groups especially “rely entirely on
what might be termed ‘cross-counseling’—people swapping advice based on
their own life experience, as distinct from receiving traditional counseling
from the professionals” (Toffler 1980, 285). This is similar in some ways to
what happens today at digital memory banks, in which one user’s message of
hope or consolation might be read by a victim’s family member and perhaps
responded to in kind. These kinds of therapeutic dialogues between non-
experts are exceedingly common in a media culture filled with self-help chat
rooms and television talk shows focused on the public disclosure of one’s
psychic pain (Illouz 2003; Moskowitz 2001).
In fact, although self-help ideals were initially seen as incompatible with
the less optimistic Freudian notion of the psyche, the convergence of
Freudian psychology and the self-help ethos in American culture today was
made possible precisely “because the language of psychotherapy left the
realm of experts and moved to the realm of popular culture” (Illouz 2008,
155). This new language converted large numbers of Americans to what Eva
Moskowitz (2001) has called “the therapeutic gospel,” in which personal
happiness and self-fulfillment are primary goals, and unhappiness is a
condition that can and should be treated. While the therapeutic assertion that
one must make or remake oneself into a happier, more fulfilled person
certainly reinforces the power and prestige of professional counselors and
psychotherapists, it also serves as a powerful motivator for many forms of
prosumption. By taking one’s physical, mental, or spiritual health into one’s
own hands, one has already adopted the active stance of the prosumer. In this
sense, digital memory banks showcase a further intertwining of the ideals of
therapeutic self-help with newer forms of digital prosumption.
Spontaneous Commemoration and Therapeutic Monuments
The Internet is not the only place where prosumption and collective memory
intertwine, however. Some of these same cultural trends toward consumption
for self-use and the active participation of non-experts have been at work in
commemorative efforts in the physical landscape for at least thirty years. As
such, the growing preponderance of “spontaneous shrines” (Santino 1992)
and the contemporary mandate for therapeutic commemoration shed more
light on the ramifications of prosumption for collective memory in the
physical landscape and for other forms of prosumption, as well.
Traditionally, memorials have been constructed at the behest of elites to
enshrine dominant points of view and to celebrate the lives and deaths of
heroic individuals. The physical construction of a memorial frequently marks
a spot in the geographical landscape as meaningful and sacred, due either to
the lives lost there—as at the site of a famous battle—or simply to the ability
of memorial architecture to convey a sense of sanctity and solemnity. Such
memorials have the power to sustain a particular interpretation of events
within collective memory at least partly because of the physical durability of
the landscape to which they are attached (Foote 1997).
Despite their hallowed status, however, memorials do contain the
potential for alternative readings and interpretations outside the intentions of
their originators, and they are always evolving as new visitors and viewers
bring new interpretations (Santino 2006; Young 1993). In fact, the creation of
memorials, monuments, archives, and museums is necessarily a contested
process in which the adherents of competing views of history jockey for
control over its representation. The decisions undertaken by the archivists,
architects, historians, and politicians involved in such efforts to include or
exclude certain documents, images, or perspectives from institutions of
collective memory show that such memory is not merely guarded or acquired
but actively shaped through the very processes of its collection (Brown and
Davis-Brown 1998). While not the norm, these processes do occasionally
result in official forms of commemoration that challenge hegemonic
ideologies and elite histories, as has been the case with memorials and
monuments dedicated to the American Civil Rights Movement, for instance
(O. Dwyer 2000).
Moreover, rituals of mourning and commemoration are not undertaken
only by, or at the direction of, government officials and other elites;
vernacular forms of commemoration have long been a part of the memorial
landscape (Bodnar 1992), and spontaneous public memorialization appears to
be a growing trend (Santino 2006). Whether on the site of a deadly traffic
accident or at the spot where a political figure was murdered, or even
scattered around a city that has just been subjected to a terrorist attack,
spontaneous shrines composed of some combination of messages to the dead,
pictures, flowers, poems, teddy bears, and other kitsch commodities are an
increasingly common feature of mourning practices (Santino 2006; Sturken
2007).
These assemblages reflect a breakdown of boundaries between elite and
popular culture (Thomas 2006) and between production and consumption.
The spontaneous displays of commemorative artwork, sculpture, banners, and
other mementos that spring up quickly at the sites of tragedies and disasters
serve to personalize these events for their creators. Some commentators have
also argued that spontaneous commemoration is an inherently political act.
As Jack Santino (2006, 13) put it, “We who build shrines and construct
public altars or parade with photographs of the deceased will not allow you to
write off victims as mere regrettable statistics.” In any case, this prosumption
of memorialization speaks to the growing influence of increasingly diverse
constituencies who feel ownership over the commemoration of wars,
disasters, and other tragedies, as well as an increasing number of
“reputational entrepreneurs” (Fine 2001) who are emotionally and politically
invested in these processes. The designing of memorials and monuments has
increasingly become a hotly disputed affair in which elites, victims’ families,
survivors, and ordinary citizens struggle to establish guiding frameworks
(Linenthal 2001; Sturken 1997, 2007).
But despite the frequency and vigor of political debate over memorial
designs today, an increasingly common aspect of both official and
spontaneous commemoration is the requirement of a therapeutic component.
The design and construction of the Vietnam Veterans Memorial in the 1980s
inaugurated the ideal of the “therapeutic monument” (Savage 2006), which
aimed to help individuals and the nation as a whole heal the psychic wounds
inflicted by the Vietnam conflict rather than simply honor soldiers or make a
political statement. That ethos, with its emphasis on survivors and ordinary
citizens, has been applied to the creation of many subsequent monuments and
memorials, such as the U.S. Holocaust Museum and the Oklahoma City
National Memorial (Sturken 2007).
Of course, the healing function of memorial planning, dedication, and
construction has always been at least a latent feature of the process, given that
such activities have the power to reunite communities that have been
fragmented by wars and other disasters (Foote 1997). But beginning with the
Vietnam Veterans Memorial, monuments and memorials have been designed
as more open-ended and reflective experiences, which allow visitors
opportunities to empathize with victims, survivors, and their families or to
reflect on the personal and national meaning of the commemorated event
without being pushed toward a particular conclusion or overarching narrative.
This represents a form of prosumption in and of itself, since the consumer of
the memorial or monument is now expected to produce a therapeutic
experience for himself or herself rather than have the terms of such
experience explicitly dictated by the text, architecture, or imagery of the
memorial. Digital archives and memory banks flourish today within this
context of spontaneous, therapeutic, and prosumer-oriented commemoration.

The September 11 Digital Archive and the Hurricane Digital


Memory Bank
Although printed magazines and newspapers have long provided forums for
national mourning in the wake of tragedies (Kitch 2003), the speed and
interactivity of online networks often allows them to supplement or
contradict traditional mass-media coverage. In the immediate aftermath of
September 11, online communities such as Slashdot.org put up mirror sites of
news organizations’ websites that had been jammed by the increased traffic,
and they added commentary on their forums. Mental health organizations
immediately focused their websites and online newsletters on the potential
post-traumatic stress that Americans might be experiencing, and blogging
sites reported a significant increase in postings (Fisher and Porter 2001).
Many message boards across the web provided a quick source of comfort for
the countless users who posted prayers for and messages to the victims and,
in some cases, spread anti-Muslim rage and racist vitriol (J. Brown 2001; see
also Martin and Phelan 2002). Similarly, during Hurricane Katrina, online
contributors to the message boards of major news networks and writers on
Katrina-themed blogs challenged the narratives presented by mainstream
journalists and asserted the rights of citizens to tell their stories (Robinson
2009).
Online information gathering during a crisis can quickly transform into
spontaneous electronic shrines and digital memorials, as was the case with
the social networking profiles of the deceased from the Virginia Tech
shootings (Creamer 2007). Similarly, a site called MyDeathSpace.com
archives the social networking pages of people who have died and allows
visitors to leave comments. Social networking sites also enable users to join
groups devoted to various social causes, including the commemoration of
disasters. In 2010, MySpace had more than thirty-six groups with 6,561
members devoted to remembering Hurricane Katrina, although many of those
members may have belonged to two or more groups, and most of those
groups were small—only two had more than one thousand members, and
only fourteen had more than one hundred members. It should be noted that by
the time Katrina struck, however, MySpace’s popularity was already waning,
potentially pushing some of the memorial traffic to competing sites such as
Facebook. It makes sense, then, that MySpace hosted a larger number of
September 11–themed groups. There were 165 groups with at least ten
members devoted to “9/11” in some form or another, making up a total of
66,316 members, although again some of those may have belonged to
multiple groups. Even with that high number, only four groups had more than
one thousand members, and only thirty groups had more than one hundred.
Many of the smaller groups were local chapters of the 9/11 Truth Movement
or advocates of related September 11 conspiracy theories, but the larger
groups used less controversial or conspiratorial rhetoric and favored more
traditional and patriotic themes.
Such websites produce digital archives as a byproduct. Threaded posts,
profiles, photos, and avatars create a history of online exchanges and allow
for the past to be reconstructed on blogs, social networking sites, and wikis,
among other platforms (Chayko 2008). In this way, the interactive and
participatory aspects of the Internet generate a kind of “writable collective
memory” (Ulmer 2005, xii) that captures contemporary norms and mores
about a whole host of social issues. Rather than crafting a coherent story
about disaster, as mainstream media outlets tend to do, the sum total of online
disaster commemoration is much more descriptive and fragmentary; its
model is the database rather than the narrative (Manovich 2001; see also
Walker 2007).
The digital archive or digital memory bank format makes this database
ideal explicit. The September 11 Digital Archive, created by the CHNM and
the American Social History Project at the Graduate Center of the City
University of New York, currently holds more than 150,000 digital items,
including more than forty thousand e-mails and electronic communications,
forty thousand firsthand stories, and fifteen thousand digital images.
Although the archive stopped posting new submissions in 2004, it remains
publicly available online and through the Library of Congress, which made
the collection its first major digital acquisition in September 2003. The
Hurricane Digital Memory Bank, which was created by the CHNM, the
University of New Orleans, and the Smithsonian’s National Museum of
American History, holds more than twenty-five thousand digital items related
to hurricanes Katrina and Rita.
The two websites have described their missions in similar terms. The
September 11 Digital Archive sought to use September 11 “as a way of
assessing how history is being recorded and preserved in the twenty-first
century” while also hoping “to foster some positive legacies of those terrible
events by allowing people to tell their stories, making those stories available
to a wide audience, providing historical context for understanding those
events and their consequences, and helping historians and archivists improve
their practices based on the lessons we learn from this project”
(http://911digitalarchive.org/about). The staff of the Hurricane Digital
Memory Bank also hoped to cultivate “positive legacies by allowing the
people affected by these storms to tell their stories in their own words, which
as part of the historical record will remain accessible to a wide audience for
generations to come” (http://hurricanearchive.org/about).
Each site emphasized its utility as a form of historical documentation,
and both described their objectives as simply “collecting and preserving” the
memories associated with these events. But by emphasizing the promotion of
“positive legacies,” their creators seem to see the sites’ functions not only in
terms of historical documentation but also as a form of therapy, akin to the
recent move toward therapeutic memorialization in the physical landscape.
As the creators of the similarly designed April 16 Archive (devoted to the
Virginia Tech shootings) put it, “If the items we have archived provide some
measure of healing and recovery for those touched by the violence of that
fateful day … then this project will have been a success” (Jesiek and
Hunsinger 2008, 203). Thus, these sites make explicit the connections among
digital prosumption, self-help, and commemoration.
Common Themes
To better understand the deployment of therapeutic and commemorative
rhetoric in digital memory banks, I analyzed the stories submitted by users at
the September 11 Digital Archive and the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank
(see Table 4.1).1

TABLE 4.1. COMMON THEMES

The diversity of subjects described in the messages left at these two sites
means that very few themes appeared in a high percentage of the entries at
both archives. Nevertheless, some important ideas emerge from this analysis.
For instance, both archives made reference to the psychological after-effects
of these disasters, such as depression, stress, or compulsively reliving the
events in one’s head. Five percent of the entries in the Hurricane Digital
Memory Bank made these sorts of references to trauma, as did 8 percent of
those at the September 11 archive. A Hurricane Katrina survivor explained:
Hurricane Katrina has been a tremendous strain on my life and I
continue to try to put it behind me. It has been such a struggle for
almost 3 years. When I went back home after Katrina that I was so
traumatized that I chose to not remember much of those 6 months
there. I would always go to my house just so I could get disgusted
and angry… . Katrina didn’t just take my house. She took my home,
my childhood, and my mental state. The person I used to be was lost
along with everything else.

Other authors told similar tales of disaster’s lingering psychological


effects, although they had only watched the September 11 attacks on
television. One user explained, “A year later, I finally came out of my state of
shock. It turned to depression. My fiancé and I broke up. I left to return to
Chicago. I am receiving treatment and am trying to piece my life back
together again. I will, but there will be a few pieces missing… . I wasn’t in
the World Trade Center, so I can’t tell you what they lost, I only know how
adversely it affected my life.” Another described the symptoms of this
vicarious trauma: “For weeks after September 11 I had terrible nightmares
involving hijacked planes and buildings… . I would hear a jet go over head
and do what I think many did in the immediate aftermath, look to see where it
was and what it was doing… . For weeks afterward the sight of low flying
aircraft would send a shiver down my spine.”
Such messages speak to the ways in which mass-mediated national
tragedies can be personalized by individual viewers and intertwined with
other painful aspects of one’s past. One commenter recalled:

On September 11, 2001, I had taken the day off to be at home in my


own grief. My oldest son was killed on September 11, 1996. I never
watch television, but on this sad day for me, I found myself pouring
another cup of coffee and bringing it into the bedroom and turning
on the TV. Not five minutes later, I watched in horror as the events
began to unfold. I cannot explain what this did to me, but I was
shaking uncontrollably, crying … not only for my own loss, but to
know that now so many others will mourn the loss of their own
children and loved ones. It is a pain that no one should have to
know. The anniversary of my son’s death is now shared by so many
in our country. As was my son’s death, the deaths on 9/11/01 were
senseless and at the hands of others. My heart goes out to each and
every person who has lost a loved one. It never gets any easier, the
pain never goes away. It just gets “different.”

Stories such as these make explicit the psychological damage that


disasters may inflict on those directly affected and distant spectators alike. In
their telling, they seek to enact a therapeutic transformation for themselves
and others. Implicit in many of the comments on both sites was the hope that
one’s own story would help others to heal or at least understand the grief that
they feel, as the commenter’s remark that “the pain never goes away. It just
gets ‘different’” seemed to suggest. But users also hoped to provide
themselves with a psychic salve by writing out their thoughts and feelings.
One user acknowledged that people may have “heard enough stories of
Hurricane Katrina” but stated, “The rest of this story is my psychological
outlet for what has built up for a year.” Later in the entry, the user wondered,
“How do I condense the rest and make it meaningful?” but decided to
continue with his lengthy story “because this is my therapy, finally.”
Similarly, one September 11 survivor put this hopeful spin on the disaster’s
painful aftermath: “The images and memories are haunting me, and the scars
are very deep at this moment. I’m not always able to keep it together
emotionally. But despite the horror of it all, there is a great feeling of hope
inside me. I must be around for some reason, and I certainly intend to find
out.”
Thus, many of the messages left by survivors, victims’ family members,
and distant spectators appropriated rhetoric from the language of therapeutic
self-help. Occasionally this came in the form of a “cross-counseling”
dialogue that offered palliative advice to other imagined readers who shared
in one’s suffering over a disaster. At other times, the act of contributing to
these memorials was explicitly framed as self-help, as a way to work through
one’s own trauma by the simple act of telling one’s story.
Although the comments quoted above explicitly addressed the
therapeutic quality of such online commemoration, many other messages
focused on healing of a more traditional, spiritual nature. Some of the most
frequently expressed sentiments in the messages left at both the September 11
Digital Archive and the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank were explicitly
religious. Thirty-three percent of messages in the September 11 archive
contained religious references (although some were simply phrases such as
“God Bless America”), while 12 percent of the Hurricane Digital Memory
Bank postings contained religious content. Many authors, such as the
following who posted to the September 11 collection, were steadfast in their
religious beliefs:

Watching the news the entire evening with our children was a
difficult but memorable experience. We had an opportunity to
explain why evil exist in light of what the Bible teaches. More
importantly, it provided a reference point for giving them an eternal
perspective to the fallen nature of this world and the hope we have
when Jesus Christ returns… . In many respects, although I would
never wish the atrocity on any other human being, I’m glad that my
children were exposed to the tragedy.

Some users also found these tragedies to be cause for religiously


motivated introspection. A post in the 9/11 archive mused, “To say God has a
plan is all well and good I suppose, but the hijackers also believed they were
carrying out God’s plan didn’t they?” And a Hurricane memory bank user
admitted:

I’m still trying to work through why my life and the lives of my
children were spared. Why was I at the right place at the right time
when so many clearly were not? Do I have an obligation to the
people who suffered so directly and profoundly? If so, what is it? If
not, why not? Is life that random? And if life is that random then
why do we spend so much time in churches, synagogues, and
mosques?

Such musings combined questions about luck and theodicy with concerns
over the moral obligation to help others in need. These same sorts of
questions have become commonplace in other parts of American popular
culture, as well, especially on daytime talk shows (Illouz 2003).
Many entries at these sites reflected a basic desire to express or vent
one’s emotions, especially one’s fear, sadness, anger, or frustration. Some
expressed anger at the media for inaccurate or overly sensational coverage.
One submission to the September 11 Digital Archive asked, “The next time
there is a major attack or tradegy in America, … the media, please do not
constantly bombard us over and over and over with the same images. Think
of what this is doing to the minds and hearts of the victims families, children,
etc.” A Hurricane Digital Memory Bank contributor critiqued the unsettlingly
quick and ultimately inaccurate way in which television news media came to
consensus about the initial effects of the storm: “All these reporters were
reading from the same script. There was no healthy disagreement, as if the
source of all the information was one guy.” Still others focused their ire on
the longer period of post-Katrina coverage, as did one author who wished
“that the media would try to focus on the rebuilding efforts as they did with
the destruction.”
Similarly, anger was directed toward federal, state, and local government
in 14 percent of the entries at the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank. However,
such messages of anger were far less common in the September 11 Digital
Archive. Instead, entries in that archive were much more likely to praise the
federal government, as well as local police and firemen. When anger was
expressed, it was usually directed at terrorists. One user summed up these
post-9/11 sentiments this way:

As the day continued into days and weeks and months, I became
very proud to be an American as we were watching the heroics of
all the police & fireman and construction crews working around the
clock to save people and recover the bodies of the victims.
Regardless of the costs, we must continue the war on terrorism until
it is wiped from this planet.

Other messages referred to the fear and sadness associated with these
disasters. A typical user described September 11 as “such a sad day for
America.” Another stated, “I now felt that I was living in fear and that ‘they’
could attack from anywhere. Not only in the air, not only on land, but by
chemical warfare. They could put things in our water; they could put things
in our food, or even make us inhale things that were unsafe to humans. The
question that still remains is why? And when will this end?” By providing an
outlet for raw emotional expression, the September 11 Digital Archive
captured the grief and paranoia of post-9/11 America; both websites offered
the chance for users to undergo a kind of catharsis through such emotional
sharing.
Another common trope in the messages on both sites—albeit one that
appeared to span several of the categories I have tallied—was the notion that
these disasters might ultimately have served a beneficial purpose by inspiring
acts of kindness toward others, calling renewed attention to the preciousness
of human life, or offering a chance to rebuild in an improved fashion. For
instance, one user commented, “On that day, I saw the true New York that
everyone knows lies beneath the usual reputation. NYC became one big
village that day.” Another commenter asserted, “In some ways, I hope we
don’t return to the days before September 11. We were, I’m sorry, but such
greedy, selfish, self-absorbed, spoiled brats. Dear God, please don’t ever let
me lose my perspective again.” And a Hurricane Katrina survivor ended her
comments by writing that her “Katrina story now merges with that of all my
co-workers, neighbors and friends who have returned to ‘Rebuild a Greater
New Orleans.’ We are now part of a bigger story that will be written in the
history books. The same faith that sustained us all through our travails will
sustain us through the months and years ahead. Our individual stories will
serve as prelude to that story, not as epitaph.”
One contributor to the 9/11 digital archive said simply, “Remembering
that horrible day helps to bring some closure for me.” Indeed, this notion of
“closure” is another way in which the experience of posting a message or
story on a digital archive is a form of self-help. Such sentiments provided a
measure of relief by describing a world in which one’s nation, one’s family,
and even one’s self had suffered but had nonetheless transformed that
suffering into something positive. Of course, such closure is itself a construct
of a culture in which “the focus on people’s grief is common but mostly
constrained by limited patience and expectations that the person will solve
the problem within a brief amount of time” (Berns 2011, 11). Even in a
context where disaster victims and their families may be wary of being
exploited by the mass media, the assumption that “closure [is] real and
something people need” (Berns 2011, 9) is shared by many. In this sense,
contributing to a digital archive in the hopes of enacting some kind of healing
is still part of the larger cultural turn in which the market offers solutions for
grief and loss.

National Identity and the Limits of Empathy


It is safe to assume that most of those who went online and uploaded a
message at either of these two digital archives did so, at least in part, due to
some emotional connection to these disasters or those who suffered through
them. But this emotional connection varied between the two disasters and
caused two groups of people to submit to these sites in very different
proportions. User-submitted stories and messages at both the September 11
Digital Archive and the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank tended to make
reference to the author’s experience with the disaster. Thus, it was generally
easy to determine whether a respondent had been directly affected (i.e., had
been in lower Manhattan or Washington, DC, on September 11 or in the
geographical area hit by hurricanes Katrina and Rita), whether she had a
friend or loved one who was affected (in the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank
sample this occasionally referred to those who volunteered after the storm
and forged close relationships with those who had been affected), or whether
the respondent was not directly affected at all (as with the contributors who
described watching the events on television, although many of these users
would likely have described themselves as directly affected because they
watched the events on television). (See Table 4.2.)

TABLE 4.2. USERS’ CONNECTIONS TO DISASTERS

Some of the stories and messages posted by those with affected friends
or loved ones fulfilled a very basic function of memorials: commemorating
the dead. Like spontaneous shrines in the physical landscape, these entries in
the digital archives commemorated the life of a particular victim; in these
cases, the entries’ authors were usually friends or family members of the
deceased. Some messages described what it was like to experience the loss of
a loved one or commemorated aspects of a particular victim’s personality.
One user whose brother worked on the one-hundredth floor of Tower One
wrote, “I could not believe what was going on and then when the towers
collapsed my heart stopped. I sat there helplessly and watch as my brother die
right before my eyes and I could not do a thing to help him, it was the worst
felling in the world… . I will miss my brother very much.”
Another described the loss of her close friend who was a passenger on
American Airlines Flight 11: “My friend perished in the blaze aboard flight
11. She was a fighter and I am sure she did what she could to prevent those
men from trying to get into the cockpit… . She is a hero as all who were on
that plane and the other planes are. As the plane crashed through the tower
with what I can imagine as terrified faces of those aboard, I envision her
smiling face. Her lively personality, her generous spirit, her laughter is what I
think of.” Stories at the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank described such
losses in similar ways:

As the sun was going down on August 29, 2005, my 95-year-old,


invalid mother died in my arms as we tried to escape the rising flood
waters coming into our house by climbing the fold-down stairs into
the attic of our house… . Without going into exhaustive detail, I will
simply say that my past life died that day with Mother and my dogs.
I now wish to devote my life to living my life to be a blessing to
others.

Yet messages written by those with affected loved ones were a relatively
small percentage of the overall number of messages on both sites. In my
sample of the September 11 Digital Archive, the large majority of stories (80
percent) were submitted by those not directly affected by the attacks, while
11 percent of the stories were submitted by those with an affected loved one
and 8 percent by those who were directly affected. (In 1 percent of submitted
stories, it was impossible to discern the author’s relationship to the 9/11
attacks.) By contrast, the large majority of stories (73 percent) in the
Hurricane Digital Memory Bank were submitted by those who were directly
affected by one of the storms, while 10 percent were submitted by those with
affected loved ones; 10 percent, by unaffected authors; and 7 percent, by
those whose relationship to the storms was impossible to determine. Part of
this discrepancy is surely due to the very different geographical reach of these
two catastrophes. Hurricanes Katrina and Rita destroyed countless homes and
properties across a huge swath of the country, and even those whose
properties and homes remained unharmed may have had to evacuate for
several days—a scenario that was described many times in the sample by
those directly affected. By contrast, only those in or near the World Trade
Center complex, the Pentagon, or the Shanksville, Pennsylvania, crash site of
United Airlines Flight 93 on September 11 were directly affected in this same
sense.
But another explanation for the fact that many unaffected people
submitted stories to the September 11 archive while far fewer did so in the
Hurricane Memory Bank has to do with the role September 11 played in
constructions of American nationalism overall. Five percent of Hurricane
Digital Memory Bank users framed their stories in terms of the local
community—either as a crisis in their towns or cities, such as Waveland or
New Orleans, or as a tragedy for the entire Gulf Coast—while only 3 percent
described the storms as affecting the entire nation or as having repercussions
for the United States as a whole. One user who applied a regional framework
to Hurricane Katrina said:

I love New Orleans, its people and culture. There truly is no other
place like it in the United States. During my evacuation travels,
people said ugly things like let it go, why go back, the sins of the
city caused this, etc. I explained the life style here. They all
marveled at it and understood. Do we tell the midwest to evacuate
and leave forever because of tornadoes; or California people to
leave forever because of fire storms and so on? Of course not. We
will rebuild I said.

Entries such as this reflected the sense that, as coverage of Hurricane Katrina
dragged on, Americans in other parts of the country began to blame the
citizens of New Orleans and the rest of the Gulf region for the terrible
aftermath. For instance, many messages sought to correct the national news
media’s portrayal of survivors as “looters,” as did one contributor who
argued, “The so-called looters are simply grabbing water, food, diapers and
medicines, because the federal and state officials have refused to provide
these basic necessities.”
By contrast, the commemorative messages at the September 11 Digital
Archive reflected an understanding of that disaster as a national event that
largely transcended the regional boundaries of affected areas. Thirty-five
percent of the September 11 archive sample framed the 9/11 attacks as part of
American national identity, while only 2 percent described them solely in
terms of the local community. One author commented, “Terrorists tried to
bomb the life out of New York City, but ordinary people saved each other,”
yet such a New York–centered framework was rare. Instead, many authors of
submissions to the September 11 archive ended their messages with some
variation of the phrase “God Bless America.” Similar national frameworks
did not appear nearly as frequently in the hurricane archive, although one
memory bank contributor did remark that “when Katrina hit, I saw a change
in the way Americans view ‘attacks’ on the United States even if it was a
national disaster compared to a terrorist attack.”
The nationalistic response in the digital archive mirrors the overall
reaction to the September 11 terrorist attacks in the mainstream media and in
public life in general, all of which were flooded by an immediate surge of
patriotism and support for the government. This was somewhat reflected in
the September 11 archive sample, as well: 4 percent of messages expressed
pro-government sentiments, while just 1 percent expressed anger at the
government. One digital archive contributor used the site to describe her
post-9/11 renewal of nationalism: “I’ve come to realize how much I love my
country. I appreciate the people in the armed services, the firemen and the
policemen more than I ever thought I would. I love the American flag.”
Another contributor expressed very similar sentiments on the one-year
anniversary of the attacks, but with a slightly ominous, militaristic tone:
“Today, a year later, our nation still stands proud, strong, and united, as
promised by President Bush. As we keep those lost in this act of terrorism in
our thoughts and prayers, the fight against terrorism continues. And trust me,
the battle has just begun.” This idea that the September 11 attacks were an act
of war and that the subsequent war on terror was a just one was perpetuated
by frequent historical comparisons to Pearl Harbor, which happened in 4
percent of the sample, making it by far the most frequent historical
comparison, much as it was in the print and televised media discussed in
Chapter 3.
In contrast, 14 percent of submissions to the Hurricane Digital Memory
Bank expressed antigovernment sentiment directed at federal, state, or local
authorities, while just 1 percent of those submissions praised government
authorities. As one fairly representative comment from the memory bank
stated, “In the immediate aftermath of Hurricane Katrina, the federal
government did a terrible job. No doubt about that. Americans stranded on
roofs. Americans without food and water. People in war-ravaged,
dysfunctional nations looking at us on television saw that our country could
be just as dysfunctional as their own.” Another user lamented the lack of
disaster preparedness on the part of the Army Corps of Engineers:

Of all the things that happened that week, the one I cannot get over
is that the city and the Army Corp of Engineers did not have an
emergency plan to patch a levee breach. Certainly they would have
a few helicopters or barges and a few hundred tons of sandbags
sitting around waiting to be rushed to a breach. It was inconceivable
that if a levee started to break the emergency plan was to watch it on
television. But that, in fact, was the plan.

These sentiments were also in keeping with public opinion as a whole on


Hurricane Katrina, which was largely seen as a failure on the part of
numerous state and federal agencies (Pew Research Center for the People and
the Press 2005).
The fact that most Hurricane Digital Memory Bank users were
themselves directly affected by the storm, while most September 11 Digital
Archive users were not directly affected by the terrorist attacks, reflects the
ways that national identity has been constructed around September 11 by
political and media elites in the past decade. September 11 was experienced
as a national turning point in which unspeakable tragedy had called forth
many acts of heroism and kindness and a renewed sense of American resolve.
By contrast, Hurricane Katrina and the government’s inept response to it
became a mark of national shame. As such, although both of these disasters
were witnessed by millions of Americans on live television, and although
both monopolized popular culture for many weeks, people from all over
America felt moved to commemorate September 11 online, while the
majority of Americans who posted online reflections of Hurricane Katrina
were those from the affected region. Despite its mission to collect and
preserve memories of hurricanes Katrina and Rita, the Hurricane Digital
Memory Bank abetted national forgetting as well as remembering, since few
who were not from the immediately affected regions contributed.
Of course, all forms of commemoration and archiving necessarily
involve the exclusion of certain perspectives, thereby enabling a gradual
forgetting of details not included in official collections or representations. But
in this case, the lack of a nationwide contingent of contributors to the
memory bank speaks to the perception of those in the region that their plight
was too quickly forgotten by the rest of the United States. One user described
this as a waning of national sympathy:

When Hurricane Katrina hit, our nation offered us sympathy.


Millions of Americans accepted us into their cities. They sent 18-
wheelers heavy with goodwill and provisions. Others came here,
donned hazard suits and helped us. But I fear this compassion is
wearing thin. It has been nearly 18 months. By now, the thinking
goes, real Americans, self-reliant Americans, would have picked
themselves up by their stiff upper lips and gotten on with life.

This drying up of compassion—“Katrina fatigue,” as some have called it


—speaks to the limits of contemporary mass-mediated empathy. Inasmuch as
it is possible to experience the pain and suffering of others vicariously, this
experience is still refracted through one’s own preexisting biases based on
age, race, class, gender, or even geographical region. In addition, one may be
more likely to engage empathetically with the kinds of suffering that reaffirm
one’s existing belief system rather than suffering that calls one’s core beliefs
into question. The pain of 9/11, with its grieving widows, heroic firefighters
and police, and calls for national unity, confirmed the belief in American
exceptionalism that many already held. Thus, many felt encouraged to post
their reflections in a digital archive even though they did not know anyone
who was directly affected by the attacks, a sign that September 11 was the
whole nation’s disaster and that vicarious, mass-mediated empathy in a
national crisis was an appropriate response for distant spectators. Indeed, the
promise of such communion and catharsis is part of the appeal of empathetic
hedonism
Yet despite similar levels of media coverage and an initially similar
outpouring of national emotion, Hurricane Katrina’s victims were beset by
various forms of victim blame and racial stereotyping (see Garfield 2007),
which aided a national distancing and ultimately marked the disaster as a
regional one, even though federal agencies such as the Federal Emergency
Management Agency, the Army Corps of Engineers, and the National Guard
had played such a large role. In that sense, the fact that so few unaffected
individuals posted online remembrances at the Hurricane Digital Memory
Bank shows that digital archives can also reflect the processes of forgetting
that have occurred throughout American culture regarding Hurricane Katrina,
and thus reaffirm the limits of our mediated empathy.

The Politics of Online Commemoration


The stories and messages submitted to the September 11 Digital Archive and
Hurricane Digital Memory Bank exhibit several forms of therapeutic rhetoric
and commemorative strategies that are also associated with sites of collective
memory in the physical landscape. One very traditional type of rhetoric
employed in these messages involved the use of religious language and
references to God. Such rhetoric sought to provide comfort to an imagined
audience of suffering readers—and, perhaps, to the authors themselves—
through tried-and-true references to the wisdom of a higher power. However,
some of these religious reflections also turned inward, adopting a more
personal, diary-like style to ponder age-old philosophical questions about the
role of God in times of great pain and loss.
Another seemingly traditional function of the messages at these sites was
the commemoration of the dead. However, it is worth remembering that
monuments and memorials to everyday people and victims of tragedies are,
with some exceptions, a rather recent phenomenon. A number of entries
coped with this commemorative tradition by labeling the victims of these
disasters “heroes,” since heroes have always been popular subjects for
commemoration. But interestingly, some authors simply used their entries to
describe personality quirks and other mundane details about the deceased.
This reflects a more populist, less didactic style of commemoration, in which
users themselves determine the significance of the words and images that are
to be collected and made part of a memorial and in which mundane aspects of
daily life may be deemed worthy of collection and memorialization.
In this way, digital memory banks and online archives sidestep some of
the political questions about the representation of disasters within collective
memory. Traditionally, archives and other repositories of collective memory
in physical space have had to decide which documents and artifacts were
worth storing and which ones they did not have room for, as well as how to
display the artifacts they did collect. These decisions were necessarily
political and frequently elicited objections “voiced by conservatives who
abhor efforts of archives and museums to educate (and not only to edify) their
publics” (Brown and Davis-Brown 1998, 20). While the memory banks
described here did not have to deal with physical space limitations and thus
were able to include any and all submissions from survivors, victims’ family
members, and distant spectators in an equal fashion, such inclusiveness
meant that no larger narrative about the disaster existed on these sites. This
may ultimately be a more equitable way to collect and store the past, but it
does suggest a shift away from older pedagogical forms of commemoration
that inspired political debate over what to collect and how to present it.
This movement away from explicit efforts at meaning making is a
phenomenon associated with recent memorials in the physical landscape, as
well, one that Kirk Savage has discussed in relation to the plans for a World
Trade Center memorial:

Some might decide that the best way to create a memorial that
“evolves” is to avoid the question of meaning altogether, to create a
“neutral” memorial that asks visitors to generate their own “personal
and private” interpretations of the event. But another response to
these requirements would be to confront the question of meaning,
not to fix it or impose it in the traditional didactic manner but to
frame questions rather than answers, still leaving room for
understanding to evolve. (Savage 2006, 115)

In online memorials where users supply all or most of the content, the sites’
creators have little ability to guide visitors or frame questions. Instead, the
more haphazard navigation of online archives and memory banks allows for a
panoply of potential experiences for users that, to paraphrase Savage (2006,
115), are just as likely to “inspire hate and a desire for revenge,” as to create
some sort of psychic healing or deeper understanding, depending on the
particular entries one searches for or stumbles on. Moreover, one wonders
whether the sheer number of submissions to these sites will make it hard for
visitors in the future to find any particularly insightful or moving messages
amid this cacophony of commemoration.
This remains a potentially problematic aspect of this new and democratic
form of collective memory. Recollection of the past has always been an
“active, constructive process, not a simple matter of retrieving information”
(Schwartz 1982, 374). The “fundamentally interactive, dialogical quality of
every memorial space” (Young 1993, xiv) means that we are all, to some
extent, prosumers of history each time we visit even the most rigid of official
monument sites. Digital archives provide a more literal version of the kinds
of interactivity or co-construction associated with memorials in the physical
landscape, by inviting anyone and everyone to contribute, and by refusing to
rank those contributions. But the resultant hodgepodge of memorial messages
is likely to forestall certain kinds of user actions and interactions even as it
encourages others.
Most importantly, the difficulty of navigating as a reader through the
multitude of submissions on these sites reinforces the fact that they are
designed primarily as outlets for contributors rather than simply to be
consumed by other readers. While the experience of the Box family described
at the start of this article was certainly one in which a similar archive was
successfully “consumed,” these archives appear to be used more often for a
therapeutic form of self-help in which prosumers can leave their messages
and stories behind to enact their own psychological fulfillment. In that sense,
these archives provide ample opportunities to work through the trauma
associated with surviving a disaster or simply watching it on television and
can simulate a kind of cross-counseling dialogue with an imagined readership
of suffering others. Although emotional self-expression often generates new
and somewhat unpredictable emotions (Reddy 2001), it seems fairly
uncontroversial to believe that the public talking- or writing-through of one’s
pain or suffering surrounding a disaster can indeed elicit a positive emotional
transformation and at least help ease a tiny bit of that suffering. In that sense,
these digital archives and memory banks presumably fulfill their missions of
fostering “positive legacies.”
However, if one takes these digital memory banks seriously as
therapeutic experiences, then the memory banks also warrant scrutiny on
those grounds. Critics have taken America’s popular faith in therapy to task
for offering fast and simple solutions to complex problems and because “our
emphasis on the individual psyche has blinded us to underlying social
realities” (Moskowitz 2001, 283). Something similar may have been at work
in the therapeutic messages within these digital archives, which largely
presented disasters as obstacles that had caused pain and suffering for
individual authors but that could and would be overcome by those
individuals. Even messages that addressed the nation as a whole frequently
transposed this narrative of individual self-improvement to a national context.
As Eva Illouz (2003, 234) has pointed out, “Recycling narratives of suffering
into narratives of self-improvement … erases the scandal of suffering.” Thus,
when a user explained that September 11 offered a profound lesson on good
and evil for her young children and another hoped that America would never
return to the “spoiled” days before 9/11, and even when a Katrina survivor
spoke passionately about rebuilding a greater New Orleans, they risked
minimizing the real horror and scandalous injustice of both these disasters, no
matter how measured their language might have been or how understandable
the impulse was to positively reframe these tragedies.
Critics of therapeutic culture have long suggested that such individual
comfort may come at the expense of the larger, more conventional purposes
of community (see Reiff 1966). The past several decades in the United States
have seen “lifestyle enclaves” geared toward private forms of leisure and
consumption supplant more traditional forms of communal organization
(Bellah et al. 1985). Inasmuch as online sites of commemoration reflect this
trend, then the simple act of reaffirming one’s identity and having one’s
framework of meaning reinforced by others online is likely a therapeutic
experience.
“However,” writes Felicia Wu Song (2004, 144), “where communities
had once functioned as a source of these identities and moral frameworks,
there is now a tendency to emphasize how individuals can choose and
construct communities that share and affirm their pre-established, self-
derived identities. As a result, there is little to keep online communities from
being reduced to communities of therapeutic function alone, again at the
expense of external communal ends.” Thus, one wonders about the aggregate
effects of this largely individualistic, therapeutic approach to
commemoration.
If there is a politics behind vernacular forms of commemoration such as
digital archives and spontaneous shrines, then it is an individualistic one, in
which the commemoration of individual victims serves as protest against the
urge to forget or the depersonalization that is somewhat inherent toward
victims of mass tragedies (Santino 2006). As John Torpey (2006) has argued
regarding reparations politics, however, such a perspective is in many ways a
poor substitute for the progressive visions of the future associated with older
political movements. He asserts that “a legalistic, therapeutic, and theological
attitude towards the past has tended to supplant the quest of active citizens
and mobilized constituencies for an alternative future” (Torpey 2006, 15).
This backward-looking, individualistic politics is essentially a form of
nostalgia. As Maurice Halbwachs recognized long ago, “That faraway world
where we remember that we suffered nevertheless exercises an
incomprehensible attraction on the person who has survived it and who seems
to think he has left there the best part of himself, which he tries to recapture”
(Halbwachs 1992, 49). Such nostalgia was often evident in the messages at
both archives, a fact that speaks to some of the more conventional or
conservative qualities of these new forms of online prosumption. It also
suggests that these archives have missed an opportunity to encourage a more
explicitly collective experience, as thousands of users have been motivated to
contribute to this new form of commemoration, but have done so in a largely
atomized, inward-looking manner.
In this sense, therapeutic online commemoration may be at odds with
progressive collective political mobilization around disasters, since it teaches
that the mass suffering brought about by catastrophes such as September 11
and Hurricane Katrina is something to be overcome through many disparate
acts of individual healing rather transformations in the social structure. Given
the many problematic aspects of the government’s response to both these
disasters and the general hostility to collective action in the current neoliberal
moment, it makes sense that digital memory banks and archives reflect the
predominantly individualistic, therapeutic attitude toward many social
problems in American society today. With no strong, progressive political
movements emerging from these two disasters, at least individuals may find
comfort for themselves at these digital archives, either by reading the
messages of others or by contributing their own stories and reflections. Still,
if the construction of “positive legacies” means more than simply making
individuals feel better—if it means contributing to the creation of a more just
society in which such tragedies are less likely to be repeated—then these
archives may not be living up to their admittedly enormous missions.

Conclusion: Commemoration and Inequality


Recollection of the past has always been a subjective process in which
meaning is made and re-made over the years (see Schwartz 1982). In this
sense, the collective construction of historical memory has exhibited aspects
of what may be called prosumption since long before various forms of online
collaboration between producers and consumers made the term fashionable.
War heroes, politicians, workers, teachers, screenwriters, television viewers,
museum architects, archivists, and memorial visitors all participate in the co-
construction, and frequent revision, of collective memory. We are all, to
some extent, prosumers of history.
Yet collective memory is more than an aggregation of idiosyncratic
individual recollections. As Jeffrey Olick (1999, 342) reminds us, “There are
clearly demonstrable long-term structures to what societies remember or
commemorate that are stubbornly impervious to the efforts of individuals to
escape them. Powerful institutions clearly value some histories more than
others, provide narrative patterns and exemplars of how individuals can and
should remember, and stimulate memory in ways and for reasons that have
nothing to do with the individual or aggregate neurological records.” As
bottom-up, largely non-hierarchical spaces open to any and all contributors,
digital archives have the potential to challenge institutionalized forms of
collective memory and top-down interpretations of historical events. But did
these two particular archives realize that potential?
In some ways, yes, particularly as a challenge to the mainstream news
media. Although they accounted for less than 5 percent of the overall
submissions to the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank, there were nonetheless
entries in that archive that exposed the flaws, inadequacies, or ethical lapses
of the mainstream news organizations’ Katrina coverage. As has already been
discussed, some contributors sought to correct the frequent
mischaracterization of storm victims, especially African Americans, as
looters. In fact, pro-social behavior was one of the two most frequently
occurring themes in the stories posted to the memory bank, appearing in 14
percent of entries and offering a much needed corrective to the notion that
Katrina loosed mere anarchy on the world.
Some users of the memory bank even struggled with the ethics of media
representation itself. One contributor described his media-induced disregard
for the suffering of others and his eventual change of heart when he met an
actual survivor of Hurricane Katrina. He wrote, “I’d seen the flashes of
shredded houses and frantic victims of Hurricane Katrina on television. Sure,
I’d felt pity for them and their families, but honestly, after the media stopped
posting headliners of the disaster on newspapers, I’d let the event slip out of
my mind… . It was horrifying what Katrina did, but it didn’t really affect
me.” Another contributor described the events behind the creation of what
eventually became an iconic photo:
They told us we had to lay him at the side of the road. At my
insistence he was brought to the entrance of City Park. I covered
him with a green cloth and a properly folded American flag. When
we saw him a couple days later the green shroud had been replaced
by the unfolded flag. Someone told me that Newsweek had
published the picture. It bothered me to think that someone may
have changed the tableau (i.e., put the opened flag and lay it over
the body) just to “get the shot.” I think I’m OK with it now that I
understand the picture might have had enough emotional impact to
jar those with the ability to help out of complacency.

Such nuanced criticism shows that the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank
offered thoughtful, alternative perspectives on the media’s coverage of the
storm and its aftermath and a venue in which those who harbored such
perspectives could express themselves. Furthermore, unlike so many of the
examples of disaster consumption described throughout the book, these
archives have remained nonprofit ventures with no advertisements and no
access fees. It should be noted, however, that less than 1 percent of the
messages in the September 11 sample contained similar media criticism.
Besides critiquing mainstream media, both of these digital archives
essentially circumvented the political and cultural gatekeepers who normally
decide on the content of permanent, official memorials in the physical
landscape. Spontaneous commemorators of tragedy online and in the physical
landscape were able to have a say in the content of the memorials they helped
create, even if they had no training in architecture or design and even if
neither they nor any of their family members had been victimized.
Furthermore, these contributors got to decide for themselves what images,
messages, and stories were worth collecting and archiving, thus evading the
power of archivists and museum curators to make such determinations.
Like other forms of vernacular memorial expression, this online
commemoration also sped up the time frame of memorial creation. Rather
than waiting to visit an official memorial that might have taken more than a
decade to complete, spontaneous commemorators began to contribute to the
construction of memorials on the Internet and on street corners and in city
squares even while these disastrous events were still under way. This
emerging norm of near-immediate commemoration has actually begun to
change the pace with which official memorials are designed and constructed
—for example, the 1966 shooting at the University of Texas was not
commemorated with a memorial on that campus until 1999, but Virginia
Tech had begun planning a temporary memorial on campus within weeks of
its shooting in 2007 (Stearns 2008). New York City’s Union Square was a
similar site of spontaneous commemoration in the immediate aftermath of the
September 11 attacks (Zukin 2002). Yet one advantage of vernacular spaces
of online commemoration over spontaneous physical memorials is that online
memorials have actually tended to last longer: although some physical
locations of tragedy and death have become permanent shrines, the initial,
vernacular contributions to these spaces are usually eventually moved away
and either destroyed or housed elsewhere, especially if such sites are in
everyday use or have been slated to be rebuilt.
That said, the bulk of what has been collected at both the September 11
Digital Archive and the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank has tended to
reflect, rather than challenge, mass-mediated public opinion and conventional
wisdom about these two disasters. The most frequently occurring themes in
the messages of the September 11 archive, by a wide margin, were national
patriotism and religion, thus mimicking much mainstream discourse in
popular culture around that disaster. Along with the theme of pro-social
behavior, anger at the government was one of the two most frequently
occurring topics in the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank, followed very
closely by stories of antisocial behavior, religious topics, and rebuilding or
resilience. In both archives, such themes were entirely appropriate and
understandable, but they nonetheless echoed the sorts of ideas commonly
expressed in mass media and consumer culture, as well as those enshrined in
official memorials and archives. Even the therapeutic potential of reading and
contributing messages at these digital archives was very much in keeping
with prevailing norms surrounding mass-mediated emotion and the
empathetic consumption of others’ suffering.
This is in some ways not surprising. The digital and the physical are not
separate realms of existence but increasingly constitute each other (see
Jurgenson 2011). They are subject to the same social structures and
inequalities. But the fact that these digital archives reproduced the
mainstream rhetoric and ideology surrounding these two disasters at least
puts a damper on any kind of cyber-utopian longing for distinct alternatives
to disaster consumerism. The problems of disaster consumerism in the print
and televisual media follow it online, as well.
If the messages and stories of thousands of archive contributors are to be
believed, these sites facilitated genuine emotional reactions, thoughtful
responses, and descriptions of disaster in all of their messy, quotidian reality.
There is certainly value in collecting such responses for posterity, even if
they fail to contest prevailing belief systems or resist existing normative
structures. Indeed, the mundane and conventional character of these messages
are part of their seeming authenticity. As Pierre Nora put it in his discussion
of an explosion of pre-digital archiving, “The less extraordinary the
testimony, the more aptly it is taken to illustrate the average mentality” (Nora
1996, 9). An archive filled primarily with comments that were politically
challenging, aesthetically sophisticated, or wildly idiosyncratic would likely
be perceived as inauthentic and would appear as if it had been created by a
specialized audience or group. Sites such as the September 11 Digital
Archive and the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank, in which challenging or
oppositional entries were tempered by many others consisting of ordinary
details and conventional wisdom, are much more likely to radiate the
appropriately authentic aura, which serves as an assurance to visitors that
other regular people created these entries. If nothing else, such an aura helps
establish the kind of trust in strangers on which therapeutic online encounters
typically rely (see Song 2004).
Beyond its therapeutic purposes, the constitution of an aura at digital
archives calls into question the larger role of authenticity in disaster
consumption. As a set of subjective, aesthetic criteria, authenticity ultimately
has to do more with form than with substance. In these online archives,
authenticity was derived from open access to the process of record keeping
and from one’s ability to co-create a small portion of the records being kept.
In other examples discussed throughout this book, it has emanated from
shaky camera work, intimate close-ups of traumatized interviewees,
frightened voices of normally calm news anchors, the home-made digital
“manifesto” of a deranged killer, or artifacts and souvenirs taken from
physical locations marked by tragedy. These cues to the authenticity of
products or media have little to do with the substance of what is said or meant
by disaster-related texts and commodities. In this way, the authenticity of
disaster allows individuals with a wide variety of viewpoints and
backgrounds to forge vicarious emotional connections, but in ways that are
unlikely to challenge an individualistic understanding of disasters and their
consequences. Such an understanding often reinforces the existing
inequalities responsible for disasters in the first place.
To drive home this point, it is worth comparing these digital forms of
commemoration with the official, physical memorials devoted to September
11 and Hurricane Katrina. The idea of a 9/11 memorial became a national
priority almost immediately after the attacks, and the money devoted to that
tragedy’s three memorial sites reflects this. The cost of the Flight 93 National
Memorial in Shanksville, Pennsylvania, has been estimated at $56 million
and that of the Pentagon 9/11 Memorial, at $32 million. The budget for the
World Trade Center memorial and museum is more than $500 million, which
was drastically decreased after the initial plans topped the $1 billion mark
(BBC News 2006; T. Dwyer 2006; Frangos 2006; Pitz 2009). By contrast,
like much of the effort to rebuild New Orleans and the rest of the Gulf Coast,
plans for an official memorial to Hurricane Katrina have been modest and
have received little national attention. The blueprint for rebuilding New
Orleans initially called for a $3.5 million memorial (Bohrer 2007), but the
actual design conceived and stewarded by the New Orleans coroner Frank
Minyard is projected to cost just $1.5 million, plus $500,000 for perpetual
care (MacCash 2007). It is telling, then, that the digital memorials studied
here largely mimicked this unequal division of national interest and
resources: the September 11 Digital Archive had many times the number of
contributors as the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank, and those who did
contribute to the latter were usually residents of the affected geographical
area, in contrast to the national and even global reach of the September 11
Digital Archive. Thus, despite their potential to elicit powerful emotional
responses and occasional critical inquiry, these two online archives
constituted an authentic reflection of existing inequities rather than an
authentic challenge to them.
“The commandment of the hour is thus ‘Thou shalt remember,’” wrote
Nora. “It is the self that remembers, and what it remembers is itself, hence the
historical transformation of memory has led to a preoccupation with
individual psychology” (Nora 1996, 10–11). The same preoccupation with
individual psychology that Nora identified decades ago continues today at
these two digital archives, in which so many came together to commemorate
these two mass tragedies but did so in a series of largely atomized, inward-
looking bits of autobiography and therapeutic memory work. These messages
and their authors are ultimately a part of a collection but not of anything that
might be labeled a community. Perhaps in the future, forms of online
collective memory might emerge that are more explicitly concerned with
social, rather than individual, change. Until then, let us hope, as one
Hurricane Katrina survivor did, that “our individual stories will serve as
prelude to that story, not as an epitaph.”

1. At the time of my research, the Hurricane Digital Memory Bank had 1,209 user-submitted stories.
For this study, I read all of them, but I omitted several types of entries, including any that were written
in languages other than English, any that were not actually submitted by their authors (some people
posted news articles or other content that they had not written), and any that were classified incorrectly
(e.g., that described a picture and thus should have been in the Images section); I also omitted poetry,
on the grounds that having to interpret poetry would stretch the reliability of my analysis. This left me
with a sample of 963 stories or messages. I used the same criteria for the September 11 Digital Archive,
but because its section of Stories from Site Visitors contained 7,126 entries, I randomly sampled 41
pages of entries, for a total of 369 stories or messages, which decreased to 345 entries after entries that
met the exclusion criteria given above were omitted. All quotations from user stories are transcribed
verbatim and without interpolation.
CONCLUSION
THE DEEPWATER HORIZON OIL SPILL AND
DISASTERS STILL TO COME

O n April 20, 2010, the Deepwater Horizon oil rig owned by British
Petroleum (BP) exploded and sank in the Gulf of Mexico, killing eleven
workers and breaking open a well one mile beneath the surface of the Gulf
that began pouring 1.5 million–2.5 million gallons of oil a day into the sea
(CNN Wire Staff 2010). For the next eighty-seven days, BP crews, the U.S.
Coast Guard, and scores of volunteers cleaned beaches, deployed oil
containment booms, and worked to prevent more oil-related damage as BP
sought first to cap the damaged well and then to plug the leak. The depth of
the leak made the process of repairing the well and halting the flow of oil a
painstakingly slow and frequently unsuccessful one, however, as various
options failed or were halted due to bad luck, bad weather, or faulty
technology. But after a summer mixed with both failure and incremental
progress, the well was sealed on July 15. By August 4, the Obama
administration had held a press conference to announce that the “static kill”
procedure of pumping mud and then cement into the now capped well had
worked to stop the flow of oil. The administration also announced that three-
quarters of the leaked oil had already been captured on the surface,
dissipated, or otherwise dispersed (Achenbach and Mufson 2010; Gillis
2010). When all was said and done, the broken well and its rapidly leaking
oil had dominated the news media and the national consciousness during the
otherwise slow summer news season and stirred widespread fears of
ecological devastation.
Despite the positive pronouncements of relieved White House officials,
the public still had reason to worry about the spill’s long-term effects. White
House officials had already admitted that the spill was likely the worst
environmental disaster in U.S. history (Associated Press 2010), so many Gulf
coast residents refused to take BP’s and the White House’s word on the
amount of oil remaining in the water and about the degree of risk posed by
the oil that did remain (Bluestein and Weber 2010). Subsequent scientific
tests seemed to prove these residents right; they suggested that as much as 80
percent of the oil remained in the Gulf and confirmed that the sea floor was
covered in oil for many miles around the spill site (Gutman and Blackburn
2010; Gutman and Dolak 2010). Even if the initial assessments had been
correct, the amount of oil remaining in the Gulf would have been much
greater than the amount in Alaska’s Prince William Sound during the Exxon
Valdez spill of 1989, and many Alaskan fisheries have yet to recover from
that disaster (Klein 2010). Thousands of birds and other animals died or were
hurt in the weeks immediately after the BP spill, and the damage from oil and
oil dispersants to the larvae and eggs of crab, shrimp, and fish are expected to
be severe, although exactly how severe is still unclear (Biello 2011; Dute
2014). Taking into account the Gulf of Mexico’s incredible diversity and
already fragile ecosystem, it is likely that many more animals will ultimately
be hurt by the effects of this oil. Of the 1,728 species of plants and animals in
the spill zone, 135 are unique to the area and 74 are already endangered; in
the worst-case scenario, the spill will permanently alter the marine chemistry
of the Gulf to the point that many of these species will simply not survive
(Hotz 2010).
Thus, as with the disasters that preceded it, the deleterious effects of the
BP spill were likely to persist longer than the attention of most of the national
news media. One Washington Post story perhaps unwittingly revealed this
dynamic: “Analysts compared the spill’s tarnishing of Barack Obama’s
reputation to the damage Hurricane Katrina did to President George W.
Bush’s image. Both disasters tested presidential responsiveness and
sensitivity. Unlike Katrina, however, the spill had staying power. Katrina
came and went, leaving devastation behind, but the spill ‘is this ogre that
keeps coming at us,’ one administration official said a few weeks into the
disaster” (Achenbach and Mufson 2010, para. 14–15). Although the residents
of New Orleans and other communities that have yet to be fully rebuilt would
certainly quarrel with the notion that Hurricane Katrina “came and went,” this
quote unwittingly reminds us that all disasters eventually lack “staying
power” in contemporary media culture. As Susan Moeller (2006, 186) put it,
“Once the complications of reconstruction begin … the media cover ‘simple’
and ‘complex’ emergencies in much the same way, which is to say that they
do not cover either of them.”
Like most modern disasters, this one produced a variety of striking
images. Photographs of the massive Deepwater Horizon rig burning and
sinking into the ocean garnered early media attention, but the most iconic
images came on June 3 when an Associated Press photographer took pictures
of brown pelicans and other seabirds covered in, and presumably dying from,
a thick, brown coat of oil at Louisiana’s East Grand Terre Island. Video
footage of the birds soon followed on most major news networks. At a time
when the potential environmental impact of the vast and uncontrolled leak
was really just beginning to dawn on the American public, these images
provided the first concrete proof of the toll that the oil was surely taking on a
wide range of wildlife throughout the Gulf.
Although the American public did not initially watch this tragedy unfold
in real time as it had on September 11, and despite the fact that BP tried to
restrict and control images of the disaster, members of Congress eventually
received access to internal video feeds from BP’s underwater rovers, which
some of those representatives then displayed to news networks without BP’s
permission (J. W. Peters 2010). BP soon announced it would turn off this live
video feed during its first attempt at a “top-kill” procedure on May 26 but
relented under pressure from the White House (Werner 2010). The resulting
broadcast of what turned out to be a failed attempt to plug the leak was, in the
words of one journalist, “an Internet smash” (Jonsson 2010). More than one
million people viewed the video embedded in PBS’s website, and more than
three thousand websites used the feed, which many television news channels
also displayed. Although this video feed lacked the visual spectacle of other
disasters, its large audience nevertheless speaks to the continued public
appetite for live footage of disasters, as well as the perceived authenticity of
such footage. Although it was frequently difficult to tell what was happening,
and almost absurdly abstract at times, audiences trusted these images of oil
ceaselessly billowing into the deep sea to reveal the truth of the matter—or, at
least, to keep BP and the White House honest in their public
pronouncements.
BP’s initial attempt to withhold its own underwater footage of the spill
was matched by attempts to block the access of journalists to sites where the
oil had surfaced and reached land (J. W. Peters 2010). When coupled with the
numerous gaffes of BP’s chief executive Tony Hayward, which were heavily
covered by a news media attuned to stories on political missteps, the
company took a public relations hit that resulted in lowered stock prices and a
nationalist American backlash against the suddenly foreign British Petroleum
company (Gross 2010; Weber and McClam 2010). Many forms of spill-
related consumer culture reflected the company’s poor public image, as well.
The company CafePress, which prints logos and designs uploaded by web
users onto T-shirts, mugs, bags, and other products, had more than two
thousand spill-related designs for sale on more than seventy thousand
possible products, most of which contained slogans such as “give bp the bird”
around a drawing of an oil-covered pelican, or bumper stickers that read
simply “FUBP.”
Much of the spill-related merchandise for sale at CafePress advocated
boycotting BP, a sentiment with a strong presence in other online venues, as
well. The Facebook account Boycott BP had more than 800,000 fans; the site
BoycottBP.org boasted twenty-nine thousand unique visitors; and Public
Citizen’s boycott petition (http://www.citizen.org/boycott-bp) contained more
than twenty-two thousand signatures. But the efficacy of such boycotts has
also been called into question. As Newsweek’s Sharon Begley put it, “Just as
buying green products is better for our eco-esteem than it is an effective way
to save the planet, so consumer boycotts of the latest oil company to run afoul
of public opinion are emotionally satisfying but ultimately futile” (Begley
2010, para. 9). Indeed, competing oil companies that would likely benefit
from a consumer boycott of BP gas have similarly poor records on
environmental and human rights issues. Unlike other famous consumer
boycotts, such as the Montgomery, Alabama, bus boycott that jumpstarted the
Civil Rights Movement, or the 1980s boycott of canned tuna that led to the
adoption of dolphin-safe fishing techniques, few real alternatives exist for
consumers who are concerned about the environmental effects of deep sea oil
exploration and our general dependence on fossil fuels, since electric cars are
not an affordable option for the bulk of consumers at this time (Begley 2010).
Perhaps as a result, public protests of BP and the oil industry in general
took more symbolic, emotional approaches. For example, one organization
called Hands across the Sand (http://www.handsacrossthesand.com) held an
event on June 26, 2010, in which people gathered at beaches all across the
country to join hands for fifteen minutes as a show of support for “protection
of our coastal economies, oceans, marine wildlife, and fishing industry.” Like
the BP boycott, such events seemed geared more toward their participants’
emotional well-being than toward addressing any concrete changes or
policies. Indeed, one wonders whether the goals of protecting coastal
economies and the fishing industry are at all compatible with the goals of
protecting oceans and marine wildlife in any sense other than the symbolic.
But, as with other forms of disaster consumerism, the personal demonstration
of empathy in the face of others’ suffering is an increasingly important
cultural norm and participation in these sorts of symbolic protests is an
effective marker of both empathy and sincerity. Tony Hayward faced heavy
criticism precisely for his perceived lack of empathy, especially after he
infamously told the Times of London, “I want my life back” (quoted in
Guarino 2010) in the wake of a disaster in which eleven people literally lost
their lives. President Obama was also criticized early on in the crisis for
failing to exhibit an appropriate level of emotional connection. One
Associated Press reporter regarded that as a motive for the president’s later
public appearances: “Eager to demonstrate not just command but
compassion, Obama invited relatives of the 11 oil workers killed in the
disaster to meet him at the White House, where he cuddled the newborn baby
of one of those lost” (Benac 2010, para. 18).
The White House did take some concrete measures early on, including
banning the drilling of new wells and all deep water drilling off American
coasts. And two months after the spill began, BP started paying out claims to
those people and businesses who had been harmed financially by this
disaster. But by October 12, roughly three months after the leak was stopped,
the Obama administration lifted its moratorium on offshore drilling (Baker
and Broder 2010). Two years after that, BP pleaded guilty to fourteen federal
criminal charges, including manslaughter and lying to Congress, and agreed
to pay $4.5 billion as a settlement. “The terms were generally considered
favorable for BP, which made $25.8 billion in profit the previous year” (S.
Beck 2014, para. 27). That same year, BP agreed to an uncapped class action
settlement that could cost it billions more. Since then, however, after paying
almost $4 billion in claims, “BP has declared war against plaintiffs [and] their
lawyers” by quite abruptly challenging the terms and conditions of the
settlement (S. Beck 2014, para. 5). But whether or not these legal maneuvers
are successful, the long-term effects of the spill on the health of the company
are clearly less dire than its effects on the health of the Gulf. As one Forbes
writer put it:

Realistically, the answer to the question of whether or not BP’s


public image has recovered is simply “it really doesn’t matter.” As
long as BP sells oil in colossal quantities, it will continue to attract
investment. Their share price may not have returned to pre-spill
levels, but the company remains an economic behemoth and a major
player in a commodity the world hopelessly depends on. The shape
of the company’s image among the general populace is largely
irrelevant, because investors know mental images of Deepwater
Horizon will not cause the end consumer in need of fuel to drive
past a BP station on principle. And BP knows it too. (Olenski 2014,
para. 11)

In these ways, the case of the 2010 Gulf of Mexico oil spill was a fitting
end to this decade of American disaster. Like the September 11 attacks,
Hurricane Katrina, the Virginia Tech shootings, and the financial crisis, it
became a kind of “public drama” (Monahan 2010) or “disaster marathon”
(Blondheim and Liebes 2002) to which high numbers of media viewers
remained attuned. Although the initial sinking of the oil rig was not viewed in
real time as September 11 or Hurricane Katrina had been, the obsession with
the underwater footage and the ability to follow live as BP attempted to cap
the well does speak to the same desire for authentic and intimate ways to
experience disasters. The variety of souvenirs and forms of charitable giving
that the spill generated also speak to a trickling down of public concern into
more mundane consumer behaviors. Perhaps most importantly, the fact that
the broader causes of the disaster have not been systematically addressed—as
our dependence on fossil fuels extracted by intractable and poorly regulated
oil companies has continued unabated—means that like those disasters earlier
in the decade, the Deepwater Horizon spill has also not made the country
more secure in the long term.
It is not surprising, then, that Americans throughout the decade have
appeared both transfixed by and uneasy with their mass-mediated experiences
of these disasters. The September 11 attacks and Hurricane Katrina were the
two most closely watched stories of the decade, with 78 percent and 73
percent of Americans, respectively, having watched these stories very
closely. The condition of the U.S. economy in September 2008 was the fourth
most watched story, while the Gulf oil spill was twelfth (Pew Research
Center for the People and the Press 2010c). And yet a month after 9/11, 32
percent of the public thought there was too much coverage of the attacks
(Pew Research Center for the People and the Press 2001b). Similarly, 21
percent of Americans thought there was too much coverage of Hurricane
Katrina (Pew Research Center for the People and the Press 2005). For some
disasters, such as the Virginia Tech shootings, the number of Americans
objecting to the amount of news coverage has reached as high as 50 percent
(Pew Research Center for the People and the Press 2007).
Many academics have used this public discomfort about the amount of
disaster news coverage as a jumping-off point to critique the presumed
effects of such an abundance of disaster news and imagery. On the one hand,
there is a sense that such media inflame the public’s taste for “disaster
pornography” such that “viewers … do not need to comprehend the causes
and implications of disaster because they become addicted to a perverted
form of reality television” (Bates and Ahmed 2007, 197–198). At the same
time, scholars argue that this intense attachment creates a waning of affect, an
“empty empathy” that occurs when news organizations present their audience
“with a daily barrage of images that are merely fragments of a large, complex
situation” (Kaplan 2005, 93). As Susan Moeller (1999, 9) confusingly put it,
“How they typically cover crises helps us to feel overstimulated and bored all
at once.”
Such claims invite scrutiny. Disasters almost by definition generate a
surfeit of highly emotional stories and powerful images. How else would
news organizations cover such stories if not emotionally and with striking
imagery? Should they ignore these central features of many catastrophes?
Critics such as Joan and Arthur Kleinman admit that “the absent image is also
a form of political appropriation; public silence is perhaps more terrifying
than being overwhelmed by public images of atrocity” (Kleinman and
Kleinman 1996, 17). Yet they go on to advocate the simultaneously vague
and grandiose position that “we must first make sure that the biases of
commercial emphasis on profit-making, the partisan agendas of political
ideologies, and the narrow technical interests that serve primarily
professional groups are understood and their influence controlled” (Kleinman
and Kleinman 1996, 18). But what would such media look like? How would
it attend to the public’s concern for the suffering of others? How would it
“creat[e] public memory that could motivate efforts towards social justice”
(Bates and Ahmed 2007, 197)? How would it actually help the victims of
disaster in ways that our current media do not? Critics are typically
ambiguous on these matters, and history offers few examples to guide us.
Of course, this supposed media-induced waning of concern for the
suffering of others has not been born out when measured by the amount of
disaster-related charitable giving. Americans donated more than $2.8 billion
after the September 11 attacks and increased that to $5.3 billion after
Hurricane Katrina. This generosity was not focused only domestically—in
2004, Americans gave $1.93 billion to relief efforts for the Southeast Asian
tsunami, and by the decade’s end, even in the midst of a crushing recession,
Americans still gave $1.45 billion in response to the Haiti earthquake (Aaron
Smith 2011). The Ethiopia famine of 1984–1985 is often regarded as the
moment in which “instead of charitable giving being seen as worthy and a
little dull, it became hip and cool” (Franks 2013, para. 6). But according to
the American Red Cross, charitable giving for the disasters of this past
decade far outstrips American donations for crises in the 1980s such as the
Ethiopian famine or the Mexico City earthquake (Kasindorf 2005). Although
such donations are not the only way one might measure Americans’ concern
for the suffering of others, in the face of such charitable outpourings it seems
hard to argue that our increased attention to disasters results in mere boredom
or empty sentiment. In the aftermath of catastrophe, Americans clearly want
to help. What other avenues are open to us?
True, in the age of the Internet it has never been easier to make a
donation or buy a T-shirt whose proceeds go to charity—such gestures do not
require much commitment. But for most of us, this sort of consumption
remains the most readily available way to publicly express our feelings about
tragedies, disasters, and the suffering of others. Seen in that light, the
consumption of disaster is really an expression of powerlessness. Following a
disaster through the maelstrom of cable television news cycles, buying a
souvenir, attending a concert, texting a donation, watching a documentary, or
visiting a disaster site: all of these behaviors simulate a kind of control over
catastrophes that in reality eludes us. In this way, the empathic ideal behind
many forms of disaster consumption reveals itself as an illusion of agency: it
makes us feel better about our actual helplessness in the face of mass tragedy,
at least until the next disaster comes along to throw that sense of agency once
again into doubt. This marks the authenticity of disasters as particularly
paradoxical. Certainly disasters are deeply real, with terrible consequences
that can be felt by victims, seen by spectators, and measured by reporters,
scientists, and government officials. But disasters are also captured,
packaged, and sold to their distant spectators in ways that encourage
empathetic hedonism first and foremost. Imagining another’s pain is a
powerful form of engagement but, as an act of imagination, it is still
ultimately an illusory one.
One of the particular illusions encouraged by disaster consumption is the
notion that individual consumption choices can effectively ensure one’s
safety from future risks and threats. The “consumerism of security” (Sturken
2007) that became so visible after the attacks of September 11 allowed
consumers to attempt to take their protection into their own hands. Such
security-minded consumption often proves wrong-headed, however, and may
actually exacerbate risks. Moreover, by its very nature this sort of
retrospective consumption of security is doomed to fail, since it is geared
toward disaster scenarios that have already happened and are therefore very
unlikely to be repeated. That is the case with the various types of executive
parachutes that appeared on the market after 9/11, which are not proven to
work and may deter people trapped in skyscrapers from using fireproof
staircases or other, more realistic escape methods (ABC News n.d.). In a
different context, fear of environmental pollution and unsafe tap water have
spurred spectacular growth in the sale of bottled water over the past quarter
century, which ultimately has produced massive amounts of plastic waste that
is highly detrimental to the environment (Szasz 2007). Americans also
frequently keep guns in their homes as a form of protection, despite the fact
that those with firearms in the home are at much greater risk of homicide or
other violent death (Cummings et al. 1997; Kellerman et al. 1993). Similarly,
the ease with which Americans can purchase firearms in the name of self-
defense makes mass shootings such as the massacre at Virginia Tech more
likely (Kellner 2008). And if we think of the wars in Iraq and Afghanistan as
a kind of product that was marketed and ultimately sold to the American
public after 9/11 on the grounds that it would make us safer (see T. Miller
2007), it seems clear that this consumption of security has also backfired, as
these conflicts have spurred anti-American rage across the globe, inspired
more recent acts of terrorism, and generally destabilized the entire Middle
East. Thus, attempting to consume one’s way to safety and security can have
a variety of disastrous consequences.
At the same time, American society continues to showcase a profound
lack of risk aversion among its elite decision makers, at least in part because
ignorance of risks is so profitable for those in positions of power. As former
New York Governor Eliot Spitzer put it:

It’s a depressingly familiar story: A company hides enormous risk


in its effort to get outsize returns, hoping that if and when the risk
metastasizes, somebody else will have to pick up the tab. The name
of the company may change, the sector of the economy may differ,
but the basic narrative is as predictable as a Hollywood sequel. Our
two recent cataclysms—the financial meltdown of the past several
years, and the more recent eco-disaster in the Gulf of Mexico—
follow this pattern. (Spitzer 2010, para. 1–2)

Like the giant financial companies whose “too big to fail” status assured
them of government bailouts when the wild profits from their riskiest trading
schemes dried up and their debt quickly turned toxic, BP’s status as the
largest oil producer in the United States (N. Graham 2010) has guaranteed
that it will continue to thrive after the spill, which may not be the case for the
Gulf’s ecosystem or its coastal economy (Elliott 2015).
Nonetheless, understanding the individualistic cultural and political
context in which disaster consumption takes place today makes denunciations
of those who engage in it seem patently unfair. As consumers, we are tasked
with purchasing our own safety and security from risk, despite the
aforementioned ways in which consumer society often generates or
exacerbates those same risks. This is necessarily an antisocial proposition,
because securing only oneself necessarily means shifting the threat to others.
Since consuming one’s own security has emerged as the norm, it has become
an increasingly large gamble to throw in one’s lot with that of one’s
neighbors and community. Zygmunt Bauman has explained the results of this
individualistic ideology: “Whatever happens to an individual can be
retrospectively interpreted as further confirmation of their sole and
inalienable responsibility for their individual plight—and for adversities as
much as successes” (Bauman 2008, 22). This individualism often intersects
with older forms of discrimination based on class and race but provides a new
way to blame the victims of inequality and structural racism. Such was
certainly the case during Hurricane Katrina, when the city’s evacuation plan,
based on access to private transportation, predictably failed the many low-
income residents who did not own automobiles (Bartling 2006). Although
decades of uneven development and terrible urban planning left many poor,
minority residents stuck in the city as the hurricane approached, those
residents were demonized in the storm’s aftermath for not driving out of the
city and then for “looting” much needed supplies from flooded or abandoned
stores.
Individuals are also urged today to perform and maintain an attractive,
authentic, and even saleable form of selfhood in the face of increasingly
unstable family situations and labor markets (Bauman 2007). Self-help
books, management guides, and psychotherapists frequently emphasize
multi-perspectivalism and empathy (Illouz 2008). Mass culture ultimately
translates America’s “grand meritocratic promise” into a matter of “self-
invention via commodities” (T. Miller 2008, 2). These trends converge
during catastrophes, when news media and popular culture make the
suffering of others a common public topic of discussion that requires our
attention and our demonstrations of empathy, lest we appear insensitive to
families, friends, employers, or potential love interests. As the empathetic
gaze becomes embedded in more forms of media and the norms associated
with empathic hedonism ascend, the lack of a strong, personal, emotional
response to any mass-mediated American tragedy is increasingly likely to
reflect poorly on individual consumers, just as it does for corporate
spokespeople and government officials.
When all is said and done, then, the atomistic properties of consumerism
make it a poor answer to disaster. Empathy may reflect well on us as
individuals, but can it inspire sustained social and political changes or just
disparate acts of charitable giving? While empathetically motivated donations
of money or time certainly help, they still suffer from a reactive, backward-
looking perspective that ensures the next disaster is as likely as ever. Of
course, consumption choices do not always crowd out other forms of
activism (see Willis and Schor 2012), but it may nonetheless be the case that
progressive, grassroots activism operates in a slower time frame than can
accommodate the immediacy of disasters. For instance, although Virginia
Tech was the center of a national outpouring of emotional and monetary
support after the massacre there, the lack of support for new federal gun
regulation afterward set the stage for subsequent shootings in places such as
Aurora, Colorado, and Newtown, Connecticut. The National Rifle
Association (NRA) has even used these more recent shootings to successfully
advocate for the relaxation of existing gun restrictions, including in some
instances those that keep firearms out of schools (Beauchamp 2013;
Childress 2013). Of course, a complicated politics with a multitude of interest
groups is at work here, but at the very least, the failure of gun control
advocates and the success of the ever-powerful NRA in the wake of high-
profile school shootings have shocked many observers (see Lucas 2014;
O’Keefe and Rucker 2013).
This should remind us that governments, corporations, and lobbyists can
respond to disasters much more effectively than individuals, though often in
only their own, elite interests. As individual consumers concerned with
making our world better and safer, we have limited options. Green
consumerism will be a niche market, or an empty marketing ploy, unless new
laws require many more products to become green and unless regulatory
agencies stringently enforce such laws. Even as mainstream consumers
increasingly seek out ethically produced commodities, those commodities are
subject to corporate “greenwashing” efforts that may merely simulate some
sort of social good (K. Brown 2013; see also King 2006). Similarly, tourism-
based redevelopment strategies in New Orleans that accentuate the city’s
authenticity and distinctiveness have often been “silent about issues of social
justice, equity, and inclusion” (Gotham 2007). Indeed, cities such as New
Orleans will likely be rebuilt only in the interest of developers who plan to
gentrify the most desirable areas and shut out the poorest residents unless the
federal government takes a more proactive role in the process and does so in
ways that take into account the needs of its poor and working-class citizens
(see Green, Kouassi, and Mambo 2013). This is, of course, in direct contrast
to the way the American government actually operates in the current political
moment, dominated by neoliberalism and its related privatization schemes.
Yet until these conditions change, the consumerism of security will resemble
a kind of “political anesthesia” (Szasz 2007, 195) that diminishes one’s sense
of risk and reduces the sense of urgency to make political demands about the
alleviation of potential hazards. And until those conditions change, the
benefits of empathetic spectatorship will manifest primarily for the individual
viewer, not for those suffering others to whom that empathy is directed.
Disasters are a kind of commodity, and the ones we value most are often
the most immediate and sensational. This does not bode well for their
progressive political potential. As we have seen, disasters such as September
11 that are spectacular and novel are easily steered toward disastrous policy
outcomes such as the Patriot Act and the wars in Afghanistan and Iraq.
Disasters that take longer to develop or that lack a sense of novelty and
spectacle may provide a greater opportunity for public debate, as was the case
in the financial crisis and, to an extent, in the Deepwater Horizon spill. The
oil spill did manage to generate some public debate about the disastrous
nature of that particularly cherished American commodity. But even with the
huge opportunity that the spill provided for environmental groups to highlight
the problem of global warming and the high economic and ecological costs of
fossil fuels, public opinion polls taken after the spill found little change in the
percentage of people worried about climate change (Fahrenthold and Eilperin
2010). One poll about American energy policy taken three months after the
spill showed slightly more support for “keeping energy prices low” than for
“protecting the environment from the effects of energy development and
use,” though both options were heavily supported (Pew Research Center for
the People and the Press 2010a). These results seem to suggest that grassroots
progressive activists cannot always capitalize on disasters the way that
governments, entrepreneurs, and corporations can.
History has shown, going back at least as far as the Lisbon earthquake of
1755, that elites frequently use disasters to consolidate power and eliminate
dissent. But fifty years of disaster sociology have also highlighted the
innumerable ways in which residents of disaster-stricken communities act
with kindness and compassion toward one another, even under the most
harrowing of conditions. As Rebecca Solnit (2009, 306) put it, “The joy in
disaster comes, when it comes, from that purposefulness, the immersion in
service and survival, and from an affection that is not private and personal
but civic: the love of strangers for each other, of a citizen for his or her city,
of belonging to a greater whole, of doing the work that matters. These loves
remain largely dormant and unacknowledged in contemporary postindustrial
society: this is the way in which everyday life is a disaster.”
Perhaps, then, what distant consumers express when they sit glued to the
television watching a disaster replayed over and over, when they buy T-shirts
or souvenirs, when they mail teddy bears to a memorial, or when they tour a
disaster site is a deep, maybe subconscious, longing for those age-old forms
of community and real human compassion that emerge in a place when
disaster has struck. It is a longing in some ways so alien to the world we
currently live in that it requires catastrophe to call it forth, even in our
imaginations. Nevertheless, the actions of unadulterated goodwill that
become commonplace in harrowing conditions represent the truly authentic
form of humanity that all of us, to one degree or another, chase after in
contemporary mass culture every day. And while it is certainly a bit
foolhardy to seek authentic humanity through disaster-related media and
culture, the sheer strength of that desire was evident in the public’s response
to all the disasters, crises, and catastrophes to hit the United States in the first
decade of the twenty-first century. The millions of television viewers who
cried on September 11, or during Hurricane Katrina and the Virginia Tech
shootings, and the thousands upon thousands who volunteered their time,
labor, money, and even their blood, as well as the countless others who
created art, contributed to memorials, or adorned their cars or bodies with
disaster-related paraphernalia—despite the fact that many knew no one who
had been personally affected by any of these disasters—all attest to a desire
for real human community and compassion that is woefully unfulfilled by
American life under normal conditions today. Perhaps that is the true aura of
disaster.
In the end, the consumption of disaster does not make us unable or
unwilling to engage with disasters on a communal level or toward
progressive political ends. It makes us feel as if we already have, simply by
consuming. It is ultimately less a form of political anesthesia than a
simulation of politics, a Potemkin village of communal sentiment that fills
our longing for a more just and humane world with disparate acts of cathartic
consumption. Still, the positive political potential underlying our
spectatorship of others’ suffering—the desire for real forms of connection
and community—remains the most redeeming feature of contemporary mass
culture. Although that desire is frequently warped when various media lenses
refract it, diffuse it, or reframe it to fit a political agenda, its overwhelming
strength should nonetheless serve notice that people want a different world
from the one in which we currently live, with a different way to understand
and respond to disasters. They want a world where risk is not leveraged for
profit or political gain but sensibly planned for with the needs of all
socioeconomic groups in mind. They want a world where preemptive
strategies are used to anticipate the real threats posed by global climate
change and global inequality rather than to invent fears of ethnic others and
justify unnecessary wars. They want a world where people can come together
not simply as a market, but as a public, to exert real agency over the policies
made in the name of their safety and security. And when disaster does strike,
they want a world where the goodwill and compassion shown by their
neighbors, by strangers in their communities, and even by distant spectators
and consumers will be matched by their own government. Although this
vision of the world is utopian, it is not unreasonable, and if contemporary
American culture is ever to give us more than just an illusion of safety, or
authenticity, or empathy, then it is this vision that we must advocate each
day, not just when disaster strikes.
We must, then, abandon the notion that any particular practice of
spectatorship is the right way to view the suffering of others. A world where
we are less vulnerable to disasters will not suddenly appear if the media
become more sensitive and humane. A world where risks are more evenly
distributed and more equitably minimized for all people will not emerge
because of disaster tourism or because of some popular backlash against
disaster tourism. Others will not suffer less in the future because we turned
our televisions, computers, or mobile devices either off or on or because we
viewed some kinds of images and not others. The disasters of the past decade
favored elites in almost every policy outcome in ways that have not
necessarily made us safer, and all despite so much genuine fear, empathy, and
concern from so many diverse viewers and consumers. New strategies of
consumption and new media technologies are unlikely to change this. We
must conclude, instead, that disasters do not favor progressive activists and
populist politics. Social justice is, after all, a long, slow struggle. It is not
typically spectacular. It does not often keep television viewers rapt with
attention for weeks on end. But unlike many of the highly emotional yet
largely symbolic forms of post-disaster spectatorship described in this book,
it might just work. After all, much social science research attests to the
greater mental health and physical security that accrue in more egalitarian
societies (see Ward and Shively 2011; Wilkinson 1996; Wilkinson and
Pickett 2009). The creation of a more just and equal society is, then, a way to
make us safer and more secure in the face of a whole host of threats—from
terrorism and natural disasters to gun violence, financial crises, and climate
change. So it is to the everyday quest for a more egalitarian society that those
of us who lived through this decade of disaster, and anyone else who wants to
forestall such catastrophes in the future, ought to devote our energy,
attention, and emotion.
REFERENCES

ABC News. N.d. “Parachutes for High-Rise Safety?” Good Morning America. Available at
http://abcnews.go.com/GMA/story?id=126613&page=1.
Achenbach, Joel, and Steven Mufson. 2010. “‘Static Kill’ of Oil Well Deemed a Success.” Washington
Post, August 5. Available at http://www.washingtonpost.com/wp-
dyn/content/article/2010/08/04/AR2010080403588.html?sid=ST2010080406374&sub=AR.
Akers, Joshua M. 2012. “Separate and Unequal: The Consumption of Public Education in Post-Katrina
New Orleans.” International Journal of Urban and Regional Research 36 (1): 29–48.
Almås, Reidar. 1999. “Food Trust, Ethics and Safety in Risk Society.” Sociological Research Online 4
(3). Available at http://www.socresonline.org.uk/4/3/almas.html.
Altheide, David L. 1996. Qualitative Media Analysis. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
———. 2002. Creating Fear: News and the Construction of Crisis. New York: Aldine de Gruyter.
———. 2006. “Terrorism and the Politics of Fear.” Cultural Studies, Critical Methodologies 6 (4):
415–439.
Andrejevic, Mark. 2004. Reality TV: The Work of Being Watched. Lanham, MD: Rowman and
Littlefield.
Aradau, Claudia, and Rens Van Munster. 2007. “Governing Terrorism through Risk: Taking
Precautions, (Un)Knowing the Future.” European Journal of International Relations 13 (1): 89–
115.
Araújo, Ana Cristina. 2006. “The Lisbon Earthquake of 1755: Public Distress and Political
Propaganda.” E-Journal of Portuguese History 4 (1): 1–11.
Ariès, Philippe. 1974. Western Attitudes toward Death: From the Middle Ages to the Present. Trans.
Patricia M. Ranum. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Associated Press. 2005. “CIA’s Final Report: No WMD Found in Iraq.” April 25. Available at
http://www.nbcnews.com/id/7634313/ns/world_news-mideast_n_africa/t/cias-final-report-no-
wmd-found-iraq.
———. 2010. “Gulf Oil Spill Is Biggest Environmental Disaster, EPA Official Says.” NOLA.com,
May 30. Available at http://www.nola.com/news/gulf-oil-
spill/index.ssf/2010/05/gulf_oil_spill_is_biggest_envi.html.
Avenanti, Alessio, Angela Sirigu, and Salvatore M. Aglioti. 2010. “Racial Bias Reduces Empathic
Sensorimotor Resonance with Other-Race Pain.” Current Biology 20 (11): 1018–1022.
Baker, Peter, and John M. Broder. 2010. “White House Lifts Ban on Deepwater Drilling.” New York
Times, October 12. Available at http://www.nytimes.com/2010/10/13/us/13drill.html?
pagewanted=all&_r=0.
Banet-Weiser, Sarah. 2012. Authentic(TM): The Politics of Ambivalence in a Brand Culture. New
York: New York University Press.
Barnouw, Eric. 1966. A Tower in Babel: A History of Broadcasting in the United States, Volume I: To
1933. New York: Oxford University Press.
Barofsky, Neil M. 2011. “Where the Bailout Went Wrong.” New York Times, March 29. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2011/03/30/opinion/30barofsky.html.
Bartling, Hugh. 2006. “Suburbia, Mobility, and Urban Calamities.” Space and Culture 9 (1): 60–62.
Bates, Benjamin R., and Rukhsana Ahmed. 2007. “Disaster Pornography: Hurricane Katrina,
Voyeurism, and the Television Viewer.” In Through the Eye of Katrina: Social Justice in the
United States, ed. Richelle S. Swan and Kristin A. Bates, 187–202. Durham, NC: Carolina
Academic Press.
Baudrillard, Jean. 1994. Simulation and Simulacra. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.
Bauman, Zygmunt. 2007. Consuming Life. Malden, MA: Polity.
———. 2008. “Happiness in a Society of Individuals.” Soundings 38:19–28.
BBC News. 2006. “9/11 Memorial Plans Scaled Down.” June 21. Available at
http://newsvote.bbc.co.uk/2/hi/americas/5101048.stm.
Bealer, Paula. 2007. “Short Stories: Empathy.” Helium, October 26. Available at
http://www.helium.com/items/666434-short-stories-empathy.
Beauchamp, Zack. 2013. “The First Federal Gun Laws to Pass since Newtown Are All NRA-
Approved.” ThinkProgress, March 22. Available at
http://thinkprogress.org/justice/2013/03/22/1760131/the-first-federal-gun-laws-to-pass-since-
newtown-are-all-nra-approved.
Beck, Susan. 2014. “How BP Decided to Fight the Deepwater Settlement.” American Lawyer, March 5.
Available at http://www.americanlawyer.com/id=1202643826256/How-BP-Decided-to-Fight-the-
Deepwater-Settlement.
Beck, Ulrich. 1992. Risk Society: Towards a New Modernity. Trans. Mark Ritter. Thousand Oaks, CA:
Sage.
———. 2002. “The Silence of Words and Political Dynamics in the World Risk Society.” Logos 1 (4):
1–18.
Becker, Ernest. 1973. The Denial of Death. New York: Free Press.
Beer, David, and Roger Burrows. 2010. “Consumption, Prosumption and Participatory Web Cultures:
An Introduction.” Journal of Consumer Culture 10 (3): 3–12.
Begley, Sharon. 2010. “Boycott BP? Don’t Bother.” Newsweek, June 7. Available at
http://www.newsweek.com/2010/06/07/boycott-bp.html.
Bellah, Robert N., Richard Madsen, William M. Sullivan, Ann Swidler, and Steven M. Tipton. 1985.
Habits of the Heart: Individualism and Commitment in American Life. New York: Perennial
Library.
Benac, Nancy. 2010. “Oil Spill Frustrates President Obama’s Effort to Put Focus on Other Issues:
Analysis.” Associated Press, June 20.
Benjamin, Walter. 1969. Illuminations: Essays and Reflections. Trans. Harry Zohn. New York:
Schocken.
———. 1999. Selected Writings, Volume 2: 1927–1934. Trans. Rodney Livingstone. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press.
Bennett, W. Lance, and Murray Edelman. 1985. “Toward a New Political Narrative.” Journal of
Communication 35 (4): 156–171.
Berger, John. 1991. About Looking. New York: Vintage International.
Berns, Nancy. 2011. Closure: The Rush to End Grief and What It Costs Us. Philadelphia: Temple
University Press.
Best, Jacqueline. 2008. “Ambiguity, Uncertainty, and Risk: Rethinking Indeterminacy.” International
Political Sociology 2 (4): 355–374.
Bickford, Susan. 2011. “Emotion Talk and Political Judgment.” Journal of Politics 37 (4): 1025–1037.
Biello, David. 2011. “How Did the BP Oil Spill Affect Gulf Coast Wildlife?” Scientific American,
April 20. Available at http://www.scientificamerican.com/article/how-did-bp-oil-spill-affect-gulf-
of-mexico-wildlife-and-ecosystems.
Bligh, M. C., J. C. Kohles, and J. R. Meindl. 2004. “Charting the Language of Leadership: A
Methodological Investigation of President Bush and the Crisis of 9/11.” Journal of Applied
Psychology 89 (3): 562–574.
Blondheim, Menahem, and Tamar Liebes. 2002. “Live Television’s Disaster Marathon of September
11 and Its Subversive Potential.” Prometheus 20 (3): 271–276.
———. 2003. “From Disaster Marathon to Media Event: Live Television’s Performance on September
11, 2001, and September 11, 2002.” Crisis Communications: Lessons from September 11, ed. A.
Michael Noll, 185–197. Lanham, MD: Rowman and Littlefield.
Bloom, Paul. 2013. “The Baby in the Well: The Case against Empathy.” New Yorker, May 20.
Available at http://www.newyorker.com/magazine/2013/05/20/the-baby-in-the-well.
Bluestein, Greg, and Harry R. Weber. 2010. “Static Kill Plugs Gulf Oil Spill Leak, but Much Work
Remains.” Christian Science Monitor, August 4. Available at http://www.csmonitor.com/From-
the-news-wires/2010/0804/Static-kill-plugs-Gulf-oil-spill-leak-but-much-work-remains.
Bodnar, John. 1992. Remaking America: Public Memory, Commemoration, and Patriotism in the
Twentieth Century. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Bohrer, Becky. 2007. “New Orleans Recovery Plan Calls for a Katrina Memorial on a ‘Homeric’
Scale.” USA Today, May 28. Available at http://www.usatoday.com/weather/news/2007-05-25-
katrina-memorial_N.htm.
Boltanski, Luc. 1999. Distant Suffering: Morality, Media and Politics. New York: Cambridge
University Press.
Boorstin, Daniel J. 1987. The Image: A Guide to Pseudo-Events in America. New York: Macmillan.
Botterill, Jacqueline. 2007. “Cowboys, Outlaws and Artists: The Rhetoric of Authenticity and
Contemporary Jeans and Sneaker Advertisements.” Journal of Consumer Culture 7 (1): 105–125.
Bouson, J. Brooks. 1989. The Empathetic Reader: A Study of the Narcissistic Character and the Drama
of the Self. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
Bowman, Rex. 2007. “Sales of Tech Goods Hit Record.” Virginia Tech: Reflection and Renewal,
October 13. Available at http://media.mgnetwork.com/imd/VTShooting/article159.htm.
Boyle, Kirk, and Daniel Mrozowski. 2013. “Introduction: Creative Documentation of Creative
Destruction.” In The Great Recession in Fiction, Film, and Television: Twenty-First-Century Bust
Culture, ed. Kirk Boyle and Daniel Mrozowski, ix–xxvi. New York: Lexington.
Broderick, Mick, and Mark Gibson. 2005. “Mourning, Monomyth, and Memorabilia: Consumer Logics
of Collecting 9/11.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a National Tragedy Became a Commodity, ed.
Dana Heller, 200–220. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Brown, Janelle. 2001. “Across the Boards.” Yahoo! Internet Life, November. Available at
https://www.craigslist.org/about/press/across?lang=en&cc=us.
Brown, Keith R. 2013. Buying into Fair Trade: Culture, Morality, and Consumption. New York: New
York University Press.
Brown, Nik, and Mike Michael. 2002. “From Authority to Authenticity: The Changing Governance of
Biotechnology.” Health, Risk, and Society 4 (3): 259–272.
Brown, Richard Harvey, and Beth Davis-Brown. 1998. “The Making of Memory: The Politics of
Archives, Libraries and Museums in the Construction of National Consciousness.” History of the
Human Sciences 11 (4): 17–32.
Brulle, Robert J. 2014. “Institutionalizing Delay: Foundation Funding and the Creation of U.S. Climate
Change Counter-Organizations.” Climatic Change 122:681–694.
Campbell, Colin. 1987. The Romantic Ethic and the Spirit of Modern Consumerism. Oxford: Basil
Blackwell.
Campbell, W. Joseph. 2001. Yellow Journalism: Puncturing the Myths, Defining the Legacies.
Westport, CT: Praeger.
Cantril, Hadley. 1940. The Invasion from Mars: A Study in the Psychology of Panic. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Carter, Bill, and Jim Rutenberg. 2001. “After the Attacks: Television; Viewers again Return to
Traditional Networks.” New York Times, September 15. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2001/09/15/us/after-the-attacks-television-viewers-again-return-to-
traditional-networks.html.
Charmaz, Kathy. 1999. “Stories of Suffering: Subjective Tales and Research Narratives.” Qualitative
Health Research 9 (3): 362–382.
Chayko, Mary. 2008. Portable Communities: The Social Dynamics of Online and Mobile
Connectedness. Albany: State University of New York Press.
Chermak, Steven, Frankie Y. Bailey, and Michelle Brown, eds. 2003. Media Representations of
September 11. Westport, CT: Praeger.
Childress, Sarah. 2013. “How the Gun-Rights Lobby Won after Newtown.” PBS Frontline, December
10. Available at http://www.pbs.org/wgbh/pages/frontline/social-issues/newtown-divided/how-
the-gun-rights-lobby-won-after-newtown.
Chouliaraki, Lilie. 2004. “Watching 11 September: The Politics of Pity.” Discourse and Society 15 (2–
3): 185–198.
Clark, Candace. 1997. Misery and Company: Sympathy in Everyday Life. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
CNN Wire Staff. 2010. “Oil Estimate Raised to 35,000–60,000 Barrels a Day.” CNN.com, June 15.
Available at http://www.cnn.com/2010/US/06/15/oil.spill.disaster/index.html.
Cohen, Jonathan. 2001. “Defining Identification: A Theoretical Look at the Identification of Audiences
with Media Characters.” Mass Communication and Society 4 (3): 245–264.
Cohen, Lizabeth. 2003. A Consumers’ Republic: The Politics of Mass Consumption in Postwar
America. New York: Vintage.
Cohen, Stanley. 1980. Folk Devils and Moral Panics: The Creation of the Mods and the Rockers. New
York: St. Martin’s Press.
Collins, Coleman. 2010. “Coleman Collins Remembers Virginia Tech Tragedy.” True Hoop, April 16.
Available at http://espn.go.com/blog/truehoop/post/_/id/14975/coleman-collins-remembers-the-
tragedy-of-virginia-tech.
“Congress Honors 9/11 First Capitalizers: Recognizes Those Who Rushed to Cash In on Tragedy.”
2011. The Onion, January 18, 1, 7.
Corner, John. 2002. “Performing the Real: Documentary Diversions.” Television and New Media 3 (3):
255–269.
Courson, Mike. 2009. “Raw Humanity, Not Contrived ‘Reality,’ Displayed in Biography Channel’s
Show I Survived.” The Underground (Missouri State University), August 3. Available at
http://www.msu-underground.com/archives/618.
Creamer, Matthew. 2007. “Big Media Blunted by Blacksburg Tragedy.” Advertising Age 78, no. 17
(April 23): 2.
Crossley, Nick. 1998. “Emotion and Communicative Action: Habermas, Linguistic Philosophy and
Existentialism.” In Emotions in Social Life: Critical Themes and Contemporary Issues, ed. Gillian
Bendelow and Simon J. Williams, 17–38. New York: Routledge.
Cummings, Peter, Thomas D. Koepsell, David C. Grossman, James Savarino, and Robert S. Thompson.
1997. “The Association between the Purchase of a Handgun and Homicide or Suicide.” American
Journal of Public Health 87 (6): 974–978.
Dahmen, Nicole Smith, and Andrea Miller. 2012. “Redefining Iconicity: A Five-Year Study of Visual
Themes of Hurricane Katrina.” Visual Communication Quarterly 19 (1): 4–19.
Davies, Douglas. 1999. “The Week of Mourning.” In The Mourning for Diana, ed. Tony Walter, 3–18.
Oxford: Berg.
Davis, Mike. 1999. Ecology of Fear: Los Angeles and the Imagination of Disaster. New York: Vintage.
Dean, Carolyn J. 2004. The Fragility of Empathy after the Holocaust. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University
Press.
Debord, Guy. 2006. The Society of the Spectacle. Oakland, CA: AK Press.
Deppa, Joan. 2007. “Coping with a Killer’s ‘Manifesto.’” Chronicle of Higher Education 53 (36): 64.
Deveau, Vicki, and Gregory Fouts. 2005. “Revenge in U.S. and Canadian News Magazines post-9/11.”
Canadian Journal of Communication 30 (1): 99–109.
Dolan, Mark K., John H. Sonnett, and Kirk A. Johnson. 2009. “Katrina Coverage in Black Newspapers
Critical of Government, Mainstream Media.” Newspaper Research Journal 30 (1): 34–42.
Dovey, Jon. 2000. Freakshow: First Person Media and Factual Television. London: Pluto.
Doyle, Don Harrison. 1990. New Men, New Cities, New South: Atlanta, Nashville, Charleston, Mobile,
1860–1910. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Drabek, Thomas E. 2010. The Human Side of Disaster. Boca Raton, FL: CRC Group.
Dumenco, Simon. 2007. “News Flash: Anything This Graphic Should Never Have a Logo.”
Advertising Age 78, no. 17 (April 23): 34.
Dunn, Robert G. 2008. Identifying Consumption: Subjects and Objects in Consumer Society.
Philadelphia: Temple University Press.
Durham, Frank. 2008. “Media Ritual in Catastrophic Time: The Populist Turn in Television Coverage
of Hurricane Katrina.” Journalism 9 (1): 95–116.
Dute, Jeff. 2014. “Four Years after Deepwater Horizon Exploded, Long-Term Environmental Impacts
from BP Oil Spill Remain Mostly Unknown.” Alabama.com, April 18. Available at
http://blog.al.com/live/2014/04/four_years_after_deepwater_hor.html.
Duttlinger, Carolin. 2008. “Imaginary Encounters: Walter Benjamin and the Aura of Photography.”
Poetics Today 29 (1): 79–101.
Dwyer, Owen J. 2000. “Interpreting the Civil Rights Movement: Place, Memory, and Conflict.”
Professional Geographer 52 (4): 660–671.
Dwyer, Timothy. 2006. “Groundbreaking for 9/11 Memorial at Pentagon Set.” Washington Post, June
6. Available at http://www.washingtonpost.com/wp-
dyn/content/article/2006/06/05/AR2006060501366.html.
Dynes, Russell R. 1998. “Seismic Waves in Intellectual Currents: The Uses of the Lisbon Earthquake
in 18th Century Thought.” Newark: University of Delaware Disaster Research Center.
———. 2000. “The Dialogue between Voltaire and Rousseau on the Lisbon Earthquake: The
Emergence of a Social Science View.” International Journal of Mass Emergencies and Disasters
18 (1): 97–115.
Dyson, Michael Eric. 2006. Come Hell or High Water: Hurricane Katrina and the Color of Disaster.
New York: Basic.
Edy, Jill A., and Patrick C. Meirick. 2007. “Wanted, Dead or Alive: Media Frames, Frame Adoption,
and Support for the War in Afghanistan.” Journal of Communication 57 (1): 119–141.
Eichenwald, Kurt. 2012. “The Deafness before the Storm.” New York Times, September 10. Available
at http://www.nytimes.com/2012/09/11/opinion/the-bush-white-house-was-deaf-to-9-11-
warnings.html.
“Eight Years after Columbine.” 2007. Editorial. New York Times, April 17, A26.
Elliott, Debbie. 2015. “Five Years after BP Oil Spill, Effects Linger and Recovery Is Slow.” NPR,
April 21. Available at http://www.npr.org/2015/04/20/400374744/5-years-after-bp-oil-spill-
effects-linger-and-recovery-is-slow.
Englehardt, Tom. 2007. The End of Victory Culture: Cold War America and the Disillusioning of a
Generation. Rev. ed. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
———. 2012. “What the Afghan War Has in Common with the Vietnam War.” Mother Jones, April
10. Available at http://www.motherjones.com/politics/2012/04/afghanistan-vietnam-war-
quagmire.
Erikson, Kai T. 1976. Everything in Its Path: Destruction of Community in the Buffalo Creek Flood.
New York: Simon and Schuster.
———. 1994. A New Species of Trouble: The Human Experience of Modern Disasters. New York: W.
W. Norton.
Ewen, Elizabeth, and Stuart Ewen. 2006. Typecasting: On the Arts and Sciences of Human Inequality.
New York: Seven Stories.
Ewen, Stuart. 1996. PR! A Social History of Spin. New York: Basic.
“The Faces Emerge.” 2001. Editorial. New York Times, September 16. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2001/09/16/opinion/the-faces-emerge.html.
Fahrenthold, David A., and Juliet Eilperin. 2010. “Historic Oil Spill Fails to Produce Gains for U.S.
Environmentalists.” Washington Post, July 12. Available at http://www.washingtonpost.com/wp-
dyn/content/article/2010/07/11/AR2010071103523.html.
Fairclough, Norman. 1989. Language and Power. New York: Longman.
———. 1995. Critical Discourse Analysis: The Critical Study of Language. New York: Longman.
Featherstone, Mike. 1991. Consumer Culture and Postmodernism. London: Sage.
Feenberg, Andrew. 2009. “Critical Theory of Communication Technology: Introduction to the Special
Section.” Information Society 25 (2): 77–83.
Fine, Gary Alan. 2001. Difficult Reputations: Collective Memories of the Evil, Inept, and
Controversial. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Fisher, Lucy, and Hugh Porter. 2001. “The Online Community Stands Together.” Time Europe 158
(13): 22.
Fong, Christina M., and Erzo F. P. Luttmer. 2007. “What Determines Giving to Hurricane Katrina
Victims? Experiential Evidence on Income, Race, and Fairness.” June 18. Available at
http://repository.cmu.edu/sds/36.
Foote, Kenneth E. 1997. Shadowed Ground: America’s Landscape of Violence and Tragedy. Austin:
University of Texas Press.
Foster, Thomas. 2005. “Cynical Nationalism.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a National Tragedy Became
a Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 254–287. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Fox, James Alan. 2008. “Fueling a Contagion of Campus Bloodshed.” Chronicle of Higher Education
54 (25): A36.
Fox, James Alan, and Jenna Savage. 2009. “Mass Murder Goes to College: An Examination of
Changes on College Campuses following Virginia Tech.” American Behavioral Scientist 52 (10):
1465–1485.
Frangos, Alex. 2006. “An Expensive Memorial Mess on World Trade Center Project.” Wall Street
Journal Online, May 9. Available at http://www.realestatejournal.com/regionalnews/20060509-
frangos.html.
Frank, Thomas. 2005. “Katrina Inspires Record Charity.” USA Today, November 13. Available at
http://usatoday30.usatoday.com/news/nation/2005-11-13-katrina-charity_x.htm.
Franks, Suzanne. 2013. “Why Michael Buerk’s 1984 Famine Report from Ethiopia Entered Media
History.” BBC Academy, October 11. Available at
http://www.bbc.co.uk/blogs/blogcollegeofjournalism/posts/Why-Michael-Buerks-1984-famine-
report-from-Ethiopia-entered-media-history.
Franzosi, Roberto. 1998. “Narrative Analysis—Or Why (and How) Sociologists Should Be Interested
in Narrative.” Annual Review of Sociology 24:517–554.
Freud, Sigmund. (1921) 1959. Group Psychology and the Analysis of the Ego. New York: W. W.
Norton.
Frosh, Paul, and Amit Pinchevski. 2014. “Media Witnessing and the Ripeness of Time.” Cultural
Studies 28 (4): 594–610.
Fry, Katherine. 2006. “Hero for New Orleans, Hero for the Nation.” Space and Culture 9 (1): 83–85.
Furedi, Frank. 2007a. Invitation to Terror: The Expanding Empire of the Unknown. New York:
Continuum.
———. 2007b. “Virginia Tech: A Massacre without Meaning.” Available at
http://www.frankfuredi.com/index.php/site/article/10.
Gammeltoft, Nikolaj. 2009. “Television Beats Internet as Source for Economic News, Pew Says.”
Bloomberg.com, July 15. Available at http://www.bloomberg.com/apps/news?
pid=20601204&sid=aHgnSLvqgftE.
Gans, Herbert J. 1979. Deciding What’s News. New York: Pantheon.
Garfield, Gail. 2007. “Hurricane Katrina: The Making of Unworthy Disaster Victims.” Journal of
African American Studies 10 (4): 55–74.
Gay, Jason. 2009. “Subprime Time: The Down-Market Sitcom Returns to TV.” New York Magazine,
April 12. Available at http://nymag.com/news/intelligencer/56018.
Gee, James Paul. 1999. An Introduction to Discourse Analysis: Theory and Method. New York:
Routledge.
Giddens, Anthony. 1990. The Consequences of Modernity. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.
———. 1991. Modernity and Self-Identity: Self and Society in the Late Modern Age. Stanford, CA:
Stanford University Press.
Gillette, Felix. 2009. “The Crying Game: I’m Sad as Hell and I’m Not Going to Take This Anymore!”
New York Observer, April 7. Available at http://observer.com/2009/04/the-crying-game-im-sad-
as-hell-and-im-not-going-to-take-this-anymore.
Gillis, Justin. 2010. “U.S. Finds Most Oil from Spill Poses Little Risk.” New York Times, August 4.
Available at http://www.nytimes.com/2010/08/04/science/earth/04oil.html.
Gilmore, James H., and B. Joseph Pine. 2007. Authenticity: What Consumers Really Want. Cambridge,
MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Glink, Ilyce. 2012. “Study: Home Modification Program Falls Short.” CBS Money-watch, September
13. Available at http://www.cbsnews.com/news/study-home-modification-program-falls-short.
Gonçalves, Diana. 2012. “From Panic to Mourning: 9/11 and the Need for Spectacle.” In Panic and
Mourning: The Cultural Work of Trauma, ed. Daniela Agostinho, Elisa Antz, and Cátia Ferreira,
233–245. Boston: Walter de Gruyter.
Goode, Luke. 2009. “Social News, Citizen Journalism and Democracy.” New Media and Society 11
(8): 1287–1305.
Goodman, Matthew. 2008. The Sun and the Moon: The Remarkable True Account of Hoaxers,
Showmen, Dueling Journalists, and Lunar Man-Bats in Nineteenth-Century New York. New York:
Basic.
Gotham, Kevin Fox. 2007. “(Re)Branding the Big Easy: Tourism Rebuilding in Post-Katrina New
Orleans.” Urban Affairs Review 42 (56): 823–850.
Goulding, Christina. 2000. “The Commodification of the Past, Postmodern Pastiche, and the Search for
Authentic Experiences at Contemporary Heritage Attractions.” European Journal of Marketing 34
(7): 835–853.
Graham, Leigh. 2012. “Razing Lafitte: Defending Public Housing from a Hostile State.” Journal of the
American Planning Association 78 (4): 466–480.
Graham, Nicholas. 2010. “BP’s Profits Far Outweigh the Cost of Cleaning up the Gulf Oil Spill.”
Huffington Post, May 27. Available at http://www.huffingtonpost.com/2010/05/27/bps-profits-far-
outweigh_n_591992.html.
Granberry, M. 2013. “Following the Zapruder Film.” Video file, Dallas Morning News, May 31.
Available at http://landing.newsinc.com/shared/video.html?
Gravois, John, and Eric Hoover. 2007. “In Media Res.” Chronicle of Higher Education 53, no. 34
(April 27): A64.
Grayson, Kent, and Radan Martinec. 2004. “Consumer Perceptions of Iconicity and Indexicality and
Their Influence on Assessments of Authentic Market Offerings.” Journal of Consumer Research
31:296–312.
Green, Rodney D., Marie Kouassi, and Belinda Mambo. 2013. “Housing, Race, and Recovery from
Hurricane Katrina.” Review of Black Political Economy 40 (2): 145–163.
Greenson, Ralph R. 1960. “Empathy and Its Vicissitudes.” International Journal of Psychoanalysis
40:418–424.
Grimshaw, Allen. 2001. “Discourse and Sociology: Sociology and Discourse.” In The Handbook of
Discourse Analysis, ed. Deborah Schiffrin, Deborah Tannen, and Heidi E. Hamilton, 750–771.
Malden, MA: Blackwell.
Groom, Debra J. 2012. “Early News Reports Tell Different Titanic Tale.” Post-Standard, April 15.
Available at
http://www.syracuse.com/news/index.ssf/2012/04/early_news_reports_tell_differ.html.
Gross, Daniel. 2010. “Home Equity: How the Gulf Crisis made BP British Again.” Slate, June 19.
Available at http://www.slate.com/toolbar.aspx?action=print&id=2257377.
Grove-White, Robin. 1996. “Environmental Knowledge and Public Policy Needs: On Humanising the
Research Agenda.” In Risk, Environment, and Modernity: Towards a New Ecology, ed. Scott
Lash, Bronislaw Szerszynski, and Brian Wynne, 269–286. London: Sage.
Guarino, Mark. 2010. “Gulf Oil Spill Clean-Up: BP’s Hayward Out, Dudley In.” Christian Science
Monitor, June 18. Available at http://www.csmonitor.com/USA/2010/0618/Gulf-oil-spill-cleanup-
BP-s-Hayward-out-Dudley-in.
Gutman, Matt, and Bradley Blackburn. 2010. “Oil Spill: Government and Researchers Face Off over
Estimates.” ABC News, August 17. Available at http://abcnews.go.com/WN/bp-oil-spill-
researchers-80-percent-oil-remains/story?id=11420557.
Gutman, Matt, and Kevin Dolak. 2010. “Oil from the BP Spill Found at Bottom of Gulf.” ABC News,
September 12. Available at http://abcnews.go.com/WN/oil-bp-spill-found-bottom-gulf/story?
id=11618039.
Habermas, Jürgen. 1975. Legitimation Crisis. Boston: Beacon.
———. 2001. The Structural Transformation of the Public Sphere: An Inquiry into a Category of
Bourgeois Society. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Hagan, Joe. 2005. “CNN’s Midlife Midwife.” New York Observer, January 16. Available at
http://www.observer.com/nodes/50342.
Haider-Markel, Donald P., William Delehanty, and Matthew Beverlin. 2007. “Media Framing and
Racial Attitudes in the Aftermath of Katrina.” Policy Studies Journal 35 (4): 587–605.
Halbwachs, Maurice. 1992. On Collective Memory. Ed. L. Coser. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Hall, L. C. 1902. “Telegraph Talk and Talkers: Human Character and Emotions an Old Telegrapher
Reads on the Wire.” McClure’s Magazine, January, 227–231. Available at http://www.telegraph-
office.com/pages/Telegraph_Talk-McClure-1902.html.
Hall, Stuart. 1980. “Encoding/Decoding.” In Culture, Media, Language: Working Papers in Cultural
Studies, 1972–79, ed. Stuart Hall, Dorothy Hobson, Andrew Lowe, and Paul Willis, 117–127.
London: Hutchinson.
Handmer, John, and Paul James. 2007. “Trust Us and Be Scared: The Changing Nature of
Contemporary Risk.” Global Society 21 (1): 119–130.
Haney, C. Allen and Dell Davis. 1999. “America Responds to Diana’s Death: Spontaneous
Memorials.” In The Mourning for Diana, ed. Tony Walter, 227–240. Oxford: Berg.
Hansen, Miriam Bratu. 2008. “Benjamin’s Aura.” Critical Inquiry 34: 336–375.
Hariman, Robert, and John Louis. Lucaites. 2007. No Caption Needed: Iconic Photographs, Public
Culture, and Liberal Democracy. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Harper, Robert S. 1951. Lincoln and the Press. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Harris, Chris. 1999. “Secular Religion and the Public Response to Diana’s Death.” In The Mourning for
Diana, ed. Tony Walter, 97–109. Oxford: Berg.
Hart, Roderick P., Sharon E. Jarvis, and Elvin T. Lim. 2002. “The American People in Crisis: A
Content Analysis.” Political Psychology 23 (3): 417–437.
Hart, William. 2005. “The Country Connection: Country Music, 9/11, and the War on Terrorism.” In
The Selling of 9/11: How a National Tragedy Became a Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 155–173.
New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Hayes, R. Allen. 2004. “Habitat for Humanity: Building Social Capital through Faith Based Service.”
Journal of Urban Affairs 2 (3): 247–269.
Heatley, Holly S. 2007. “‘Commies and Queers’: Narratives that Supported the Lavender Scare.”
Master’s thesis. Arlington: University of Texas.
Hechter, Michael, and Karl-Dieter Opp. 2001. “Introduction.” In Social Norms, ed. Michael Hechter
and Karl-Dieter Opp, xi–xx New York: Russell Sage.
Heller, Dana. 2005. “Introduction.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a National Tragedy Became a
Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 1–26. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Hellström, Tomas. 2008. “Transferability and Naturalistic Generalization: New Generalizability
Concepts for Social Science or Old Wine in New Bottles?” Quality and Quantity 42:321–327.
Herkenhoff, Kyle F., and Lee E. Ohanian. 2011. “Labor Market Dysfunction during the Great
Recession.” National Bureau of Economic Research Working Paper. Available at
http://www.nber.org/papers/w17313.
Herring, Cedric. 2006. “Hurricane Katrina and the Racial Gulf.” Du Bois Review 3 (1): 129–144.
Heyer, Paul. 1995. Titanic Legacy: Disaster as Media Event and Myth. Westport, CT: Praeger.
Hinton, Laura. 1999. The Perverse Gaze of Sympathy: Sadomasochistic Sentiments from Clarissa to
Rescue 911. Albany: State University of New York Press.
Hoffner, Cynthia, and Joanne Cantor. 1991. “Perceiving and Responding to Mass Media Characters.”
In Responding to the Screen: Reception and Reaction Processes, ed. Jennings Bryant and Dolf
Zillman, 63–103. Hillsdale, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
Horkheimer, Max, and Theodor W. Adorno. (1944) 2002. Dialectic of Enlightenment. Trans. J.
Cumming. New York: Continuum.
Hotz, Robert Lee. 2010. “Scientists Try to Gauge Potential Long-Term Environmental Impact.” Wall
Street Journal, June 12. Available at http://online.wsj.com/article/SB10001424052748.
Hucheson, John, David Domke, Andre Billeaudeaux, and Philip Garland. 2004. “U.S. National
Identity, Political Elites, and a Patriotic Press following September 11.” Political Communication
21:27–50.
Hulse, Carl, and David M. Herszenhorn. 2008. “House Rejects Bailout Package, 228–205; Stocks
Plunge.” New York Times, September 29. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2008/09/30/business/30bailout.html.
Hume, David. 1874. A Treatise on Human Nature and Dialogues Concerning Natural Religion. Vol. 2.
London: Longmans, Green.
Huntress, Keith Gibson. 1974. Narratives of Shipwrecks and Disasters, 1586–1860. Iowa City:
University of Iowa Press.
Ickes, William, ed. 1997. Empathic Accuracy. New York: Guilford.
Illouz, Eva. 2003. Oprah Winfrey and the Glamour of Misery: An Essay on Popular Culture. New
York: Columbia University Press.
———. 2008. Saving the Modern Soul: Therapy, Emotions, and the Culture of Self-Help. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Izard, Ralph, and Jay Perkins, eds. 2011. Lessons from Ground Zero: Media Response to Terror. New
Brunswick, NJ: Transaction.
Jameson, Frederic. 2002. “The Dialectics of Disaster.” South Atlantic Quarterly 101 (2): 297–304.
Jeleniewski Seidler, Victor. 2013. Remembering Diana: Cultural Memory and the Reinvention of
Authority. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Jenni, Karen E., and George Loewenstein. 1997. “Explaining the ‘Identifiable Victim Effect.’” Journal
of Risk and Uncertainty 14:235–257.
Jensen, Devon. 2008. “Transferability.” In The Sage Encyclopedia of Qualitative Research Methods,
ed. Lisa M. Given, 886. Vol. 2. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Jesiek, Brent K., and Jeremy Hunsinger. 2008. “The April 16 Archive: Collecting and Preserving the
Memories of the Virginia Tech Tragedy.” In There Is a Gunman on Campus: Tragedy and Terror
at Virginia Tech, ed. Ben Agger and Timothy W. Luke, 29–54. New York: Rowman and
Littlefield.
Johnson, M. Alex. 2007. “Gunman in Massacre Contacted NBC News.” MSNBC.com, April 19.
Available at http://www.msnbc.msn.com/id/18195423/print/1/displaymode/1098.
Johnson, Simon. 2010. “TARP, the Long Goodbye.” New York Times, September 30. Available at
http://economix.blogs.nytimes.com/2010/09/30/tarp-the-long-goodbye/.
Jonsson, Patrik. 2010. “BP ‘Top Kill’ Live Feed Makes Stars out of Disaster Bots.” Christian Science
Monitor, May 29. Available at
http://www.csmonitor.com/layout/set/print/content/view/print/30486.
Jurgenson, Nathan. 2011. “Digital Dualism versus Augmented Reality.” Cyborgology. Available at
http://thesocietypages.org/cyborgology/2011/02/24/digital-dualism-versus-augmented-reality.
Kaplan, E. Ann. 2005. Trauma Culture: The Trauma of Terror and Loss in Media and Literature. New
Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Kasindorf, Martin. 2005. “Poll, Charities Chart American Outpouring.” USA Today, January 6.
Available at http://usatoday30.usatoday.com/news/world/2005-01-06-poll-usat_x.htm.
Katz, Elihu, and Tamar Liebes. 2007. “‘No More Peace!’: How Disaster, Terror and War Have
Upstaged Media Events.” International Journal of Communication 1:157–166.
Kellermann, Arthur L., Frederick P. Rivara, Norman B. Rushforth, Joyce G. Banton, Donald T. Reay,
Jerry T. Francisco, Ana B. Locci, Janice Prodzinski, Bela B. Hackman, and Grant Somes. 1993.
“Gun Ownership as a Risk Factor for Homicide in the Home.” New England Journal of Medicine
329 (15): 1084–1091.
Kellner, Douglas. 2008. Guys and Guns Amok: Domestic Terrorism and School Shootings from the
Oklahoma City Bombing to the Virginia Tech Massacre. Boulder, CO: Paradigm.
Kendrick, T. D. 1956. The Lisbon Earthquake. London: Methuen.
King, Samantha. 2006. Pink Ribbons, Inc.: Breast Cancer and the Politics of Philanthropy.
Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Kitch, Carolyn. 2003. “‘Mourning in America’: Ritual, Redemption, and Recovery in News Narrative
after September 11.” Journalism Studies 4 (2): 213–224.
Klein, Naomi. 2007. The Shock Doctrine: The Rise of Disaster Capitalism. New York: Metropolitan.
———. 2010. “Gulf Oil Spill: A Hole in the World.” Common Dreams, June 20. Available at
http://www.commondreams.org/print/57464.
Kleinman, Arthur, and Joan Kleinman. 1996. “The Appeal of Experience; the Dismay of Images:
Cultural Appropriations of Suffering in Our Times.” Daedalus 125 (1): 1–23.
Klinenberg, Eric. 2002. Heat Wave: A Social Autopsy of Disaster in Chicago. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Kogut, Tehila. 2011. “Someone to Blame: When Identifying a Victim Decreases Helping.” Journal of
Experimental Social Psychology 47:748–755.
Kohut, Heinz. 1984. How Does Analysis Cure? Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Kosicki, Gerald M. 1993. “Problems and Opportunities in Agenda-Setting Research.” Journal of
Communication 43 (2): 100–127.
Kurtz, Howard. 2006. “The Media’s New Orleans Burnout.” Washington Post, May 7. Available at
http://www.washingtonpost.com/wp-dyn/content/article/2006/05/05/AR2006050501744.html.
Landsberg, Alison. 2009. “Memory, Empathy, and the Politics of Identification.” International Journal
of Politics, Culture, and Society 22 (2): 221–229.
Lane, Anthony. 2001. “This Is Not a Movie.” New Yorker, September 24. Available at
http://www.newyorker.com/archive/2001/09/24/010924crci_cinema.
Langer, John. 1992. “Truly Awful News on Television.” In Journalism and Popular Culture, ed. P.
Dahlgren and C. Sparks, 113–129. London: Sage Publications.
Larabee, Ann. 2001. “‘Nothing Ends Here’: Managing the Challenger Disaster.” In American
Disasters, ed. Steven Bielm, 197–221. New York: New York University Press.
Le Bon, Gustave. (1895) 1960. The Crowd: A Study of the Popular Mind. New York: Viking.
Leigh, Thomas W., Cara Peters, and Jeremy Shelton. 2006. “The Consumer Quest for Authenticity:
Multiple Meanings within the MG Subculture.” Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science 34
(4): 481–493.
Leiserowitz, Anthony, Edward Maibach, Connie Roser-Renouf, Geoff Feinberg, Seth Rosenthal, and
Jennifer Marlon. 2014. “Climate Change in the American Mind: Americans’ Global Warming
Beliefs and Attitudes in November, 2013.” Report. Yale University and George Mason
University. Yale Project on Climate Change Communication, New Haven, CT.
Lewis, Lloyd. 1957. The Assassination of Lincoln: History and Myth. Lincoln: University of Nebraska
Press.
Li, Xigen, and Ralph Izard. 2003. “9/11 Attack Coverage Reveals Similarities, Differences.”
Newspaper Research Journal 24 (1): 204–219.
Liebes, Tamar. 1998. “Television’s Disaster Marathons: A Danger for Democratic Processes?” In
Media, Ritual and Identity, ed. Tamar Liebes and James Curran, 71–84. London: Routledge.
Lincoln, Yvonna S., and Egon G. Guba. 1985. Naturalistic Inquiry. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Linenthal, Edward T. 2001. The Unfinished Bombing: Oklahoma City in American Memory. New
York: Oxford University Press.
Lloyd, Robert. 2009. “Walter Cronkite: And That’s the Way It Was.” Los Angeles Times, July 18.
Available at http://www.latimes.com/entertainment/news/la-et-cronkite-appreciation18-
2009jul18,0,5128038.story.
Lockard, Joe. 2005. “Social Fear and the Terrorism Survival Guide.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a
National Tragedy Became a Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 221–232. New York: Palgrave
Macmillan.
Lowrey, Annie. 2011. “Final Arguments: Was TARP a Success or Failure? It Depends on Who You
Think It Was Supposed to Help.” Slate, April 1. Available at
http://www.slate.com/articles/business/moneybox/2011/04/final_arguments.html.
Lubin, David M. 2003. Shooting Kennedy: JFK and the Culture of Images. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Lucas, Fred. 2014. “Dem Senator: Not Passing Gun Control Is a ‘Stunning Failure of Democracy.’”
The Blaze, July 16. Available at http://www.theblaze.com/stories/2014/07/16/dem-senator-not-
passing-gun-control-is-a-stunning-failure-of-democracy.
Lupton, Deborah. 2013. “Risk and Emotion: Towards an Alternative Theoretical Perspective.” Health,
Risk and Society 15 (8): 634–647.
MacCash, Doug. 2007. “New Orleans Katrina Memorial Is Almost Perfect.” NOLA.com, September
14. Available at http://blog.nola.com/dougmaccash/2007/09/new_orleans_katrina_memorial.html.
Mackay, Charles. (1841) 1980. Extraordinary Popular Delusions and the Madness of Crowds. New
York: Harmony.
Man, John. 2002. Gutenberg: How One Man Remade the World with Words. New York: Wiley.
Manovich, Lev. 2001. The Language of New Media. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Martin, Patrick, and Sean Phelan. 2002. “Representing Islam in the Wake of September 11: A
Comparison of US Television and CNN Online Messageboard Discourses.” Prometheus 20 (3):
263–269.
Marwell, Gerald. 1964. “Problems of Operational Definitions of ‘Empathy,’ ‘Identification’ and
Related Concepts.” Journal of Social Psychology 63:87–102.
Mason, Haydn. 1992. Candide: Optimism Demolished. Woodbridge, CT: Twayne.
McCosker, Anthony. 2013. “De-framing Disaster: Affective Encounters with Raw and Autonomous
Media.” Continuum 27 (3): 382–396.
McMurria, John. 2008. “Desperate Citizens and Good Samaritans: Neoliberalism and Makeover
Reality TV.” Television and New Media 9 (4): 305–332.
McRobbie, Angela, and Sarah L. Thornton. 1995. “Rethinking ‘Moral Panic’ for Multi-mediated Social
Worlds.” British Journal of Sociology 46 (4): 559–574.
Mencimer, Stephanie. 2010. “Glenn Beck’s Gold Gurus Charged with Fraud.” Mother Jones, May 19.
Available at http://www.motherjones.com/politics/2010/05/glenn-beck-goldline-weiner.
Mercer, Philip. 1972. Sympathy and Ethics: A Study of the Relationship between Sympathy and
Morality with Special Reference to Hume’s Treatise. Oxford: Clarendon.
Metz, Christian. 1992. “Identification, Mirror.” In Film Theory and Criticism: Introductory Readings,
ed. Gerald Mast, Marshall Cohen, and Leo Braudy, 694–700. 4th ed. New York: Oxford
University Press.
Mian, Atif, and Amir Sufi. 2014. House of Debt: How They (and You) Caused the Great Recession,
and How We Can Prevent It from Happening Again. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Miller, DeMond Shondell. 2006. “Visualizing the Corrosive Community: Looting in the Aftermath of
Hurricane Katrina.” Space and Culture 9 (1): 71–73.
Miller, Toby. 2007. Cultural Citizenship: Cosmopolitanism, Consumerism, and Television in a
Neoliberal Age. Philadelphia: Temple University Press.
———. 2008. Makeover Nation: The United States of Reinvention. Columbus: Ohio State University
Press.
Moeller, S. D. 1999. Compassion Fatigue: How the Media Sell Disease, Famine, War and Death. New
York: Routledge.
———. 2006. “‘Regarding the Pain of Others’: Media, Bias and the Coverage of International
Disasters.” Journal of International Affairs 59 (2): 173–196.
Mogensen, Kirsten. 2008. “Television Journalism during Terror Attacks.” Media, War and Conflict 1
(1): 31–49.
Monahan, Brian A. 2010. Shock of the News: Media Coverage and the Making of 9/11. New York:
New York University Press.
Moore, David W. 2003. “Public Little Concerned about Patriot Act.” Gallup, September 9. Available at
http://www.gallup.com/poll/9205/Public-Little-Concerned-About-Patriot-Act.aspx.
Moser, Barry. 2007. Ashen Sky: The Letters of Pliny the Younger on the Eruption of Vesuvius. Los
Angeles: Getty.
Moskowitz, Eva S. 2001. In Therapy We Trust: America’s Obsession with Self-Fulfillment. Baltimore,
MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Mott, Frank Luther. 1962. American Journalism: A History, 1690–1960. New York: Macmillan.
Mrozowski, Daniel. 2013. “From Hoarders to Pickers: Salvage Aesthetics and Reality Television in the
Great Recession.” In The Great Recession in Fiction, Film, and Television: Twenty-First-Century
Bust Culture, ed. Kirk Boyle and Daniel Mrozowski, 189–210. New York: Lexington.
Mulvey, Laura. 1992. “Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema.” In Film Theory and Criticism:
Introductory Readings, ed. Gerald Mast, Marshall Cohen, and Leo Braudy, 711–722. 4th ed. New
York: Oxford University Press.
Nora, Pierre. 1996. “General Introduction: Between Memory and History.” In Realms of Memory,
Volume 1: Conflicts and Divisions, ed. Pierre Nora, trans. Arthur Goldhammer, 1–20. New York:
Columbia University Press.
Nordhaus, William D. 2006. “The Economics of Hurricanes in the United States.” December 21.
Available at http://nordhaus.econ.yale.edu/hurr_122106a.pdf.
Nunberg, Geoffrey. 2001. “Since Sept. 11, We’re Watching Our Words.” Los Angeles Times,
November 4. Available at http://articles.latimes.com/2001/nov/04/opinion/op-65510.
Nuttall, A. D. 1996. Why Does Tragedy Give Pleasure? Oxford: Oxford University Press.
O’Hehir, Andrew. 2008. “Heroes of Katrina, Ghost of ‘Gonzo.’” Salon.com, January 21. Available at
http://www.salon.com/ent/movies/btm/2008/01/21/trouble.
O’Keefe, Ed, and Philip Rucker. 2013. “Gun Control Overhaul Is Defeated in Senate.” Washington
Post, April 17. Available at http://www.washingtonpost.com/politics/gun-control-overhaul-is-
defeated-in-senate/2013/04/17/57eb028a-a77c-11e2-b029-8fb7e977ef71_story.html.
Olenski, Steve. 2014. “Nearly Four Years after Deepwater Horizon, Has BP’s Brand Image
Recovered?” Forbes, January 24. Available at
http://www.forbes.com/sites/steveolenski/2014/01/24/nearly-four-years-after-deepwater-horizon-
has-bps-brand-image-recovered.
Olick, Jeffrey K. 1999. “Collective Memory: The Two Cultures.” Sociological Theory 17 (3): 333–348.
Park, Ahran. 2008. “The Right to Know about Violent Images? The Virginia Tech Killer’s Gun Points
at the Viewer.” Paper presented at the annual meeting of the International Communication
Association, Montreal, May 22.
Park, Michael. Y. 2006. “‘Disaster Tourists’ Flock to Lower Ninth Ward.” FoxNews.com, March 8.
Available at http://www.foxnews.com/story/0,2933,187242,00.html.
Patterson, Troy. 2009. “Save It: Irritating New Budget-Conscious Lifestyle Shows.” Slate, May 7.
Available at http://www.slate.com/id/2217907.
Pellegrino, Charles R. 2004. Ghosts of Vesuvius: A New Look at the Last Days of Pompeii, How
Towers Fall, and Other Strange Connections. New York: William Morrow.
Peters, Jeremy W. 2010. “Efforts to Limit the Flow of Spill News.” New York Times, June 9. Available
at http://www.nytimes.com/2010/06/10/us/10access.html?_r=1.
Peters, John Durham. 1999. Speaking into the Air: A History of the Idea of Communication. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
———. 2001. “Witnessing.” Media, Culture, and Society 23:707–723.
Peters, Michael A. 2012. “In a Risk Society, Is Consumption Our Only Tool to Influence the World?”
Truthout, July 29. Available at http://truth-out.org/news/item/10531-in-a-risk-society-is-
consumption-our-only-tool-to-influence-our-world.
Petersen, Jennifer. 2011. Murder, the Media, and the Politics of Public Feelings: Remembering
Matthew Shepard and James Byrd Jr. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Pew Research Center for the People and the Press. 2001a. “American Psyche Reeling from Terrorist
Attacks.” September 19. Available at http://www.people-press.org/2001/09/19/american-psyche-
reeling-from-terror-attacks.
———. 2001b. “Americans Open to Dissenting Views on the War on Terrorism.” October 4. Available
at http://www.people-press.org/2001/10/04/americans-open-to-dissenting-views-on-the-war-on-
terrorism.
———. 2001c. “But Guarded Confidence in Military Success: Military Action a Higher Priority than
Homeland Defense.” September 27. Available at http://www.people-press.org/files/legacy-
pdf/2.pdf.
———. 2001d. “Public Remains Steady in Face of Anthrax Scare.” October 15. Available at
http://www.people-press.org/2001/10/15/punlic-remains-steady-in-face-of-anthrax-scare.
———. 2003. “Two Years Later, the Fear Lingers.” September 4. Available at http://www.people-
press.org/2003/09/04/two-years-later-the-fear-lingers.
———. 2005. “Two-in-Three Critical of Bush’s Relief Efforts.” September 8. Available at
http://www.people-press.org/2005/09/08/two-in-three-critical-of-bushs-relief-efforts.
———. 2007. “Widespread Interest in Virginia Tech Shootings. But Public Paid Closer Attention to
Columbine.” April 25. Available at http://people-press.org/report/322/widespread-interest-in-
virginia-tech-shootings.
———. 2008a. “Economic Problems, Especially in Detroit, Absorb Public’s Attention.” November 20.
Available at http://www.people-press.org/2008/11/20/economic-problems-especially-in-detroit-
absorb-publics-attention.
———. 2008b. “Small Plurality Backs Bailout Plan.” September 30. Available at http://www.people-
press.org/2008/09/30/small-plurality-backs-bailout-plan.
———. 2009. “America’s Place in the World 2009.” December. Available at http://www.people-
press.org/files/legacy-pdf/569.pdf.
———. 2010a. “Earmarks Could Help Candidates in Midterms; Palin and Tea Party Connections
Could Hurt.” August 2. Available at http://people-press.org/report/642/#energy.
———. 2010b. “Health Care Reform—Can’t Live with It, or without It.” March 18. Available at
http://www.people-press.org/files/legacy-pdf/598.pdf.
———. 2010c. “Public’s Top Stories of the Decade—9/11 and Katrina.” December 30. Available at
http://www.people-press.org/2010/12/30/publics-top-stories-of-the-decade-911-and-katrina.
Pitz, Marylynne. 2009. “Groundbreaking Set for Flight 93 Memorial.” Pittsburgh Post-Gazette,
February 21. Available at http://www.post-gazette.com/pg/09052/950745-84.stm.
Postman, Neil. 1985. Amusing Ourselves to Death: Public Discourse in the Age of Show Business. New
York: Viking Penguin.
Potter, Jonathan. 1996. “Discourse Analysis and Constructionist Approaches: Theoretical
Background.” In Handbook of Qualitative Research Methods for Psychology and the Social
Sciences, ed. J.T.E. Richardson, 125–140. Leicester, UK: British Psychological Society.
Prinz, Jesse. 2011. “Against Empathy.” Southern Journal of Philosophy 49:214–233.
Quarantelli, E. L. 2001. “The Sociology of Panic.” In International Encyclopedia of the Social and
Behavioral Sciences, ed. Neil J. Smelser and Paul B. Baltes, 11020–11023. Oxford: Elsevier.
Quarantelli, E. L., and R. R. Dynes. 1977. “Response to Social Crisis and Disaster.” Annual Review of
Sociology 3:23–49.
Recuber, Timothy. 2013. “Disaster Porn!” Contexts 12 (2): 28–33.
Reddy, William M. 2001. The Navigation of Feeling: A Framework for the History of Emotions. New
York: Cambridge University Press.
Reese, Stephen D. 2003. “Prologue—Framing Public Life: A Bridging Model for Media Research.” In
Framing Public Life: Perspectives on Media and Our Understanding of the Social World, ed.
Stephen D. Reese, Oscar H. Gandy, and August E. Grant, 7–32. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Reich, Robert. 2001. “How Did Spending Become Our Patriotic Duty?” Washington Post, September
23, B1.
Reiff, Philip. 1966. The Triumph of the Therapeutic: Uses of Faith after Freud. New York: Harper and
Row.
Reinhart, Carmen M., and Kenneth S. Rogoff. 2009. This Time Is Different: Eight Centuries of
Financial Folly. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
“Revising 9/11.” 2005. Editorial. New York Times, September 11. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2005/09/11/opinion/revising-911.html?_r=0.
Ritzer, George. 1999. Enchanting a Disenchanted World: Revolutionizing the Means of Consumption.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Pine Forge.
Ritzer, George, and Nathan Jurgenson. 2010. “Production, Consumption, Prosumption: The Nature of
Capitalism in the Age of the Digital ‘Prosumer.’” Journal of Consumer Culture 10 (1): 13–36.
Roberts, Dan, and Spencer Ackerman. 2013. “US Lawmakers Call for Review of Patriot Act after NSA
Surveillance Revelations.” The Guardian, June 10. Available at
http://www.theguardian.com/world/2013/jun/10/patriot-act-nsa-surveillance-review.
Robinson, Sue. 2009. “‘If You Had Been with Us’: Mainstream Press and Citizen Journalists Jockey
for Authority over the Collective Memory of Hurricane Katrina.” New Media and Society 11 (5):
795–814.
Rodríguez, Havidán, and Russell Dynes. 2006. “Finding and Framing Katrina: The Social Construction
of Disaster.” June 11. Available at
http://understandingkatrina.ssrc.org/Dynes_Rodriguez/printable.html.
Rodríguez, Havidán, Joseph Trainor, and Enrico L. Quarantelli. 2006. “Rising to the Challenges of a
Catastrophe: The Emergent and Prosocial Behavior following Hurricane Katrina.” Annals of the
American Academy of Political and Social Science 604:82–101.
Rose, Randall L., and Stacy L. Wood. 2005. “Paradox and the Consumption of Authenticity through
Reality Television.” Journal of Consumer Research 32:284–296.
Rose, Steve. 2013. “Abraham Zapruder: The Man behind History’s Most Infamous Home Movie.” The
Guardian, November 14. Available at http://www.theguardian.com/film/2013/nov/14/abraham-
zapruder-film-kennedy-killing-parkland.
Rousseau, Jean-Jacques. 1997. The Discourses and Other Early Writings. Ed. and trans. Victor
Gourevitch. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Rozario, Kevin. 2007. The Culture of Calamity: Disaster and the Making of Modern America. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
Rushkoff, Douglas. 2002. “Renaissance Now?” June 13. Available at
http://www.rushkoff.com/blog/2002/6/13/renaissance-now.html.
Saad, Lydia. 2004. “Americans Generally Comfortable with Patriot Act.” Gallup News Service, March
2. Available at http://www.gallup.com/poll/10858/Americans-Generally-Comfortable-Patriot-
Act.aspx.
Sandy, Adam. 2001. “Dreamland.” Available at http://history.amusement parks.com/Dreamland.html.
Santino, Jack. 1992. “‘Not an Unimportant Failure’: Rituals of Death and Politics in Northern Ireland.”
In Displayed in Mortal Light, ed. Michael McCaughan, n.p. Antrim, Ireland: Antrim Arts Council.
———. 2006. “Performative Commemoratives: Spontaneous Shrines and the Public Memorialization
of Death.” In Spontaneous Shrines and the Public Memorialization of Death, ed. Jack Santino,
363–372. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
“Sarnoff, David: U.S. Media Executive.” N.d. In Encyclopedia of Television, ed. Horace Newcomb,
Museum of Broadcast Communications website. Available at
http://www.museum.tv/archives/etv/S/htmlS/sarnoffdavi/sarnoffdavi.htm.
Savage, Kirk. 2006. “Trauma, Healing, and the Therapeutic Monument.” In Terror, Culture, Politics:
Rethinking 9/11, ed. Daniel J. Sherman and Terry Nardin, 103–120. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Scanlon, Jennifer. 2005. “‘Your Flag Decal Won’t Get You into Heaven Anymore’: U.S. Consumers,
Wal-Mart, and the Commodification of Patriotism.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a National
Tragedy Became a Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 174–199. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Scarry, Elaine. 1985. The Body in Pain: The Making and Unmaking of the World. New York: Oxford
University Press.
Schudson, Michael. 1978. Discovering the News: A Social History of American Newspapers. New
York: Basic.
Schwartz, Barry. 1982. “The Social Context of Commemoration: A Study in Collective Memory.”
Social Forces 61 (2): 374–402.
Scott, A. O. 2007. “Drawing a Line from Movie to Murder.” New York Times, April 23. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2007/04/23/movies/23movi.html.
Sears, Michael D. 2013. “The Formation of Issue Publics during the Great Recession: Examining the
Influences of News Media, Geography, and Demographics.” Ph.D. diss. University of Iowa, Iowa
City.
Shales, Tom. 2007. “NBC Broadcasts an Eerie Epilogue.” Washington Post, April 19. Available at
http://www.washingtonpost.com/wp-dyn/content/article/2007/04/18/AR2007041802745.html.
Shirky, Clay. 2011. “The Political Power of Social Media: Technology, the Public Sphere, and Political
Change.” Foreign Affairs. Available at http://www.foreignaffairs.com/articles/67038/clay-
shirky/the-political-power-of-social-media.
Shrum, Wesley. 2007. “Hurricane Stories, from Within.” Social Studies of Science 37 (1): 97–102.
Simmons, James C. 1969. “Bulwer and Vesuvius: The Topicality of the Last Days of Pompeii.”
Nineteenth-Century Fiction 24 (1): 103–105.
Simon, Art. 1996. Dangerous Knowledge: The JFK Assassination in Art and Film. Philadelphia:
Temple University Press.
Sirota, David. 2009. “TARP on Steroids.” Truthdig, October 29. Available at
http://www.truthdig.com/report/item/20091029_tarp_on_steroids#.
Smelser, Neil J. 2004. “September 11, 2001, as Cultural Trauma.” In Cultural Trauma and Collective
Identity, ed. Jeffrey C. Alexander, Ron Eyerman, Bernhard Giesen, Neil J. Smelser, and Piotr
Sztompka, 264–282. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Smith, Aaron. 2011. “How Sept. 11 Changed Charity in America.” CNN Money, September 6.
Available at http://money.cnn.com/2011/09/06/news/economy/katrina_donations_911.
Smith, Adam. (1790) 2009. The Theory of Moral Sentiments. New York: Penguin.
———. 1869. The Essays of Adam Smith. London: Alex. Murray and Son.
Solnit, Rebecca. 2009. A Paradise Built in Hell: The Extraordinary Communities that Arise in Disaster.
New York: Viking.
Solomon, Jesse. 2010. “Nine Years after 9/11, a Photo Provides Some Peace.” CNN.com, September
11. Available at http://www.cnn.com/2010/US/09/10/september.11.photo/index.html.
Song, Felicia Wu. 2004. “Online Communities in a Therapeutic Age.” In Therapeutic Culture:
Triumph and Defeat, ed. Jonathan B. Imber, 137–151. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction.
Sontag, Susan. 1990. On Photography. New York: Anchor.
———. 2003. Regarding the Pain of Others. New York: Farrar, Straus and Giroux.
Spigel, Lynn. 2005. “Entertainment Wars: Television Culture after 9/11.” In The Selling of 9/11: How a
National Tragedy Became a Commodity, ed. Dana Heller, 119–154. New York: Palgrave
Macmillan.
Spitzer, Eliot. 2010. “Regulators and Risk-Takers.” Slate, July 14. Available at
http://www.slate.com/id/2260470/.
Stanley, Alessandra. 2007. “Ghosts of Abu Ghraib: Abu Ghraib and Its Multiple Failures.” New York
Times. Available at http://www.nytimes.com/2007/02/22/arts/television/22stan.html.
Stearns, Peter N. 2006. American Fear: The Causes and Consequences of High Anxiety. New York:
Routledge.
———. 2008. “Texas and Virginia: A Bloodied Window into Changes in American Public Life.”
Journal of Social History 42 (2): 299–318.
Steinberg, Jacques. 2007. “Arts, Briefly: Suspect’s Video Boosts Ratings for NBC News.” New York
Times, April 25, 2.
Steinberg, Ted. 2000. Acts of God: The Unnatural History of Natural Disaster in America. Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Stephen, Andrew. 2007. “The Unmentionable Causes of Violence.” New Statesmen, April 30, 20–21.
Stephens, Mitchell. 1988. A History of News: From the Drum to the Satellite. New York: Viking.
Stewart, Doug. 2006. “Resurrecting Pompeii: A New Exhibition Brings the Doomed Residents of
Pompeii and Herculaneum Vividly to Life.” Smithsonian Magazine, February. Available at
http://www.smithsonianmag.com/history-archaeology/pompeii.html.
Strobel, Warren P. 2008. “Exhaustive Review Finds No Link between Saddam and al Qaida.”
McClatchy Newspapers, March 10. Available at
http://www.mcclatchydc.com/2008/03/10/29959/exhaustive-review-finds-no-link.html.
Strom, Stephanie. 2006. “Red Cross Sifting Internal Charges over Katrina Aid.” New York Times,
March 24. Available at
http://www.nytimes.com/2006/03/24/national/nationalspecial/24cross.html.
Sturken, Marita. 1997. Tangled Memories: The Vietnam War, the AIDS Epidemic, and the Politics of
Remembering. Berkeley: University of California Press.
———. 2007. Tourists of History: Memory, Kitsch, and Consumerism from Oklahoma City to Ground
Zero. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Szasz, Andrew. 2007. Shopping Our Way to Safety: How We Changed from Protecting the
Environment to Protecting Ourselves. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Taylor, Charles. 1991. The Ethics of Authenticity. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Teal, Harvey S. 2001. Partners with the Sun: South Carolina Photographers, 1840–1940. Columbia:
University of South Carolina Press.
Thomas, Jeannie B. 2006. “Communicative Commemoration and Graveside Shrines: Princess Diana,
Jim Morrison, My ‘Bro’ Max, and Boogs the Cat.” In Spontaneous Shrines and the Public
Memorialization of Death, ed. Jack Santino, 17–40. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
“Three Shocks Yesterday; Citizens of Charleston Repairing Their Homes.” 1886. New York Times,
September 8, 1.
Thrift, Nigel. 2006. “Re-inventing Invention: New Tendencies in Capitalist Commodification.”
Economy and Society 35 (2): 279–306.
Tierney, Kathleen J. 2007. “From the Margins to the Mainstream? Disaster Research at the
Crossroads.” Annual Review of Sociology 33:503–525.
Tierney, Kathleen, Christine Bevc, and Erica Kuligowski. 2006. “Metaphors Matter: Disaster Myths,
Media Frames, and Their Consequences in Hurricane Katrina.” Annals of the American Academy
of Political and Social Science 604:57–81.
Tocqueville, Alexis de. 2000. Democracy in America. Trans. G. Lawrence. New York: Perennial
Classics.
Toffler, Alvin. 1980. The Third Wave. New York: William Morrow.
Torpey, John. 2006. Making Whole What Has Been Smashed: On Reparations Politics. Cambridge,
MA: Harvard University Press.
Trotter, Wilfred. (1919) 1953. Instincts of the Herd in Peace and War. London: Oxford University
Press.
“‘Trouble the Water’ Examines Katrina Aftermath.” 2008. Nashville City Paper, September 26.
Available at http://nashvillecitypaper.com/content/lifestyles/%E2%80%98trouble-
water%E2%80%99-examines-katrina-aftermath704463504575300551880706526.html.
Turner, Graeme. 2006. “The Mass Production of Celebrity: ‘Celetoids,’ Reality TV and the ‘Demotic
Turn.’” International Journal of Cultural Studies 9 (2): 153–165.
Turnock, Robert. 2000. Interpreting Diana: Television Audiences and the Death of a Princess. London:
British Film Institute.
Ulmer, Gregory L. 2005. Electronic Monuments. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Underwood, Doug. 2001. “Reporting and the Push for Market-Oriented Journalism: Media
Organizations as Businesses.” In Mediated Politics: Communication in the Future of Democracy,
ed. W. Lance Bennett and Robert M. Entman, 99–116. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Ungar, Sheldon. 1990. “Moral Panics, the Military-Industrial Complex, and the Arms Race.”
Sociological Quarterly 31 (2): 165–185.
Van Meter, Jonathan. 2005. “Unanchored.” New York Magazine, September 11. Available at
http://nymag.com/nymetro/news/features/14301.
Van Zoonen, Liesbet. 1998. “The Ethics of Making Private Life Public.” In The Media in Question:
Popular Cultures and Public Interests, ed. Kees Brants, Joke Hermes, and Liesbet van Zoonen,
113–123. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Vattimo, Gianni. 1992. The Transparent Society. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Vetlesen, Arne Johan. 1994. Perception, Empathy, and Judgment: An Inquiry into the Preconditions of
Moral Performance. University Park: Pennsylvania State University Press.
Victor, Jeffrey S. 1991. “The Dynamics of Rumor-Panics about Satanic Cults.” In The Satanism Scare,
ed. James T. Richardson, Joel Best, and David G. Bromley, 221–236. New York: Aldine de
Gruyter.
Voorhees, Courte C. W., John Vick, and Douglas D. Perkins. 2007. “‘Came Hell and High Water’: The
Intersection of Hurricane Katrina, the News Media, Race and Poverty.” Journal of Community
and Applied Social Psychology 17:415–429.
Walker, Joyce. 2007. “Narratives in the Database: Memorializing September 11th Online.” Computers
and Composition 24:121–153.
Walt, Stephen M. 2012. “Why Afghanistan Was Obama’s Biggest Mistake.” Weatherhead Center for
International Affairs, Harvard University. Available at http://wcfia.harvard.edu/publications/why-
afghanistan-was-obamas-biggest-mistake.
Ward, Patrick S., and Gerald E. Shively. 2011. “Disaster Risk, Social Vulnerability and Economic
Development.” Paper presented at the Agricultural and Applied Economics Association and
Northeastern Agricultural and Resource Economics Association Joint Annual Meeting, Pittsburgh,
July 24–26.
Weber, Harry R., and Erin McClam. 2010. “Gulf Oil Spill: BP’s Failures Amplified by Numerous
Gaffes.” Huffington Post, June 11. Available at http://www.huffingtonpost.com/2010/06/11/gulf-
oil-spil-bp-gaffes_n_609859.html.
Weisbrot, Mark. 2013. “Are Snowden, Greenwald, and Wikileaks Winning?” Alternet, August 7.
Available at http://www.files.alternet.org/are-snowden-greenwald-and-wikileaks-winning.
Wellman, Barry, Anabel Quan Haase, James Witte, and Keith Hampton. 2001. “Does the Internet
Increase, Decrease, or Supplement Social Capital? Social Networks, Participation, and
Community Commitment.” American Behavioral Scientist 45 (3): 436–455.
Werner, Erica. 2010. “BP Agrees to Show ‘Top Kill’ Video.” ABC News, May 25. Available at
http://abcnews.go.com/Business/wireStory?id=10742878.
Wherry, Frederick F. 2006. “The Social Sources of Authenticity in Global Handicraft Markets:
Evidence from Northern Thailand.” Journal of Consumer Culture 6 (1): 5–32.
Wilkinson, Richard G. 1996. Unhealthy Societies: The Afflictions of Inequality. New York: Routledge.
Wilkinson, Richard, and Kate Pickett. 2009. The Spirit Level: Why Greater Equality Makes Societies
Stronger. New York: Bloomsbury.
Williams, Raymond. 1977. Marxism and Literature. New York: Oxford University Press.
———. 1985. Keywords: A Vocabulary of Culture and Society. Rev. ed. New York: Oxford University
Press.
Williams, Susan Millar, and Stephen G. Hoffius. 2011. Upheaval in Charleston: Earthquake and
Murder on the Eve of Jim Crow. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Willis, Margaret, and Juliet B. Schor. 2012. “Does Changing a Light Bulb Lead to Changing the
World? Political Action and the Conscious Consumer.” Annals of the American Academy of
Political and Social Science 644:160–190.
Wispé, Lauren. 1986. “The Distinction between Sympathy and Empathy: To Call Forth a Concept, a
Word Is Needed.” Journal of Personality and Social Psychology 50 (2): 314–321.
Young, James E. 1993. The Texture of Memory: Holocaust Memorials and Meaning. New Haven, CT:
Yale University Press.
Zelizer, Barbie. 1992. Covering the Body: The Kennedy Assassination, the Media, and the Shaping of
Collective Memory. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Zinn, Jens O. 2006. “Risk, Affect and Emotion.” Forum 7 (1). Available at http://www.qualitative-
research.net/index.php/fqs/article/view/67/137.
Zinner, Ellen S. 1999. “The Challenger Disaster: Group Survivorship on a National Landscape.” In
When a Community Weeps: Case Studies in Group Survivorship, ed. Ellen S. Zinner and Mary
Beth Williams, 23–48. Ann Arbor, MI: Brunner/Mazel.
Zukin, Sharon. 2002. “Our World Trade Center.” In After the World Trade Center: Rethinking New
York City, ed. Michael Sorkin and Sharon Zukin, 13–22. New York: Routledge.
———. 2008. “Consuming Authenticity: From Outposts of Difference to Means of Exclusion.”
Cultural Studies 22 (5): 724–748.
———. 2010. Naked City: The Death and Life of Authentic Urban Places. New York: Oxford
University Press.
Timothy Recuber is a Visiting Assistant Professor in the
Communication Department at Hamilton College.

You might also like